PARK OHIO INDUSTRIES INC/OH
424B4, 1999-07-27
METAL FORGINGS & STAMPINGS
Previous: MPEG SUPER SITE, 8-K, 1999-07-27
Next: MUNIHOLDINGS NEW JERSEY INSURED FUND II INC, NSAR-B, 1999-07-27



<PAGE>   1

                                               Filed Pursuant To Rule 424(B)4
                                               Registration No. 333-83117
PROSPECTUS
                                                                  PARK OHIO LOGO

                                  $200,000,000

                           PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC.

                       OFFER TO EXCHANGE ALL OUTSTANDING
                   9 1/4% SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES DUE 2007
        THAT WERE ORIGINALLY ISSUED ON JUNE 2, 1999 OR NOVEMBER 25, 1997
               FOR NEW 9 1/4% SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES DUE 2007
           THAT HAVE BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

                 THIS EXCHANGE OFFER WILL EXPIRE AT 5:00 P.M.,
                     NEW YORK CITY TIME, ON AUGUST 26, 1999

          - Interest on the notes accrues at an annual rate of 9 1/4% and will
            be paid twice a year, beginning December 1, 1999.

          - The terms of the notes are the same as the terms of the outstanding
            notes that we issued in a private offering on June 2, 1999, except
            that the new notes will not be subject to the transfer restrictions
            imposed by federal securities laws.

          - The notes will rank below all of our senior debt. Therefore, if we
            default, your right to payment under the notes will be junior to any
            of our senior debt.

          - We will exchange all outstanding notes that are validly tendered and
            are not withdrawn before this exchange offer expires.

          - You may withdraw your tender of notes at any time before August 26,
            1999, the expiration date of this exchange offer.

          - Your exchange of an outstanding note for a new note will not
            constitute a taxable exchange for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

          - You may tender your notes only in denominations of $1,000 and in
            multiples of $1,000.

          - The exchange offer is subject only to the condition that it does not
            violate applicable law or any applicable interpretation of the staff
            of the Securities and Exchange Commission.

          - We will not receive any proceeds from this exchange offer.

     THIS EXCHANGE OFFER APPLIES TO ALL OF OUR OUTSTANDING 9 1/4% SENIOR
SUBORDINATED NOTES DUE 2007, SERIES B AND SERIES C INCLUDING THE $150,000,000 OF
NOTES ORIGINALLY ISSUED ON NOVEMBER 25, 1997 AND THE $50,000,000 OF NOTES
ORIGINALLY ISSUED ON JUNE 2, 1999.

                            ------------------------

     Please carefully consider the "Risk Factors" beginning on page 9 of this
prospectus.

                            ------------------------

     NEITHER THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION NOR ANY STATE SECURITIES
COMMISSION HAS APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED OF THESE NOTES OR DETERMINED THAT THIS
PROSPECTUS IS ACCURATE OR COMPLETE. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A
CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

                 The date of this prospectus is July 27, 1999.
<PAGE>   2

                               TABLE OF CONTENTS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                PAGE
                                                                ----
<S>                                                             <C>
FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS..................................     iv

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION.........................     iv

PROSPECTUS SUMMARY..........................................      1
     Park-Ohio..............................................      1
     Recent Developments....................................      1
     The Exchange Offer.....................................      2
     The Notes..............................................      5
     Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges.....................      6
     Risk Factors...........................................      6
     Federal Income Tax Consequences........................      6
     Summary Historical and Pro Forma Consolidated Financial
      Data..................................................      7

RISK FACTORS................................................      9
     Risks Associated With the Notes........................      9
     Risks Specific to Park-Ohio and Our Business...........     11
     Risks Associated with Not Participating in the Exchange
      Offer.................................................     14

USE OF PROCEEDS.............................................     15

CAPITALIZATION..............................................     15

SELECTED HISTORICAL CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA.............     16

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT DATA......     18

THE EXCHANGE OFFER..........................................     24
     Purpose and Effect of the Exchange Offer...............     24
     Resale of the New Notes................................     24
     Special Rules for Broker-Dealers.......................     25
     Terms of the Exchange Offer............................     25
     Expiration Date; Extensions; Amendments................     25
     Conditions.............................................     26
     Procedures for Tendering...............................     27
     Book-Entry Transfer....................................     28
     Guaranteed Delivery Procedures.........................     29
     Withdrawal of Tenders..................................     29
     Termination of Rights Accorded by the Registration
      Rights Agreement......................................     30
     Exchange Agent.........................................     30
     Fees and Expenses......................................     30
     Consequences of Failure of Exchange....................     31
     Accounting Treatment...................................     31

MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
  AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.................................     32
     Overview...............................................     32
     Results of Operations..................................     33
     Liquidity and Sources of Capital.......................     35
     Impact of Inflation....................................     36
     Year 2000 Conversion...................................     36
     Environmental..........................................     37
     Seasonality; Variability of Operating Results..........     37
     Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure About Market
      Risk..................................................     37
     Forward-Looking Statements.............................     37
</TABLE>

                                        i
<PAGE>   3

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                PAGE
                                                                ----
<S>                                                             <C>
DESCRIPTION OF OTHER INDEBTEDNESS...........................     38
     Revolving Credit Facility..............................     38
     Industrial Revenue Bonds...............................     38
     State Loans............................................     39
     Other Indebtedness.....................................     39
     Series B Notes.........................................     39

BUSINESS....................................................     40
     Our Operations.........................................     42
     Integrated Logistics Solutions.........................     42
     Manufactured Products..................................     43
     Aluminum Products......................................     44
     Sales and Marketing....................................     45
     Raw Materials and Suppliers............................     45
     Backlog................................................     45
     Environmental Regulations..............................     45
     Employees..............................................     46
     Information About Industry Segments and Geographic
      Areas.................................................     46
     Properties.............................................     46
     Legal Proceedings......................................     46

MANAGEMENT..................................................     47
     Directors and Officers of Park-Ohio....................     47
     Compensation of the Board of Directors.................     48

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION......................................     49
     Summary of Compensation................................     49
     Stock Based Compensation, Including Options............     49

PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS......................................     51

RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS..................................     52

DESCRIPTION OF THE NOTES....................................     53
     General................................................     53
     Maturity, Interest and Principal.......................     53
     Optional Redemption....................................     53
     Subordination..........................................     54
     Covenants..............................................     56
     Change of Control Offer................................     61
     Merger, Consolidation or Sale of Assets................     63
     Events of Default......................................     64
     Defeasance and Covenant Defeasance.....................     65
     Modification of Indenture..............................     66
     Reports to Holders.....................................     67
     Compliance Certificate.................................     67
     The Trustee............................................     67
     Transfer and Exchange..................................     67
     Definitions............................................     67
     Book-Entry; Delivery and Form..........................     81
</TABLE>

                                       ii
<PAGE>   4

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                PAGE
                                                                ----
<S>                                                             <C>
FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES.............................     85
     U.S. Holders...........................................     85
     Non-U.S. Holders.......................................     87
     Information Reporting and Backup Withholding...........     88

PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION........................................     88

LEGAL MATTERS...............................................     89

EXPERTS.....................................................     89

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS..................    F-1
</TABLE>

                                       iii
<PAGE>   5

                           FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

     WE MAKE "FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS" THROUGHOUT THIS PROSPECTUS. WHENEVER
YOU READ A STATEMENT THAT IS NOT SIMPLY A STATEMENT OF HISTORICAL FACT SUCH AS
WHEN WE DESCRIBE WHAT WE "BELIEVE," "EXPECT" OR "ANTICIPATE" WILL OCCUR, AND
OTHER SIMILAR STATEMENTS, YOU MUST REMEMBER THAT OUR EXPECTATIONS MAY NOT BE
CORRECT, EVEN THOUGH WE BELIEVE THEY ARE REASONABLE. WE DO NOT GUARANTEE THAT
THE TRANSACTIONS AND EVENTS DESCRIBED IN THIS PROSPECTUS WILL HAPPEN AS
DESCRIBED, OR THAT THEY WILL HAPPEN AT ALL. YOU SHOULD READ THIS PROSPECTUS
COMPLETELY AND WITH THE UNDERSTANDING THAT ACTUAL FUTURE RESULTS MAY BE
SIGNIFICANTLY DIFFERENT FROM WHAT WE EXPECT. WE WILL NOT UPDATE THESE
FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS, EVEN THOUGH OUR SITUATION MAY CHANGE IN THE FUTURE.

                      WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

     We are subject to the periodic reporting and other informational
requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. In accordance with those
requirements, we file reports and other information with the SEC. All reports
and other information filed under the Exchange Act may be inspected at the
public reference facilities maintained by the SEC at 450 Fifth Street, N.W.,
Washington, D.C. 20549 and at its regional offices, located at 7 World Trade
Center, Suite 1300, New York, New York 10048 and at Citicorp Center, 500 West
Madison Street, Suite 1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661-2511. Copies of those
documents may be obtained from the Public Reference Section of the SEC, 450
Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549 at prescribed rates. You may obtain
information about the operation of the public reference facilities by calling
1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC maintains a web site at http://www.sec.gov that contains
reports and other information regarding registrants, like us, that file
documents electronically with the SEC.

     We have agreed that, whether or not we are required to do so by the rules
and regulations of the SEC, for so long as any of the notes remain outstanding,
we will furnish to the holders of the notes and file with the SEC, unless the
SEC will not accept such a filing:

          All quarterly and annual financial information that would be required
     to be contained in a filing with the SEC on Forms 10-Q and 10-K if we were
     required to file those forms, including a "Management's Discussion and
     Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and, with
     respect to the annual information only, a report by our certified
     independent accountants.

          All reports that would be required to be filed with the SEC on Form
     8-K if we were required to file those reports.

     In addition, for so long as any of the notes remain outstanding, we have
agreed to make available to any prospective purchaser of the notes or beneficial
owner of the notes in connection with any sale thereof the information required
by Rule 144A(d)(4) under the Securities Act.

                                       iv
<PAGE>   6

                               PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

     This summary highlights information contained elsewhere in this prospectus.
This summary is not complete and may not contain all of the information you
should consider before deciding to participate in the exchange offer. We urge
you to read this entire prospectus carefully, including the section titled "Risk
Factors." Unless otherwise indicated, all references in this prospectus to "we,"
"us," "our" and similar terms, as well as references to "Park-Ohio," refer to
Park-Ohio Industries, Inc. and its subsidiaries. Park-Ohio is a wholly owned
subsidiary of Park-Ohio Holdings Corp.

                                   PARK-OHIO

     Park-Ohio is an industrial logistics and diversified manufacturing business
which conducts its operations through three business segments:

     - Integrated Logistics Solutions, a leading national supplier of over
       150,000 standard and specialty fasteners and other industrial products;

     - Aluminum Products, which specializes in casting and machining aluminum
       components primarily for the automotive industry; and

     - Manufactured Products, which operates a diverse group of niche
       manufacturing businesses including large forgings such as locomotive
       crankshafts and camshafts, rubber products such as valve seals and
       capital equipment such as induction heating systems.

     Between 1992 and the year ended December 31, 1998, we have grown
significantly, both internally and through acquisitions. Over this period, we
have increased:

     - Net sales from $67.2 million to $551.8 million; and

     - EBITDA (as defined) from ($4.5) million to $53.1 million.

     We generated net sales of $347.7 million, $441.1 million, $551.8 million
and $171.4 million and EBITDA of $28.1 million, $38.3 million, $53.1 million and
$18.0 million for the years ended December 31, 1996, 1997 and 1998, and the
three months ended March 31, 1999, respectively.

                              RECENT DEVELOPMENTS

     We completed the following acquisitions in 1998 and 1999:

INTEGRATED LOGISTICS SOLUTIONS

     Columbia Nut & Bolt Corp. and Industrial Fasteners Corp. In July 1999, we
acquired all of the outstanding stock of Columbia and Industrial Fasteners,
distributors of fasteners and other industrial products. Industrial Fasteners
manufactures fasteners, primarily screws, rivets and pins. The acquisition of
these companies provides us with a base on the east coast from which we can
expand. Columbia and Industrial Fasteners had combined 1998 net sales of
approximately $35.0 million. As these acquisitions did not take place until
July, 1999 and are not material to Park-Ohio, their results have not been
included in the pro forma financial statements.

     GIS Industries, Inc. On October 8, 1998, we acquired all of the outstanding
stock of GIS Industries, a distributor of fasteners and other industrial
products and a manufacturer of metal products and fasteners. GIS Industries,
which is referred to in this prospectus as Gateway, has customers primarily
located in Ohio, Pennsylvania, New York and Kentucky. The acquisition of Gateway
provides us with a major presence in Pennsylvania, as well as an experienced
management team. Gateway generated $41.4 million in net sales in 1998.

     Direct Fasteners Limited. On April 13, 1998, we acquired all of the
outstanding stock of Direct Fasteners, a distributor of fasteners located in
Ontario, Canada. Direct's customers are located primarily in the provinces of
Ontario and Quebec. The acquisition of Direct Fasteners provides us with a base
in Canada from which we can expand. Direct Fasteners generated $6.8 million in
net sales in 1998.

                                        1
<PAGE>   7

ALUMINUM PRODUCTS

     The Metalloy Corporation. On January 4, 1999, we acquired all of the
outstanding stock of Metalloy, a full service aluminum casting and machining
company. Metalloy's customers are primarily domestic producers of automobiles
and trucks. Metalloy specializes in die, sand and permanent mold machined
castings and has operations in Indiana, Michigan and Mississippi. Metalloy
generated $94.8 million in net sales in 1998.

MANUFACTURED PRODUCTS

     PMC Industries Inc. On February 17, 1999, we acquired all of the Ohio-based
assets of PMC. PMC is the only domestic manufacturer of tube threading machines
and related parts for the oil drilling industry. PMC generated $10.4 million in
net sales in 1998.

     St. Louis Screw and Bolt Company. On January 29, 1999, we acquired
substantially all of the assets of St. Louis Screw and Bolt, a manufacturer of
bolts for the construction industries. St. Louis Screw and Bolt complements our
existing structural hardware business and expands our product offerings. St.
Louis Screw and Bolt generated $6.8 million in net sales in 1998.

     We borrowed approximately $99.3 million in cash under our revolving credit
facility to complete these seven acquisitions.

                               THE EXCHANGE OFFER

THE EXCHANGE OFFER               We are offering to exchange $200.0 million
                                 principal amount of new 9 1/4% Senior
                                 Subordinated Notes due 2007, Series D, which
                                 have been registered under the federal
                                 securities laws for:

                                 - $50.0 million principal amount of our
                                   outstanding unregistered 9 1/4% Senior
                                   Subordinated Notes due 2007, Series C, that
                                   were issued in June 1999 in a private
                                   offering; and

                                 - $150.0 million principal amount of our 9 1/4%
                                   Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007, Series B.
                                   All of the Series A notes, originally issued
                                   in November 1997, were exchanged for Series B
                                   notes that were registered with the
                                   Securities and Exchange Commission in
                                   December 1997.

                                 We sometimes refer to the Series C notes and
                                 the Series B notes collectively as the
                                 "outstanding notes." You have the right to
                                 exchange your outstanding notes for new notes
                                 with substantially identical terms.

                                 In order for your outstanding notes to be
                                 exchanged, you must properly tender them prior
                                 to the expiration of the exchange offer. All
                                 validly tendered outstanding notes will be
                                 exchanged. We will issue new notes promptly
                                 after the exchange offer expires.

THIS EXCHANGE OFFER WILL
EXTINGUISH REGISTRATION RIGHTS   We sold the Series C notes in a private
                                 offering to CIBC World Markets Corp., ING
                                 Baring Furman Selz LLC and Value Investing
                                 Partners, Inc., the initial purchasers. At that
                                 time, we signed a registration rights agreement
                                 with those initial purchasers which requires us
                                 to conduct this exchange offer for both the
                                 Series C notes and Series B notes.

                                 This exchange offer is intended to satisfy the
                                 rights provided by the registration rights
                                 agreement. After the exchange offer is
                                 complete, you will no longer be entitled to
                                 registration rights with respect to
                                        2
<PAGE>   8

                                 outstanding notes you were entitled to exchange
                                 but did not exchange.

WHAT HAPPENS IF YOU FAIL TO
  EXCHANGE YOUR OUTSTANDING
  NOTES?                         If you hold Series C notes and do not exchange
                                 your outstanding notes for new notes in the
                                 exchange offer, you will continue to be subject
                                 to the restrictions on transfer provided in
                                 those notes and in the indenture governing
                                 those notes. In general, you may not offer or
                                 sell your Series C notes unless they are
                                 registered under the federal securities laws or
                                 are sold in a transaction exempt from or not
                                 subject to the registration requirements of the
                                 federal securities laws and applicable state
                                 securities laws.

                                 If you hold Series B notes, and do not exchange
                                 your notes for new notes in this exchange
                                 offer, you will not become subject to transfer
                                 restrictions and your notes will remain freely
                                 tradeable. However, the principal amount of
                                 remaining Series B notes will decrease as those
                                 notes are exchanged in the exchange offer. This
                                 decrease will reduce the liquidity of any
                                 trading market that may exist for the Series B
                                 notes.

EXPIRATION DATE                  The exchange offer will expire at 5:00 p.m.,
                                 New York City time, on August 26, 1999, unless
                                 we decide to extend the expiration date. See
                                 "The Exchange Offer -- Expiration Date;
                                 Extensions; Amendments."

CONDITIONS TO THE EXCHANGE
OFFER                            The exchange offer is subject to conditions
                                 that we may waive. The exchange offer is not
                                 conditioned on any minimum amount of
                                 outstanding notes being tendered for exchange.
                                 Please read "The Exchange Offer -- Conditions"
                                 for a complete description of the conditions to
                                 the exchange offer.

                                 We reserve the right, subject to applicable
                                 law, at any time and from time to time:

                                 - to delay the acceptance of any outstanding
                                   notes;

                                 - to terminate the exchange offer if any of the
                                   specified conditions have not been satisfied;

                                 - to extend the expiration date of the exchange
                                   offer and retain all tendered outstanding
                                   notes subject to the right of tendering
                                   holders to withdraw their tender of
                                   outstanding notes; and

                                 - to waive any condition or otherwise amend the
                                   terms of the exchange offer in any respect.

HOW TO TENDER YOUR OUTSTANDING
  NOTES                          If you wish to tender your outstanding notes
                                 for exchange, you must:

                                 - complete and sign the enclosed Letter of
                                   Transmittal by following the related
                                   instructions, and

                                 - send the Letter of Transmittal, as directed
                                   in the instructions, together with any other
                                   required documents, to the exchange agent,
                                   either

                                   (1) with the outstanding notes to be
                                       tendered; or

                                        3
<PAGE>   9

                                   (2) in compliance with the specified
                                       procedures for guaranteed delivery of
                                       outstanding notes.

                                 Brokers, dealers, commercial banks, trust
                                 companies and other nominees may also effect
                                 tenders by book-entry transfer.

                                 Please do not send your letter of transmittal
                                 or certificates representing your outstanding
                                 notes to Park-Ohio. Those documents should only
                                 be sent to the exchange agent. Questions
                                 regarding how to tender and requests for
                                 information should also be directed to the
                                 exchange agent. See "The Exchange
                                 Offer -- Exchange Agent."

SPECIAL PROCEDURES FOR
BENEFICIAL OWNER                 If your outstanding notes are registered in the
                                 name of a broker, dealer, commercial bank,
                                 trust company or other nominee, we urge you to
                                 contact that person promptly if you wish to
                                 tender your outstanding notes in the exchange
                                 offer. See "The Exchange Offer  -- Procedures
                                 for Tendering."

WITHDRAWAL RIGHTS                You may withdraw the tender of your outstanding
                                 notes any time prior to the expiration date of
                                 the exchange offer by delivering a written
                                 notice of withdrawal to the exchange agent. You
                                 must follow the withdrawal procedures described
                                 under the heading "The Exchange
                                 Offer -- Withdrawal of Tenders."

RESALES OF NEW NOTES             We believe that you will be able to offer for
                                 resale, resell or otherwise transfer new notes
                                 issued in the exchange offer without compliance
                                 with the registration and prospectus delivery
                                 provisions of the federal securities laws, as
                                 long as:

                                 - you are acquiring the new notes in the
                                   ordinary course of business;

                                 - you are not participating, and have no
                                   arrangement or understanding with any person
                                   to participate, in the distribution of the
                                   new notes; and

                                 - you are not an affiliate of Park-Ohio. An
                                   affiliate of Park-Ohio is a person that
                                   "controls, is controlled by, or is under
                                   common control with" Park-Ohio.

                                 Our belief is based on interpretations by the
                                 staff of the Securities and Exchange Commission
                                 set forth in no-action letters issued to third
                                 parties not related to us. The SEC's staff has
                                 not considered this exchange offer in the
                                 context of a no-action letter. We cannot assure
                                 you that the SEC's staff would make a similar
                                 determination with respect to this exchange
                                 offer.

                                 If our belief is not accurate and you transfer
                                 a new note without delivering a prospectus
                                 meeting the requirements of the federal
                                 securities laws or without an exemption from
                                 these laws, you may incur liability under the
                                 federal securities laws. We do not, and will
                                 not, assume or indemnify you against this
                                 liability.

                                 Each broker-dealer that receives new notes for
                                 its own account in exchange for outstanding
                                 notes which were acquired by that broker-
                                 dealer as a result of market-making or other
                                 trading activities must agree to deliver a
                                 prospectus meeting the requirements of the
                                 federal

                                        4
<PAGE>   10

                                 securities laws in connection with any resale
                                 of the notes. See "The Exchange Offer -- Resale
                                 of the New Notes."

EXCHANGE AGENT................   Norwest Bank, National Association is the
                                 exchange agent for the exchange offer. The
                                 address, telephone and facsimile numbers of the
                                 exchange agent are listed under the heading
                                 "The Exchange Offer -- Exchange Agent."

     See "The Exchange Offer" for more detailed information concerning the
exchange offer.

                                   THE NOTES

SECURITIES OFFERED............   $200,000,000 principal amount of 9 1/4% Senior
                                 Subordinated Notes, Series D, which we refer to
                                 as the "notes," the "new notes" or the "Series
                                 D Notes".

MATURITY DATE.................   December 1, 2007.

INTEREST RATE.................   9 1/4% per year (calculated using a 360-day
                                 year).

INTEREST PAYMENT DATES........   Each June 1 and December 1, beginning on
                                 December 1, 1999.

RANKING.......................   The notes will not be secured by any
                                 collateral.

                                 The notes will rank below all of our senior
                                 debt. Therefore, if we default, you will not be
                                 entitled to payment under the notes until the
                                 holders of our senior debt collect all of the
                                 money we owe them at that time. The notes will
                                 effectively rank below all liabilities
                                 (including trade payables) of our subsidiaries.

                                 The notes will rank equal to our other senior
                                 subordinated debt.

                                 As of March 31, 1999, we estimate that we would
                                 have had $271.3 million of debt after issuing
                                 the notes, of which approximately $71.3 million
                                 would have been senior debt.

OPTIONAL REDEMPTION...........   Except in connection with qualifying equity
                                 offerings by us, we cannot choose to redeem the
                                 notes before December 1, 2002. At any time from
                                 that date (which may be more than once), we can
                                 choose to redeem some or all of the notes at
                                 specified prices, plus interest.

                                 Redemption in connection with qualifying equity
                                 offerings: at any time (which may be more than
                                 once) before December 1, 2000, we can choose to
                                 buy back up to 35% of the outstanding notes
                                 with money that we raise in one or more
                                 qualifying equity offerings, as long as:

                                 - we pay 109.25% of the face amount of the
                                   notes, plus interest;

                                 - we buy the notes back within 60 days of
                                   completing the equity offering; and

                                 - at least 65% of all the notes issued under
                                   the indentures remain outstanding afterwards.

CHANGE OF CONTROL OFFER.......   If we experience a change in control, we must
                                 give holders of the notes the opportunity to
                                 sell us their notes at 101% of their face
                                 amount, plus interest. We might not be able to
                                 pay those holders the required price for notes
                                 they present to us at the time of a change of
                                 control, because:

                                        5
<PAGE>   11

                                 - we might not have enough funds at that time;
                                   or

                                 - the terms of our senior debt may prohibit us
                                   from paying.

ASSET SALE PROCEEDS...........   We may have to use the cash proceeds from
                                 selling assets to offer to buy back notes at
                                 their face amount, plus accrued interest.

CERTAIN INDENTURE
PROVISIONS....................   The indentures governing the notes will limit
                                 what we, and most or all of our subsidiaries,
                                 may do, including our ability to:

                                 - incur more debt;

                                 - pay dividends and make distributions;

                                 - issue stock of subsidiaries;

                                 - make investments;

                                 - repurchase stock;

                                 - create liens;

                                 - enter into transactions with affiliates;

                                 - enter into sale lease-back transactions;

                                 - create dividend or other payment restrictions
                                   with respect to subsidiaries;

                                 - merge or consolidate; and

                                 - transfer or sell assets.

                                 These covenants are subject to a number of
                                 important exceptions.

                       RATIO OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES

     The following are the ratio of earnings to fixed charges for each of the
years in the five-year period ended December 31, 1998 and for the three months
ended March 31, 1998 and 1999.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                    THREE MONTHS
                                                       ENDED
                                                     MARCH 31,                   YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                   --------------      --------------------------------------------
                                                   1998      1999      1994      1995      1996      1997      1998
                                                   ----      ----      ----      ----      ----      ----      ----
<S>                                                <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges.............    2.0x      2.2x      3.8x      2.8x      2.7x      2.7x      2.1x
</TABLE>

                                  RISK FACTORS

     You should carefully consider each of the risk factors and all of the other
information set forth in this prospectus before deciding to participate in the
exchange offer.

                        FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

     Your exchange of an outstanding note for a new note will not constitute a
taxable exchange for U.S. federal income tax purposes. See the section titled
"Federal Income Tax Consequences" in this prospectus for more information.

                            ------------------------

     Our principal executive office is located at 23000 Euclid Avenue,
Cleveland, Ohio 44117, and our telephone number is (216) 692-7200.

                                        6
<PAGE>   12

          SUMMARY HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

     The summary historical consolidated financial data set forth below for the
three years ended December 31, 1998 have been derived from our consolidated
financial statements. Our consolidated financial statements for the three years
ended December 31, 1998 have been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent
auditors. The summary historical consolidated financial data for the three-month
periods ended March 31, 1998 and 1999 have been derived from our unaudited
consolidated financial statements, which include all adjustments (consisting of
normal recurring accruals) that we consider necessary for a fair presentation of
our financial position and results of operations for these periods. You should
read the following data in conjunction with "Management's Discussion and
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," our consolidated
financial statements and notes thereto, and other financial information included
elsewhere in this prospectus. The data for the periods presented are not
necessarily comparable because of acquisitions made throughout such periods. The
unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information for the year ended
December 31, 1998 and the three-month period ended March 31, 1999 has been
derived from the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial data included
elsewhere in this prospectus. The results of operations for the three months
ended March 31, 1999 are not necessarily indicative of results that may be
expected for any other interim period or for the year ending December 31, 1999.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                  PRO FORMA
                                                     HISTORICAL                           -------------------------
                             ----------------------------------------------------------      YEAR          THREE
                                       YEAR ENDED                THREE MONTHS ENDED          ENDED        MONTHS
                                      DECEMBER 31,                    MARCH 31,            DECEMBER        ENDED
                             ------------------------------   -------------------------       31,        MARCH 31,
                               1996       1997       1998        1998          1999         1998(B)        1999
                             --------   --------   --------   -----------   -----------   -----------   -----------
                                                              (UNAUDITED)   (UNAUDITED)   (UNAUDITED)   (UNAUDITED)
<S>                          <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
SELECTED INCOME STATEMENT
  DATA:
Net sales..................  $347,679   $441,110   $551,793    $136,503      $171,403      $697,872      $171,403
Cost of products sold......   289,400    368,734    455,167     113,171       140,436       573,735       140,436
                             --------   --------   --------    --------      --------      --------      --------
  Gross profit.............    58,279     72,376     96,626      23,332        30,967       124,137        30,967
Selling, general and
  administrative
  expenses.................    38,131     44,396     56,318      14,137        17,952        74,314        17,952
Operating income(a)........    17,496     27,980     40,308       9,195        13,015        49,823        13,015
Interest expense...........     6,947      9,101     17,488       4,152         5,378        23,370(c)      5,842(c)
OTHER FINANCIAL DATA:
Net cash flows provided
  (used) by operating
  activities...............  $  7,726   $(10,039)  $  4,132    $(11,938)     $ 10,926
Net cash flows provided
  (used) by investing
  activities...............    31,611    (77,217)   (62,957)     (6,355)      (35,896)
Net cash flows provided
  (used) by financing
  activities...............   (37,340)    84,411     61,331      17,262        25,132
EBITDA(d)..................    28,146     38,345     53,061      12,926        17,999      $ 68,763      $ 17,999
Depreciation and
  amortization.............     7,998     10,365     12,753       3,731         4,984        18,940         4,984
Capital expenditures.......    15,590     15,947     22,681       6,254         6,304        26,195         6,304
Ratio of earnings to fixed
  charges(e)...............       2.7x       2.7x       2.1x        2.0x          2.2x          2.0x          2.1x
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              AS OF MARCH 31, 1999
                                                              --------------------
                                                                   HISTORICAL
                                                              --------------------
                                                                  (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                           <C>
SELECTED BALANCE SHEET DATA:
Cash and cash equivalents...................................        $  4,482
Working capital, as adjusted (f)............................         159,877
Total assets................................................         565,281
Total debt..................................................         270,316
Shareholder's equity........................................         145,439
</TABLE>

(See footnotes on following page)
                                        7
<PAGE>   13

     NOTES TO SUMMARY HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

(a) Operating income is defined as net sales less cost of products sold,
    selling, general and administrative expenses and a restructuring charge. In
    1996, we incurred a restructuring charge of $2.7 million relating to the
    consolidation of three of our consumer products manufacturing facilities
    into one and the discontinuance of certain of our product lines.

(b) Reflects the operating results of our recent acquisitions from the periods
    prior to their respective closing dates and certain cost savings that we
    believe would have been realized and certain estimated incremental expenses
    relating to selling, general and administrative expenses and amortization of
    intangible assets that would have been incurred had we consummated our
    recent acquisitions as of January 1, 1998.

(c) Reflects an interest rate of 9.25% on the notes.

(d) EBITDA is defined as earnings from continuing operations before interest,
    income taxes, depreciation, amortization, other income and non-recurring
    items. Non-recurring items include a restructuring charge of $2.7 million in
    the fourth quarter of 1996 relating to the consolidation of three of our
    consumer products manufacturing facilities into one and the discontinuance
    of certain product lines. EBITDA is not a measure of performance under GAAP.
    While EBITDA should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute for
    net income, cash flows from operating activities and other income or cash
    flow statement data prepared in accordance with GAAP or as a measure of
    profitability or liquidity, we understand that EBITDA is customarily used as
    an indication of a company's ability to incur and service debt. You should
    read the "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and
    Results of Operations" sections included elsewhere in this prospectus for a
    discussion of other measures of liquidity and operations that are covered by
    our consolidated financial statements. EBITDA as defined by us may not be
    comparable to other similarly titled measures of other companies.

(e) Earnings are defined as earnings from continuing operations before income
    taxes and fixed charges. Fixed charges are defined as interest expense and a
    portion of rental expense representing the interest factor, which we
    estimate to be one-third of rental expense, and amortization of deferred
    financing costs and premium on the notes.

(f) Working capital, as adjusted, is defined as total current assets excluding
    cash and cash equivalents less total current liabilities excluding current
    portion of long-term debt.

                                        8
<PAGE>   14

                                  RISK FACTORS

     You should carefully consider each of the following factors and all of the
other information set forth in this prospectus before deciding to participate in
the exchange offer.

RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH THE NOTES

WE HAVE SUBSTANTIAL DEBT THAT COULD PREVENT US FROM FULFILLING OUR OBLIGATIONS
UNDER THESE NOTES.

     We have a substantial amount of outstanding debt. At March 31, 1999, we
would have had $271.3 million of debt after issuing the Series C notes,
representing approximately 65% of our total capitalization. Our substantial debt
may have important consequences to you. For example it could:

     - limit our ability to obtain additional financing for acquisitions,
       working capital, capital expenditures or other purposes;

     - require us to dedicate a substantial portion of our cash flow to pay our
       interest expense and debt amortization, which will reduce the funds that
       would otherwise be available to us for our operations and future business
       opportunities;

     - limit our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our
       business and the industries in which we operate;

     - place us at a competitive disadvantage compared to our competitors that
       have less debt;

     - increase our vulnerability to general adverse economic and industry
       conditions; and

     - make it more difficult for us to satisfy our obligations with respect to
       the notes.

     Our ability to pay interest on the notes and to satisfy our other debt
obligations will depend in part upon the future financial and operating
performance of our subsidiaries and upon our ability to renew or refinance
borrowings or to raise additional equity capital. Prevailing economic conditions
and financial, business and other factors, many of which are beyond our control,
will affect our ability to make these payments. While we believe that cash flow
from operations will provide an adequate source of long-term liquidity, a
significant drop in operating cash flow resulting from economic conditions,
competition or other uncertainties beyond our control would increase the need
for alternative sources of liquidity. If we are unable to generate sufficient
cash flow to meet our debt service obligations, we will have to pursue one or
more alternatives, such as:

     - reducing or delaying capital expenditures;

     - refinancing debt;

     - selling assets; or

     - raising equity capital.

     We cannot assure you that any of those alternatives could be accomplished
on satisfactory terms, if at all, or that those actions would yield sufficient
funds to retire the notes and the debt senior to the notes.

ADDITIONAL BORROWINGS ARE AVAILABLE -- THE RISKS DESCRIBED ABOVE COULD INCREASE
IF WE BORROW MORE MONEY THROUGH OUR REVOLVING CREDIT FACILITY.

     Despite our high level of debt, our revolving credit facility and the
indentures governing the Series B notes and the Series C notes permit us to
borrow additional money. Any additional debt could rank senior in right of
payment to the notes. If we borrow more money, as we intend to do in order to
make acquisitions, the related risks described above could be significantly
increased.

THE NOTES WILL BE CONTRACTUALLY SUBORDINATED IN RIGHT OF PAYMENT TO ALL OF OUR
SENIOR DEBT.

     The notes will be unsecured and rank behind all of our existing and future
senior debt, including our obligations under our revolving credit facility. Our
debt under the revolving credit facility will also become due

                                        9
<PAGE>   15

prior to the time the principal obligations under the notes become due. As a
result of the subordination provisions of the notes, in the event of a
liquidation or insolvency, our assets will be available to pay obligations on
the notes only after all of our senior debt has been paid in full. After our
senior debt has been paid in full there may not be sufficient assets remaining
to pay amounts due on any or all of the notes then outstanding. If we incur any
additional senior subordinated debt, the holders of that debt would be entitled
to share ratably with the holders of the notes in any proceeds distributed in
connection with any insolvency, liquidation, reorganization, dissolution or
other winding-up. This right may have the effect of reducing the amount of
proceeds paid to holders of the notes.

     In addition, no payments may be made with respect to the principal of or
premium, if any, or interest on the notes if a payment default exists with
respect to our senior debt and, under certain circumstances, no payments may be
made with respect to the principal of, or interest on, the notes for a certain
period if a non-payment default exists with respect to the senior debt. See
"Description of the Notes -- Subordination."

SUBSTANTIAL RESTRICTIONS AND COVENANTS -- RESTRICTIONS AND COVENANTS IN OUR DEBT
AGREEMENTS LIMIT OUR ABILITY TO TAKE CERTAIN ACTIONS. WE HAVE LIMITED
FLEXIBILITY TO DO SOME CORPORATE FUNCTIONS.

     Our debt agreements, which consist of the indentures covering the Series B
notes and the Series C notes and our revolving credit facility, contain a number
of significant covenants that, among other things, limit our ability to:

     - incur additional debt or liens;

     - pay dividends or make certain other restricted payments;

     - make investments including the repurchase or redemption of either capital
       stock or our notes;

     - consummate asset sales;

     - enter into transactions with affiliates;

     - issue capital stock of a subsidiary or create dividend or other payment
       restrictions with respect to subsidiaries;

     - consolidate or merge with any person or transfer or sell all or
       substantially all of our assets;

     - make capital investments; and

     - alter the business we conduct.

     In addition, our revolving credit facility requires us to comply with
specific financial ratios and tests, under which we are required to achieve
specific financial and operating results. Our ability to comply with these
provisions may be affected by events beyond our control. A breach of any of
these covenants would result in a default under the revolving credit facility.
In the event of any default, depending on the actions taken by the lenders under
the revolving credit facility, we could be prohibited from making any payments
on the notes. In addition, our lenders could elect to declare all amounts
borrowed under the revolving credit facility, together with accrued interest
thereon, to be due and payable, which would be an event of default under the
indentures governing the Series B notes and the Series C notes. As a result of
the priority afforded the revolving credit facility, we cannot assure you that
we would have sufficient assets to pay debt then outstanding under the revolving
credit facility and the indentures. Any future refinancing of the revolving
credit facility is likely to contain similar restrictive covenants. See
"Description of Other Indebtedness -- Revolving Credit Facility."

FINANCING A CHANGE OF CONTROL OFFER -- WE MAY NOT HAVE THE ABILITY TO RAISE THE
FUNDS NECESSARY TO FINANCE A CHANGE OF CONTROL OFFER IF REQUIRED BY THE
INDENTURES.

     Upon the occurrence of a change of control, we will be required to make an
offer to purchase the notes at a price in cash equal to 101% of their aggregate
principal amount, plus any accrued and unpaid interest, to the date of
repurchase. Events involving a change of control may result in an event of
default under our revolving credit facility and other debt that may be incurred
in the future. This could result in an acceleration of the payment of that debt,
in which case the subordination provisions of the notes would require payment in
full of all senior debt

                                       10
<PAGE>   16

before we can repurchase or make other payments in respect of the notes. See
"Description of the Notes -- Change of Control Offer," "Description of the
Notes -- Subordination" and "Description of Other Indebtedness -- Revolving
Credit Facility." We cannot assure you that we would have sufficient resources
to repurchase the notes or pay our obligations if the debt under the revolving
credit facility or other future senior debt were accelerated upon the occurrence
of a change of control event. We cannot assure you that we will be able to
obtain the consent of the lenders under the revolving credit facility to enable
us to repurchase the notes.

OUR SUBSIDIARIES ARE NOT GUARANTORS -- YOUR RIGHT TO RECEIVE PAYMENTS ON THE
NOTES COULD BE ADVERSELY AFFECTED IF ANY OF OUR SUBSIDIARIES DECLARE BANKRUPTCY,
LIQUIDATE OR REORGANIZE.

     We are a holding company and conduct substantially all of our operations
through various direct and indirect subsidiaries. We depend upon our ability to
receive cash from our subsidiaries to meet our debt service and other
obligations, including obligations under the notes and the revolving credit
facility. Our subsidiaries are separate and distinct legal entities and will
have no obligation, contingent or otherwise, to pay any amounts due under the
notes. Our rights, and the rights of our creditors, including holders of the
notes, to participate in the distributions of the assets of any subsidiary upon
that subsidiary's liquidation or reorganization will be subject to the prior
claims of that subsidiary's creditors, including trade creditors. All of our
material, domestic subsidiaries guarantee our debt under the revolving credit
facility.

RISKS SPECIFIC TO PARK-OHIO AND OUR BUSINESS

DEPENDENCE ON THE AUTOMOTIVE AND TRUCK INDUSTRIES -- THE LOSS OF ANY OF OUR
MAJOR AUTOMOTIVE OR TRUCK CUSTOMERS COULD AFFECT OUR FINANCIAL HEALTH.

     We derived 19.6% and 14.9% of our net sales during 1998 from the automobile
and truck industries, respectively. Ford and Navistar, our two largest
customers, accounted for 7.5% and 5.4%, respectively of our total net sales for
the year ended December 31, 1998. The loss of a significant portion of business
to Ford, Navistar, or any of our other major automotive or truck customers could
have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, liquidity and results
of operations. Although we continually engage in efforts to improve and expand
our relationships with these customers, we cannot assure you that we will
maintain or improve these relationships or that we will continue to supply these
customers at current levels.

THE INDUSTRIES IN WHICH WE OPERATE ARE CYCLICAL AND ARE AFFECTED BY THE ECONOMY
IN GENERAL.

     We sell products to customers in industries that experience cyclicality in
demand for products, such as the construction, industrial equipment, electrical
equipment, plumbing and lawn and garden equipment industries. In addition, the
automotive and truck industries are highly cyclical and are affected by consumer
spending, general economic conditions and the impact of international trade. A
downturn in the domestic automotive or truck industry could have a material
adverse effect on our financial condition, liquidity and results of operations.

RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH INTEGRATING ACQUISITIONS -- WE MAY NOT BE SUCCESSFUL IN
INTEGRATING THE BUSINESSES OBTAINED IN CONNECTION WITH OUR RECENT ACQUISITIONS
OR FUTURE ACQUISITIONS.

     We believe we will realize substantial benefits from the successful
integration of our recent acquisitions. However, we cannot assure you that we
will be able to maintain or improve the operating results of the acquired
businesses or that they will be successfully integrated into our operations. We
continually evaluate potential acquisitions and intend to actively pursue
acquisition opportunities, some of which could be material to us. We may finance
future acquisitions from internally generated funds, bank borrowings, public
offerings or private placements of equity or debt securities, or a combination
of the foregoing. We cannot assure you that we will be able to make acquisitions
on terms favorable to us. If we complete any future acquisitions, we may
encounter various associated risks, including the possible inability to
integrate an acquired business into our operations, increased goodwill
amortization, diversion of management's attention and unanticipated problems or
liabilities, some or all of which could have a material adverse effect on our
operations and financial performance.

                                       11
<PAGE>   17

DEPENDENCE ON THIRD-PARTY SUPPLIERS AND MANUFACTURERS -- WE DEPEND UPON THIRD
PARTIES FOR SUBSTANTIALLY ALL OF OUR RAW MATERIALS AND COMPONENT PARTS.

     The Aluminum and Manufactured Products segments purchase substantially all
of their raw materials, principally metals and some component parts incorporated
into their products, and Integrated Logistics Solutions purchases substantially
all of its fasteners, from third-party suppliers and manufacturers. We believe
there are numerous available sources of supply for required raw materials and
component parts incorporated into our products with the exception of some
specialty fasteners. While we currently maintain alternative sources for raw
materials and these component parts, our businesses are subject to the risk of
price fluctuations and periodic delays in the delivery of specialty fasteners,
raw materials and component parts. Failure by suppliers to continue to supply us
with raw materials or these component parts on commercially reasonable terms, or
at all, would have a material adverse effect on us. We depend upon the ability
of these suppliers, among other things, to meet stringent performance and
quality specifications and to conform to delivery schedules. Failure by
third-party suppliers to comply with these and other requirements could have a
material adverse effect on our financial condition, liquidity and results of
operations.

COMPETITION -- WE OPERATE IN HIGHLY COMPETITIVE INDUSTRIES.

     The markets in which the Aluminum and Manufactured Products segments sell
their products are highly competitive. Some of our competitors are large
companies that have greater financial resources than we have. We believe that
the principal competitive factors for Aluminum and Manufactured Products are
product quality and conformity to customer specifications, design and
engineering capabilities, product development, timeliness of delivery and price.
The rapidly evolving nature of the markets in which we compete may attract new
entrants as they perceive opportunities, and our competitors may foresee the
course of market development more accurately than we do. In addition, our
competitors may develop products that are superior to our products or may adapt
more quickly than we do to new technologies or evolving customer requirements.

     Integrated Logistics Solutions competes with over 2,500 domestic full-line
industrial fastener distributors and other domestic distributors that offer
fasteners in addition to other products, as well as a number of fastener
manufacturers. In certain circumstances, some fastener manufacturers may sell
directly to original equipment manufacturers. Recent trends by original
equipment manufacturers to limit their number of outside vendors and moderate
growth in the industrial fastener industry have resulted in increased
competition as many manufacturers and distributors have reduced prices to
compete more effectively. We expect competitive pressures in our markets to
remain strong. These pressures arise from existing competitors, other companies
that may enter our existing or future markets and, in some cases, our customers,
which may decide to produce in-house items we sell. We cannot assure you that we
will be able to compete successfully with our competitors. Failure to compete
successfully could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition,
liquidity and results of operations.

POTENTIAL PRODUCT LIABILITY RISKS EXIST FROM THE PRODUCTS WHICH WE SELL.

     Our businesses expose us to potential product liability risks that are
inherent in the design, manufacture and sale of our products and products of
third-party vendors that we use or resell. While we currently maintain what we
believe to be suitable and adequate product liability insurance, we cannot
assure you that we will be able to maintain our insurance on acceptable terms or
that our insurance will provide adequate protection against potential
liabilities. In the event of a claim against us, a lack of sufficient insurance
coverage could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition,
liquidity and results of operations. Moreover, even if we maintain adequate
insurance, any successful claim could have a material adverse effect on our
financial condition, liquidity and results of operations.

ENVIRONMENTAL COMPLIANCE -- IF WE FAIL TO COMPLY WITH ENVIRONMENTAL LAWS AND
REGULATIONS, THEN WE MAY INCUR COSTS WHICH COULD HAVE A MATERIAL ADVERSE EFFECT
ON OUR FINANCIAL CONDITION.

     We are subject to a variety of environmental laws including those which
regulate the use, handling, treatment, storage, discharge and disposal of
substances and hazardous wastes used or generated in our manufacturing
processes. If we fail to comply with present and future environmental laws, we
could be subject to

                                       12
<PAGE>   18

future liabilities or the suspension of production. Environmental laws could
also restrict our ability to expand our facilities or could require us to
acquire costly equipment or to incur other significant expenses in connection
with our manufacturing processes. We believe compliance with existing laws and
the cost of remediation efforts will not have a material adverse impact on our
financial condition, liquidity and results of operations. However, material
future expenditures may be necessary if compliance standards change or material
unknown conditions are discovered. See "Business -- Environmental Regulations".

GOVERNMENT REGULATION -- PORTIONS OF OUR BUSINESS ARE SUBJECT TO REGULATION
UNDER THE FASTENER QUALITY ACT OF 1991.

     The Fastener Quality Act of 1991 regulates the manufacture, importation and
distribution of certain high-grade industrial fasteners in the United States.
The Fastener Act, which was signed into law on June 8, 1999, requires testing,
certification and recordkeeping requirements by the manufacturers, importers and
distributors of those fasteners. As a result, we and other fastener suppliers
are required to maintain records and product tracking systems and comply with
other requirements imposed during the implementation of the Fastener Act. We
have tracking and traceability systems, which, to date, have not materially
increased expenses. However, we cannot assure you that future regulations will
not materially increase our costs.

WE DEPEND HEAVILY ON OUR INFORMATION SYSTEMS -- IF OUR INFORMATION SYSTEMS FAIL,
OUR BUSINESS WILL BE MATERIALLY AFFECTED.

     We believe that our computer systems are an integral part of the Integrated
Logistics Solutions business, and to a lesser extent, the Aluminum and
Manufactured Products segments. We depend on our information systems to process
orders, manage inventory and accounts receivable collections, purchase products,
maintain cost-effective operations, route and re-route orders and provide
superior service to our customers. We cannot assure you that a disruption in the
operation of our information systems used by Integrated Logistics Solutions,
including the failure of the supply chain management software to function
properly, or those used by Aluminum and Manufactured Products will not occur.
Any such disruption could have a material adverse effect on our financial
condition, liquidity and results of operations.

LABOR RELATIONS -- SOME OF OUR EMPLOYEES BELONG TO LABOR UNIONS AND STRIKES OR
WORK STOPPAGES COULD ADVERSELY AFFECT OUR OPERATIONS.

     We are a party to 16 collective bargaining agreements with various labor
unions, two of which will expire in 1999. In the aggregate, under those
agreements we currently employ approximately 1,000 full-time employees. Our
inability to negotiate acceptable contracts with these unions could result in,
among other things, strikes, work stoppages or other slowdowns by the affected
workers and increased operating costs as a result of higher wages or benefits
paid to union members. In the last three years, we have experienced labor
strikes at one operating unit of our Manufactured Products segment. While we
consider our current relations with our employees to be good, if the unionized
workers were to engage in a strike, work stoppage or other slowdown, or other
employees were to become unionized, we could experience a significant disruption
of our operations and higher ongoing labor costs, which could have a material
adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

YEAR 2000 -- OUR FAILURE, OR THE FAILURE OF BUSINESSES ON WHICH WE RELY, TO BE
YEAR 2000 COMPLIANT COULD NEGATIVELY IMPACT OUR OPERATIONS.

     The year 2000 issue is the result of computer programs being written using
two digits rather than four to define the applicable year. Any of our computer
programs or hardware that have date-sensitive software or embedded chips may
recognize a date using "00" as the year 1900 rather than the year 2000. If we
and/or third parties on which we rely do not successfully update computer
systems to avoid this issue, we could experience system failures or
miscalculations, and, as a result, disruptions in our operations. The possible
consequences could include, among other things, a temporary inability to process
transactions, send invoices or engage in similar normal business activities.

                                       13
<PAGE>   19

     During 1996, we developed a task force to monitor and track year 2000
compliance at our operating units. The target for completion of all phases of
remediation and testing of our computer systems is the third quarter of this
year. We believe, based upon assessments and remediations of our systems
completed to date, that the year 2000 issue will not have a material effect on
our business operations, consolidated financial condition, cash flows or results
of operations. However, we cannot assure you that all phases of our internal
assessments and remediations will be completed on schedule. Moreover, we cannot
assure you that further testing of our systems will not reveal that the year
2000 issue may have potential material adverse effects on our business.

     Our task force also is reviewing the year 2000 compliance of our key
suppliers, customers and service providers in an effort to reduce the potential
adverse effect on our operations from non-compliance by those parties. This
review is expected to be completed by September 30, 1999. We cannot assure you,
however, that our assessment of our systems and those of third parties on which
we rely will be completed on schedule. Moreover, due to the general uncertainty
inherent in the year 2000 issues, we are unable to determine at this time
whether the consequences of year 2000 compliance failures by third parties with
whom we transact business would have a material adverse effect on our results of
operations or financial condition. Failure by these third parties to be year
2000 compliant, over which we have no control, could have a material adverse
effect on our operations.

RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH NOT PARTICIPATING IN THE EXCHANGE OFFER

ANY MARKET FOR THE OUTSTANDING NOTES IS LIKELY TO DECLINE AFTER THE COMPLETION
OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER.

     As outstanding notes are tendered and accepted in the exchange offer, the
principal amount of remaining outstanding Series C notes and Series B notes will
decrease. This decrease will reduce the liquidity of the trading market for
those outstanding notes. There can be no assurance that any trading market that
has developed for those outstanding notes will continue to exist after the
completion of the exchange offer. See "The Exchange Offer -- Consequences of
Failure to Exchange."

IF YOU DO NOT EXCHANGE YOUR OUTSTANDING SERIES C NOTES, YOU WILL REMAIN SUBJECT
TO TRANSFER RESTRICTIONS.

     Park-Ohio has not registered the outstanding Series C notes under the
federal securities laws. Outstanding Series C notes that are not exchanged and
remain outstanding after the completion of the exchange offer will remain
subject to the transfer restrictions under applicable securities laws. This
means that you will be able to transfer, sell or trade your outstanding notes
only through an exemption from the registration requirements of the federal
securities laws. See "The Exchange Offer -- Consequences of Failure to
Exchange."

                                       14
<PAGE>   20

                                USE OF PROCEEDS

     There will be no cash proceeds from the issuance of the new notes. The
proceeds from the issuance and sale of the outstanding notes were used to repay
$49.0 million of our borrowings under the revolving credit facility which were
used to complete recent acquisitions. As of March 31, 1999, the interest rate on
our revolving credit facility was approximately 6.0%. Subsequent to the offering
of the Series C notes, we borrowed approximately $30 million under our revolving
credit facility to complete the acquisition of Columbia Nut & Bolt and
Industrial Fasteners. See "Summary -- Recent Developments." For a description of
the terms of our revolving credit facility see "Description of Other
Indebtedness -- Revolving Credit Facility."

                                 CAPITALIZATION

     The following table sets forth the capitalization of our company as of
March 31, 1999, on an actual basis and on a pro forma basis after giving effect
to the offering of the notes. You should read the information in this table in
conjunction with the "Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Data,"
"Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Income Statement Data," and "Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations"
sections of this prospectus, as well as our consolidated financial statements
and the notes thereto, which are included in this prospectus.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               AS OF MARCH 31, 1999
                                                              -----------------------
                                                               ACTUAL      PRO FORMA
                                                              ---------    ----------
                                                              (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                                           <C>          <C>
Cash and cash equivalents...................................  $  4,482      $  4,482
                                                              ========      ========
Revolving credit facility(a)................................  $111,500      $ 62,500
Other debt(b)...............................................     8,816         8,816
Senior subordinated notes...................................   150,000       200,000
                                                              --------      --------
          Total debt........................................   270,316       271,316
Shareholder's equity........................................   145,439       145,439
                                                              --------      --------
          Total capitalization..............................  $415,755      $416,755
                                                              ========      ========
</TABLE>

- ---------------

(a) The revolving credit facility is a $150.0 million senior unsecured revolving
    credit facility. See "Description of Other Indebtedness -- Revolving Credit
    Facility."

(b) Other debt is comprised primarily of industrial revenue bonds, state loans
    and capital leases. See "Description of Other Indebtedness."

                                       15
<PAGE>   21

                SELECTED HISTORICAL CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

     The selected historical consolidated financial data set forth below for the
five years ended December 31, 1998 have been derived from our consolidated
financial statements. Our consolidated financial statements for the five years
ended December 31, 1998 have been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent
auditors. The selected historical consolidated financial data for the
three-month periods ended March 31, 1998 and 1999 have been derived from our
unaudited consolidated financial statements, which include all adjustments
(consisting of normal recurring accruals) that we consider necessary for a fair
presentation of our financial position and results of operations for these
periods. You should read the following data in conjunction with "Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," our
consolidated financial statements and notes thereto, and other financial
information included elsewhere in this prospectus. The data for the periods
presented are not necessarily comparable because of acquisitions made throughout
such periods. The results of operations for the three months ended March 31,
1999 are not necessarily indicative of results that may be expected for any
other interim period or for the year ending December 31, 1999.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                            THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                                YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,                         MARCH 31,
                                  ----------------------------------------------------   -------------------------
                                    1994       1995       1996       1997       1998        1998          1999
                                  --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   -----------   -----------
                                                                                         (UNAUDITED)   (UNAUDITED)
<S>                               <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>           <C>
SELECTED INCOME STATEMENT DATA:
Net sales.......................  $129,216   $289,501   $347,679   $441,110   $551,793    $136,503      $171,403
Cost of products sold...........   104,225    240,871    289,400    368,734    455,167     113,171       140,436
                                  --------   --------   --------   --------   --------    --------      --------
  Gross profit..................    24,991     48,630     58,279     72,376     96,626      23,332        30,967
Selling, general and
  administrative expenses.......    16,838     30,020     38,131     44,396     56,318      14,137        17,952
Restructuring charge............        --         --      2,652         --         --          --            --
                                  --------   --------   --------   --------   --------    --------      --------
  Operating income (a)..........     8,153     18,610     17,496     27,980     40,308       9,195        13,015
Other income....................        --       (214)    (4,204)(b)     (320)       --         --            --
Interest expense................     1,501      5,911      6,947      9,101     17,488       4,152         5,378
                                  --------   --------   --------   --------   --------    --------      --------
Income from continuing
  operations before income
  taxes.........................     6,652     12,913     14,753     19,199     22,820       5,043         7,637
Income taxes (benefit)..........    (1,826)    (6,900)     5,060      7,903      9,726       2,169         3,289
                                  --------   --------   --------   --------   --------    --------      --------
Income from continuing
  operations before
  extraordinary charge..........  $  8,478   $ 19,813   $  9,693   $ 11,296   $ 13,094    $  2,874      $  4,348
                                  ========   ========   ========   ========   ========    ========      ========
OTHER DATA:
Net cash flows provided (used)
  by operating activities.......  $  9,027   $ (3,992)  $  7,726   $(10,039)  $  4,132    $(11,938)     $ 10,926
Net cash flows provided (used)
  by investing activities.......   (16,772)   (49,425)    31,611    (77,217)   (62,957)     (6,355)      (35,896)
Net cash flows provided (used)
  by financing activities.......     9,784     53,907    (37,340)    84,411     61,331      17,262        25,132
EBITDA (c)......................    11,366     24,888     28,146     38,345     53,061      12,926        17,999
Capital expenditures............    11,749     13,632     15,590     15,947     22,681       6,254         6,304
Ratio of earnings to fixed
  charges (d)...................       3.8x       2.8x       2.7x       2.7x       2.1x        2.0x          2.2x
</TABLE>

   See accompanying Notes to Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Data.
                                       16
<PAGE>   22

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                    AS OF DECEMBER 31,                         AS OF MARCH 31,
                                   ----------------------------------------------------   -------------------------
                                     1994       1995       1996       1997       1998        1998          1999
                                   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   -----------   -----------
                                                                                          (UNAUDITED)   (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>           <C>
SELECTED BALANCE SHEET DATA:
Cash and cash equivalents........  $  2,172   $  2,662   $  4,659   $  1,814   $  4,320    $    783      $  4,482
Working capital, as adjusted
  (e)............................    27,677     98,110    100,247    145,102    172,889     161,331       159,877
Total assets.....................   128,396    301,747    282,910    413,109    489,554     445,830       565,281
Total debt.......................    32,001    118,738     82,989    172,755    238,105     190,181       270,316
Shareholders' equity.............    46,530     95,542    115,069    129,010    140,842     134,196       145,439
</TABLE>

   See accompanying Notes to Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Data

            NOTES TO SELECTED HISTORICAL CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

(a) Operating income is defined as net sales less cost of products sold,
    selling, general and administrative expenses and a restructuring charge. In
    1996, we incurred a restructuring charge of $2.7 million relating to the
    consolidation of three of our consumer products manufacturing facilities
    into one and the discontinuance of certain or our product lines.

(b) In 1996, other income was comprised of:

    - a gain of $2.7 million in connection with the full settlement of
      subordinated notes receivable resulting from the sale of two manufacturing
      facilities; and

    - a gain of $1.5 million on the sale of certain securities by us in the
      third quarter of 1996.

(c) EBITDA is defined as earnings from continuing operations before interest,
    income taxes, depreciation, amortization, other income and non-recurring
    items. Non-recurring items include a restructuring charge of $2.7 million in
    the fourth quarter of 1996 relating to the consolidation of three of our
    consumer products manufacturing facilities into one and the discontinuance
    of certain product lines. EBITDA is not a measure of performance under GAAP.
    While EBITDA should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute for
    net income, cash flows from operating activities and other income or cash
    flow statement data prepared in accordance with GAAP or as a measure of
    profitability or liquidity, we understand that EBITDA is customarily used as
    an indication of a company's ability to incur and service debt. You should
    read the "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and
    Results of Operations" section in this prospectus for a discussion of other
    measures of liquidity and operations that are covered by our consolidated
    financial statements. EBITDA as defined by us may not be comparable to other
    similarly titled measures of other companies.

(d) Earnings are defined as earnings from continuing operations before income
    taxes and fixed charges. Fixed charges are defined as interest expense and a
    portion of rental expense representing the interest factor, which we
    estimate to be one-third of rental expense, and amortization of deferred
    financing costs and premium on the notes.

(e) Working capital, as adjusted, is defined as total current assets excluding
    cash and cash equivalents less total current liabilities excluding current
    portion of long-term debt.

                                       17
<PAGE>   23

             UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT DATA

     The following Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Income Statement Data are
adjusted to give effect to our recent acquisitions and the consummation of the
offering of the notes as if these events occurred as of the beginning of the
periods presented. The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Income Statement Data
combine our historical operating results with the historical operating results
of our recent acquisitions prior to the dates we made such acquisitions using
the purchase method of accounting. The pro forma operating results are presented
for informational purposes only and are not necessarily indicative of the
operating results that we would have achieved had these acquisitions actually
occurred at the beginning of each period presented, nor do they necessarily
indicate results of future operations.

     The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Income Statement Data are based on the
assumptions set forth in the notes to such statements, and you should read them
in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements and notes thereto
included elsewhere in this prospectus.

                                       18
<PAGE>   24

             UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT DATA
                   FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1999
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                         HISTORICAL    REFINANCING     PRO FORMA
                                                         COMPANY(A)    ADJUSTMENTS    AS ADJUSTED
                                                         ----------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                      <C>           <C>            <C>
SELECTED INCOME STATEMENT DATA:
Net sales..............................................   $171,403        $  --        $171,403
Cost of products sold..................................    140,436           --         140,436
                                                          --------        -----        --------
  Gross profit.........................................     30,967           --          30,967
Selling, general and administrative expenses...........     17,952           --          17,952
                                                          --------        -----        --------
  Operating income.....................................     13,015           --          13,015
Interest expense.......................................      5,378          464 (b)       5,842
                                                          --------        -----        --------
  Income before income taxes...........................      7,637         (464)          7,173
Income taxes...........................................      3,289         (176)(c)       3,113
                                                          --------        -----        --------
  Net income...........................................   $  4,348        $(288)       $  4,060
                                                          ========        =====        ========
OTHER FINANCIAL DATA:
Operating income.......................................   $ 13,015        $  --        $ 13,015
Plus: Depreciation and amortization....................      4,984           --           4,984
                                                          --------        -----        --------
EBITDA (d).............................................   $ 17,999        $  --        $ 17,999
                                                          ========        =====        ========
Capital expenditures...................................   $  6,304        $  --        $  6,304
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges (e).................        2.2x          --             2.1x
</TABLE>

  See accompanying Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Income Statement
                                     Data.

                                       19
<PAGE>   25

        NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT DATA
                   FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1999
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

     (a) Historical results for the three-month period ended March 31, 1999
         include the results for Metalloy, St. Louis Screw and Bolt and PMC from
         their respective dates of acquisition. Our acquisition of Metalloy
         occurred on January 4, 1999. Our acquisition of St. Louis Screw and
         Bolt on January 29, 1999 was considered effective January 1, 1999 and
         PMC was not operating in 1999 until we acquired it. Acquisition
         adjustments are therefore not required for these three acquisitions. As
         the acquisitions of Columbia Nut & Bolt and Industrial Fasteners did
         not take place until July 1999, and are not material to Park-Ohio,
         their results have not been included in the pro forma financial
         statements.

     (b) Reflects the following adjustments to interest expense:

<TABLE>
    <S>                                                             <C>
         Interest expense -- notes offered hereby(1)............    $1,156
         Interest expense -- existing notes(2)..................     3,469
         Interest expense -- revolving credit facility(3).......       937
         Interest expense -- other debt.........................       109
         Amortization of deferred financing fees, net of premium
          on notes..............................................       171
                                                                    ------
         Pro forma interest expense.............................     5,842
         Less: historical interest expense......................     5,378
                                                                    ------
              Total adjustment..................................    $  464
                                                                    ======
</TABLE>

        (1) Reflects an interest rate of 9.25%.

        (2) Reflects an interest rate of 9.25%.

        (3) Reflects the current interest rate of 6.00%.

     (c) Adjustment necessary to reflect income tax expense at our incremental
         effective income tax rate of 38%.

     (d) EBITDA is defined as earnings from continuing operations before
         interest, income taxes, depreciation and amortization. EBITDA is not a
         measure of performance under GAAP. While EBITDA should not be
         considered in isolation or as a substitute for net income, cash flows
         from operating activities and other income or cash flow statement data
         prepared in accordance with GAAP or as a measure of profitability or
         liquidity, we understand that EBITDA is customarily used as an
         indication of a company's ability to incur and service debt. You should
         read the "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
         and Results of Operations" section included elsewhere in this
         prospectus for a discussion of other measures of liquidity and
         operations that are covered by our consolidated financial statements.
         EBITDA as defined by us may not be comparable to other similarly titled
         measures of other companies.

     (e) Earnings are defined as earnings from continuing operations before
         income taxes and fixed charges. Fixed charges are defined as interest
         expense and a portion of rental expense representing the interest
         factor, which we estimate to be one-third of rental expense, and
         amortization of deferred financing costs and premium on the notes.

                                       20
<PAGE>   26

             UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT DATA
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1998
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                     HISTORICAL
                            ----------------------------
                                             RECENT         ACQUISITION     PRO FORMA   REFINANCING    PRO FORMA
                            COMPANY(a)   ACQUISITIONS(b)   ADJUSTMENTS(c)    COMPANY    ADJUSTMENTS   AS ADJUSTED
                            ----------   ---------------   --------------   ---------   -----------   -----------
<S>                         <C>          <C>               <C>              <C>         <C>           <C>
SELECTED INCOME STATEMENT
  DATA:
Net sales.................   $551,793       $146,079         $       --     $697,872     $      --     $697,872
Cost of products sold.....    455,167        119,737             (1,169)(d)  573,735            --      573,735
                             --------       --------         ----------     --------     ---------     --------
  Gross profit............     96,626         26,342              1,169      124,137            --      124,137
Selling, general and
  administrative
  expenses................     56,318         21,746             (4,508)(e)   74,314            --       74,314
                                   --             --                758(f)        --            --           --
                             --------       --------         ----------     --------     ---------     --------
  Operating income........     40,308          4,596              4,919       49,823            --       49,823
Interest expense..........     17,488          3,304                 --       20,792         2,578(g)    23,370
                             --------       --------         ----------     --------     ---------     --------
  Income before income
    taxes.................     22,820          1,292              4,919       29,031        (2,578)      26,453
Income taxes..............      9,726            396              1,869(h)    11,991          (980)(h)   11,011
                             --------       --------         ----------     --------     ---------     --------
  Net income..............   $ 13,094       $    896         $    3,050     $ 17,040     $  (1,598)    $ 15,442
                             ========       ========         ==========     ========     =========     ========
OTHER FINANCIAL DATA:
Operating income..........   $ 40,308       $  4,596         $    4,919     $ 49,823     $      --     $ 49,823
Plus: Depreciation and
  amortization............     12,753          5,429                758       18,940            --       18,940
                             --------       --------         ----------     --------     ---------     --------
EBITDA (i)................   $ 53,061       $ 10,025         $    5,677     $ 68,763     $      --     $ 68,763
                             ========       ========         ==========     ========     =========     ========
Capital expenditures......   $ 22,681       $  3,514         $       --     $ 26,195     $      --     $ 26,195
Ratio of earnings to fixed
  charges (j).............        2.1x            --                 --           --            --          2.0x
</TABLE>

  See accompanying Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Income Statement
                                     Data.

                                       21
<PAGE>   27

        NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT DATA
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1998
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

     (a) Historical results for the year ended December 31, 1998 include the
         results for Direct as of April 14, 1998 and Gateway as of October 8,
         1998.

     (b) The following table reflects the operating results of our recent
         acquisitions from January 1, 1998 to the earlier of their respective
         dates of acquisition or December 31, 1998 (As the acquisition of
         Columbia Nut & Bolt and Industrial Fasteners did not take place until
         July 1999, and are not material to Park-Ohio, their results have not
         been included in the pro forma financial statements.):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 ST. LOUIS
                                                                                   SCREW
                                                DIRECT    GATEWAY    METALLOY    AND BOLT       PMC       TOTAL
                                                ------    -------    --------    ---------    -------    --------
          <S>                                   <C>       <C>        <C>         <C>          <C>        <C>
          SELECTED INCOME STATEMENT DATA:
          Net sales...........................  $2,046    $32,093    $94,789      $6,772      $10,379    $146,079
          Cost of products sold...............   1,309    19,411      86,173       5,516        7,328     119,737
                                                ------    -------    -------      ------      -------    --------
          Gross profit........................     737    12,682       8,616       1,256        3,051      26,342
          Selling, general and administrative
            expenses..........................     420    10,393       6,048       1,233        3,652      21,746
                                                ------    -------    -------      ------      -------    --------
          Operating income (loss).............     317     2,289       2,568          23         (601)      4,596
          Interest expense....................      --       396         873          --        2,035       3,304
                                                ------    -------    -------      ------      -------    --------
          Income (loss) before income taxes...     317     1,893       1,695          23       (2,636)      1,292
          Income taxes........................      12        --         384          --           --         396
                                                ------    -------    -------      ------      -------    --------
          Net income (loss)...................  $  305    $1,893     $ 1,311      $   23      $(2,636)   $    896
                                                ======    =======    =======      ======      =======    ========
          OTHER FINANCIAL DATA:
          EBITDA..............................  $  323    $2,685     $ 7,315      $   61      $  (359)   $ 10,025
          Depreciation and amortization.......       6       396       4,747          38          242       5,429
          Capital expenditures................      --     1,380       1,893          94          147       3,514
</TABLE>

     (c) Reflects adjustments for certain cost savings that we believe would
         have been realized and certain estimated incremental expenses relating
         to selling, general and administrative expenses and amortization of
         intangible assets that would have been incurred had we consummated our
         recent acquisitions as of January 1, 1998.

     (d) Reflects a cost saving adjustment of $1,169 to cost of products sold
         due to the elimination of duplicative operating personnel in
         conjunction with our recent acquisitions.

     (e) Reflects the following cost saving adjustments to selling, general and
         administrative expenses in conjunction with our recent acquisitions:

<TABLE>
    <S>                                                             <C>
         Elimination of duplicative personnel...................    $3,299
         Reduction in insurance and pension costs...............       834
         Elimination of compensation to previous owners.........       375
                                                                    ------
              Total adjustment..................................    $4,508
                                                                    ======
</TABLE>

     (f) Reflects additional amortization of goodwill over 40 years as a result
         of our recent acquisitions.

                                       22
<PAGE>   28

     (g) Reflects the following adjustments to interest expense:

<TABLE>
    <S>                                                             <C>
         Interest expense -- notes offered hereby(1)............    $ 4,625
         Interest expense -- existing notes(2)..................     13,875
         Interest expense -- revolving credit facility(3).......      3,750
         Interest expense -- other debt.........................        436
         Amortization of deferred financing fees, net of premium
          on notes..............................................        684
                                                                    -------
         Pro forma interest expense.............................     23,370
         Less: historical interest expense......................     20,792
                                                                    -------
              Total adjustment..................................    $ 2,578
                                                                    =======
</TABLE>

        (1) Reflects an interest rate of 9.25%.

        (2) Reflects an interest rate of 9.25%.

        (3) Reflects the current interest rate of 6.00%.

     (h) Adjustment necessary to reflect income tax expense at our incremental
         effective income tax rate of 38%.

     (i) EBITDA is defined as earnings from continuing operations before
         interest, income taxes, depreciation and amortization. EBITDA is not a
         measure of performance under GAAP. While EBITDA should not be
         considered in isolation or as a substitute for net income, cash flows
         from operating activities and other income or cash flow statement data
         prepared in accordance with GAAP or as a measure of profitability or
         liquidity, we understand that EBITDA is customarily used as an
         indication of a company's ability to incur and service debt. You should
         read the "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
         and Results of Operations" section included elsewhere in this
         prospectus for a discussion of other measures of liquidity and
         operations that are covered by our consolidated financial statements.
         EBITDA as defined by us may not be comparable to other similarly titled
         measures of other companies.

     (j) Earnings are defined as earnings from continuing operations before
         income taxes and fixed charges. Fixed charges are defined as interest
         expense and a portion of rental expense representing the interest
         factor, which we estimate to be one-third of rental expense, and
         amortization of deferred financing costs and premium on the notes.

                                       23
<PAGE>   29

                               THE EXCHANGE OFFER

PURPOSE AND EFFECT OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER

     We sold the Series C notes to the initial purchasers on June 2, 1999. As a
condition to the sale of those notes, we entered into a registration rights
agreement which requires us, unless not permitted by applicable law or
Securities and Exchange Commission policy, to:

     - file with the SEC a registration statement under the Securities Act with
       respect to the new notes within 45 days after June 2, 1999;

     - use our best efforts to cause that registration statement to become
       effective under the Securities Act within 130 days after June 2, 1999;
       and

     - upon effectiveness of the registration statement, commence the exchange
       offer and keep it open for at least 30 days (or a longer period if
       required by law) and deliver to the exchange agent new notes in the same
       aggregate principal amount as the outstanding notes that were tendered by
       holders in the exchange offer.

     A copy of the registration rights agreement has been filed as an exhibit to
the registration statement which was filed with the SEC. The registration
statement also includes this prospectus.

     You are a holder, or a person to whom this exchange offer is made, if you
are a person in whose name any outstanding notes are registered on Park-Ohio's
books or if you have obtained a properly completed assignment of those notes
from a registered holder.

     In order to participate in the exchange offer, you must represent to
Park-Ohio that:

     - the new notes being acquired in the exchange offer are being obtained in
       the ordinary course of business of the person receiving those new notes;

     - neither you nor any other person receiving the new notes is engaging in
       or intends to engage in a distribution of the new notes;

     - neither you nor any other person receiving the new notes has an
       arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in the
       distribution of the new notes; and

     - neither you nor any other person receiving the new notes is an
       "affiliate" of Park-Ohio. An affiliate is any person who "controls, is
       controlled by, or is under the common control with," Park-Ohio.

RESALE OF THE NEW NOTES

     In exchange for properly tendered outstanding notes, the new notes will be
issued without a restrictive legend and may be reoffered and resold by the
holder without the restrictions and limitations imposed by the Securities Act of
1933 on the outstanding Series C notes. Outstanding notes that are not tendered
for exchange under the exchange offer will remain outstanding and holders of
those notes will be entitled to the rights as set forth in the indentures.
However, the holders of the outstanding notes will not retain any rights under
the registration rights agreement, including the right to receive additional
incremental interest on the outstanding notes in the event that the registration
statement has not been filed or become effective within specified time periods.
Untendered outstanding Series C notes will remain subject to the transfer
restrictions imposed by the Securities Act of 1933. See "Consequences of Failure
to Exchange."

     The conclusion that the new notes may be reoffered and resold by the holder
without transfer restrictions is based on previous interpretations by the Staff
of the SEC in no-action letters issued to third parties, including "Exxon
Capital Holdings Corporation" (available May 13, 1988), "Morgan Stanley & Co.
Incorporated" (the "Morgan Stanley Letter"), Mary Kay Cosmetics, Inc."
(available June 5, 1991), "Warnaco, Inc." (available October 11, 1991, and
"K-III Communications Corp." (available May 14, 1993). This conclusion also
relies on the representations described above that must be made by you and by
any other tendering holder before participating in the exchange offer.

                                       24
<PAGE>   30

     Any holder who tenders in the exchange offer with the intention of
participating in a distribution of the new notes cannot rely on this conclusion
and must comply with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of
the Securities Act of 1933 in connection with any resale transaction. If our
conclusion regarding resale of the new notes is inaccurate, holders who transfer
new notes in violation of the prospectus delivery provisions of the Securities
Act of 1933 and without an exemption from registration may incur liability. We
will not assume, or indemnify holders against, this liability.

     The exchange offer is not being made to, and we will not accept tenders
from, holders of outstanding notes in any jurisdiction where the exchange offer
or the acceptance of outstanding notes would not be in compliance with the
securities or blue sky laws of that jurisdiction.

SPECIAL RULES FOR BROKER-DEALERS

     Each broker-dealer that receives new notes for its own account in exchange
for outstanding notes, where the outstanding notes were acquired by that
broker-dealer as a result of market-making activities or other trading
activities, must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection
with any resale of new notes. In order to facilitate the disposition of new
notes by broker-dealers participating in the exchange offer, we have agreed, for
a period of 180 days following the expiration of the exchange offer and, subject
to specific conditions, to make this prospectus, as it may be amended or
supplemented from time to time, available for delivery by those broker-dealers
to satisfy their prospectus delivery obligations under the Securities Act.

TERMS OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER

     If the terms and conditions described in this prospectus and in the
accompanying Letter of Transmittal are met, we will accept any and all
outstanding notes validly tendered and not withdrawn prior to 5:00 p.m., New
York City time, on the expiration date.

     This prospectus, together with the Letter of Transmittal, is being sent to
all registered holders of the outstanding notes. There will be no fixed record
date for determining registered holders of the outstanding notes entitled to
participate in the exchange offer. Instead, holders of the outstanding notes
must tender their certificates or cause their outstanding notes to be tendered
by book-entry transfer prior to the expiration date in order to participate.

     The exchange agent, Norwest Bank, National Association will act as agent
for the tendering holders for the purposes of receiving new notes from
Park-Ohio. Park-Ohio will be deemed to have accepted validly tendered
outstanding notes when we have given oral or written notice to the exchange
agent. If any tendered outstanding notes are not accepted for exchange because
of an invalid tender or any other reason, certificates for those unaccepted
outstanding notes will be returned, without expense to the tendering holder, as
promptly as practicable after the expiration date of the exchange offer. Any
unaccepted outstanding notes tendered by book-entry transfer will be credited to
an account maintained with The Depository Trust Company, without expense to the
tendering holder, as promptly as practicable after the expiration date. See
"Procedures for Tendering."

     Holders who tender outstanding notes in the exchange offer will not be
required to pay brokerage commissions or fees or, subject to the instructions in
the accompanying Letter of Transmittal, transfer taxes with respect to the
exchange.

EXPIRATION DATE; EXTENSIONS; AMENDMENTS

     The expiration date will be 5:00 p.m., New York City time on August 26,
1999, unless, in our sole discretion, we extend the exchange offer. If extended,
the expiration date will then be the latest date and time to which the exchange
offer is extended.

     We will notify the exchange agent of any extension by oral (promptly
confirmed in writing) or written notice prior to 9:00 a.m., New York City time,
on the next business day after the previously schedule expiration date and will
also make a public announcement of any extension through a release to an
appropriate news agency.

                                       25
<PAGE>   31

     We reserve the right, in our sole discretion to:

     - delay accepting any outstanding notes,

     - extend the exchange offer, if any of the conditions set forth below under
       "Conditions" have not been satisfied,

     - terminate the exchange offer, if any of the conditions set forth below
       under "Conditions" have not been satisfied,

     - amend the terms of the exchange offer in any manner consistent with the
       registration rights agreement.

     Any delay in acceptances, extension, termination, or amendment of the
exchange offer will be followed as promptly as practicable by oral or written
notice to the registered holders. We have no obligation to publish, advertise or
otherwise communicate this notice other than our obligation to make a timely
release to a news agency.

     If the exchange offer is amended in a manner determined by us to constitute
a material change, we will promptly disclose that amendment in a prospectus
supplement that will be distributed to all registered holders. Depending upon
the significance of the amendment and the manner of disclosure to the registered
holders, we will also extend the exchange offer for a period of five to ten
business days, if the exchange offer would otherwise expire during that five to
ten business day period.

     Issuance of new notes in exchange for accepted outstanding notes will be
made only after the exchange agent receives:

     - certificates for the outstanding notes, or a timely confirmation of
       book-entry transfer of such outstanding notes into the exchange agent's
       account at The Depository Trust Company;

     - a properly completed and duly executed Letter of Transmittal; and

     - all other required documents.

     However, we reserve the absolute right to waive any defects or
irregularities in the tender of outstanding notes or in the satisfaction of
conditions of the exchange offer by a holder. If:

     - any tendered outstanding notes are not accepted for any reason;

     - the holder withdraws their previously tendered outstanding notes; or

     - outstanding notes are submitted for a greater principal amount of
       outstanding notes than the holder desires to exchange;

then any such unaccepted, withdrawn or portion of non-exchanged outstanding
notes will be returned as promptly as practicable after the expiration or
termination of the exchange offer without expense to the tendering holder. In
the case of outstanding notes tendered by book-entry transfer, such unaccepted,
withdrawn or portion of non-exchanged outstanding notes will be credited to an
account maintained with The Depository Trust Company without expense to the
tendering holder.

CONDITIONS

     We will not be required to exchange any new notes for outstanding notes,
and we may terminate the exchange offer before the acceptance of any outstanding
notes for exchange, if:

     - any action or proceeding is instituted or threatened in any court or by
       or before any governmental agency with respect to the exchange offer
       which, in our reasonable judgment, might materially impair our ability to
       proceed with the exchange offer;

     - any law, statute, rule or regulation is proposed, adopted or enacted, or
       any interpretation of any existing law, statute, rule or regulation is
       issued by the staff of the SEC, which, in our reasonable judgment, might
       materially impair our ability to proceed with the exchange offer; or

                                       26
<PAGE>   32

     - any governmental approval or approval by holders of the outstanding notes
       has not been obtained, if we deem, in our reasonable judgment, that such
       approval is necessary for the consummation of the exchange offer.

     If we determine in our sole discretion that any of these conditions are not
satisfied, we may:

     - refuse to accept any outstanding notes and return all tendered
       outstanding notes to the tendering holders, or, in the case of
       outstanding notes tendered by book-entry transfer, credit such
       outstanding notes to an account maintained with The Depository Trust
       Company;

     - extend the exchange offer and retain all outstanding notes tendered prior
       to the expiration of the exchange offer, subject to the rights of holders
       to withdraw their tender of outstanding notes; or

     - waive any unsatisfied conditions and accept all properly tendered
       outstanding notes that have not been withdrawn.

     See "-- Expiration Date; Extensions; Amendments."

PROCEDURES FOR TENDERING

     To tender in the exchange offer, a holder must:

     - complete, sign and date the Letter of Transmittal, or a facsimile;

     - have the signatures on the Letter of Transmittal guaranteed if required
       by the Letter of Transmittal, and

     - mail or otherwise deliver the Letter of Transmittal or facsimile to the
       exchange agent before the expiration date.

     In addition, a holder must comply with the guaranteed delivery procedures
described below if:

     - certificates for outstanding notes and the Letter of Transmittal will not
       be received by the exchange agent before the expiration date; or

     - a timely confirmation of book-entry transfer of outstanding notes into
       the exchange agent's account at The Depository Trust Company will not be
       received by the exchange agent before the expiration date.

     To be effectively tendered, the Letter of Transmittal and other required
documents must be received by the exchange agent at the address set forth below
under "-- Exchange Agent" before the expiration date.

     A tender by a holder of outstanding notes that is not withdrawn before the
expiration date will constitute an agreement between Park-Ohio and the holder in
accordance with the terms, and subject to the conditions, set forth in this
prospectus and in the Letter of Transmittal.

     THE METHOD OF DELIVERY OF OUTSTANDING NOTES AND THE LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL
AND ALL OTHER REQUIRED DOCUMENTS TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT IS AT YOUR ELECTION AND
RISK. INSTEAD OF DELIVERY BY MAIL, YOU SHOULD USE AN OVERNIGHT OR HAND DELIVERY
SERVICE, PROPERLY INSURED. IN ALL CASES, SUFFICIENT TIME SHOULD BE ALLOWED TO
ASSURE DELIVERY TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT BEFORE THE EXPIRATION DATE. DO NOT SEND
THE LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL OR OUTSTANDING NOTES TO PARK-OHIO. YOU MAY REQUEST
THAT YOUR RESPECTIVE BROKERS, DEALERS, COMMERCIAL BANKS, TRUST COMPANIES, OR
NOMINEES TENDER YOUR OUTSTANDING NOTES FOR YOU.

     If you are a beneficial owner whose outstanding notes are registered in the
name of a broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company, or other nominee, and
you wish to tender your outstanding notes, you should contact the registered
holder promptly and instruct the registered holder to tender your outstanding
notes on your behalf. If you are a beneficial owner and wish to tender your
outstanding notes on your own behalf, you must, before completing and executing
the Letter of Transmittal and delivering your outstanding notes, either make
appropriate arrangements to register ownership of the outstanding notes in your
name or obtain a properly completed assignment from the registered holder. The
transfer of registered ownership of outstanding notes may take a long time.

                                       27
<PAGE>   33

     Signatures on a Letter of Transmittal or a notice of withdrawal must be
guaranteed by an eligible institution unless the outstanding notes are

     - tendered by a registered holder who has not completed the box entitled
       "Special Payment Instructions" or "Special Delivery Instructions" on the
       Letter of Transmittal; or

     - tendered for the account of an eligible institution.

If signatures on a Letter of Transmittal or a notice of withdrawal are required
to be guaranteed, the guarantor must be an eligible institution. Eligible
institutions include:

     - a member firm of a registered national securities exchange;

     - a member firm of the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc.;

     - a commercial bank having an office or correspondent in the U.S.; and

     - an "eligible guarantor institution" within the meaning of Rule 17Ad-15
       under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

     If the Letter of Transmittal is signed by a person other than the
registered holder, those outstanding notes must be endorsed or accompanied by a
properly completed bond power. The bond power must be signed by the registered
holder as their name appears on their outstanding notes.

     If the Letter of Transmittal, any outstanding notes or any bond power is
signed by trustees, executors, administrators, guardians, attorneys-in-fact,
officers of corporations or others acting in a fiduciary or representative
capacity, those persons should indicate their capacity when signing. Unless
waived, evidence satisfactory to us of that person's authority to act must be
submitted with the Letter of Transmittal.

     All questions as to the validity, form, eligibility, time of receipt,
acceptance of tendered outstanding notes, and withdrawal of tendered outstanding
notes will be determined by us in our sole discretion, which will be final and
binding. We reserve the absolute right to reject any and all outstanding notes
not properly tendered. Our interpretation of the terms and conditions of the
exchange offer, including the instructions in the Letter of Transmittal, will be
final and binding on all parties.

     Unless waived, any defects or irregularities in connection with tenders of
outstanding notes must be cured within the time period we designate. Although we
intend to notify holders of defects or irregularities in the tender of
outstanding notes, neither we, nor the exchange agent or any other person will
be liable for failure to give such notification. Tenders of outstanding notes
will not be deemed to have been made until all defects or irregularities have
been cured or waived. Any outstanding notes received by the exchange agent that
are not properly tendered and as to which the defects or irregularities have not
been cured or waived will be returned by the exchange agent to the exchange
agent to the tendering holders, unless otherwise provided in the Letter of
Transmittal, as soon as practicable following the expiration date.

     In addition, we reserve the right, in our sole discretion, to purchase or
make offers for any outstanding notes that remain outstanding subsequent to the
expiration date. To the extent permitted by applicable law and the terms of our
agreements relating to our outstanding indebtedness, we may purchase outstanding
notes in the open market, in privately negotiated transactions or otherwise. The
terms of any such purchases or offers could differ from the terms of the
exchange offer.

BOOK-ENTRY TRANSFER

     The exchange agent will make a request to establish an account for the
outstanding notes at The Depository Trust Company for the purposes of the
exchange offer within two business days after the date of this prospectus. Any
financial institution that is a participant in The Depository Trust Company's
system may make book-entry delivery of outstanding notes by causing The
Depository Trust Company to transfer such outstanding notes into the exchange
agent's account at The Depository Trust Company in accordance with its transfer
procedures. Even

                                       28
<PAGE>   34

though delivery of outstanding notes may be effected through book-entry transfer
at The Depository Trust Company,

     - a holder must comply with the guaranteed delivery procedures described
       below; or

     - the Letter of Transmittal or a facsimile, with any required signature
       guarantees and any other required documents, must be received by the
       exchange agent at the address set forth below under "Exchange Agent" on
       or before the expiration date.

     Delivery of documents to The Depository Trust Company in accordance with
its procedures does not constitute delivery to the exchange agent.

GUARANTEED DELIVERY PROCEDURES

     If your outstanding notes are not immediately available or you are unable
to deliver your outstanding notes, the Letter of Transmittal, or any other
required documents to the exchange agent prior to the expiration date, you may
effect a tender if:

     - the tender is made through an eligible institution; and

     - before the expiration date, the exchange agent receives from an eligible
       institution a properly completed and duly executed "Notice of Guaranteed
       Delivery" substantially in the form provided by us which

        - states the name and address of the holder;

        - states the certificate number(s) of such outstanding notes;

        - states the principal amount of outstanding notes tendered;

        - states that the tender is being made through the guaranteed delivery
          procedures; and

        - guarantees that, within three New York Stock Exchange trading days
          after the expiration date, the following documents will be deposited
          by the eligible institution with the exchange agent:

           - the Letter of Transmittal, or a facsimile thereof; and

           - the certificate(s) representing the outstanding notes in proper
             form for transfer or a confirmation of book-entry transfer; and

           - any other documents required by the Letter of Transmittal; and

        - a properly completed and executed Letter of Transmittal, or a
          facsimile, the certificate(s) representing all tendered outstanding
          notes in proper form for transfer and all other documents required by
          the Letter of Transmittal are received by the exchange agent within
          three New York Stock Exchange trading days after the expiration date
          of the exchange offer.

     Upon request, the exchange agent will send a Notice of Guaranteed Delivery
to holders who wish to tender their outstanding notes according to the
guaranteed delivery procedures set forth above.

WITHDRAWAL OF TENDERS

     Except as otherwise provided herein, tenders of outstanding notes may be
withdrawn at any time prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the expiration
date of the exchange offer.

     To withdraw a tender of outstanding notes, a written or facsimile
transmission of a notice of withdrawal must be received by the exchange agent at
its address set forth in this prospectus prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time,
on the expiration date. Any notice of withdrawal must:

     - specify the name of the person who deposited the outstanding notes that
       are being withdrawn;

     - identify the tendered outstanding notes to be withdrawn, including the
       certificate number(s);

     - be signed by the holder in the same manner as the original signature on
       the Letter of Transmittal by which the outstanding notes were tendered,
       including any required signature guarantees, or be accompanied by
       documents of transfer sufficient to have the exchange agent register the
       transfer of such outstanding notes in the name of the person withdrawing
       the tender;

                                       29
<PAGE>   35

     - specify the name in which any outstanding notes are to be registered, if
       different from that of the person who deposited the notes to be
       withdrawn; and

     - any outstanding notes so withdrawn will be deemed not to have been
       validly tendered for purposes of the exchange offer, and no new notes
       will be issued unless the withdrawn outstanding notes are validly
       retendered. Properly withdrawn outstanding notes may be retendered by
       following one of the procedures described above under "-- Procedures for
       Tendering" at any time prior to the expiration date.

TERMINATION OF RIGHTS ACCORDED BY THE REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT

     All rights under the registration rights agreement accorded to holders of
outstanding notes will terminate upon the consummation of the exchange offer.
However, Park-Ohio will be obligated:

          - to keep the registration statement effective until the closing of
            the exchange offer; and

          - for up to 180 days after the expiration date, to provide copies of
            the latest version of this prospectus to any broker-dealer that
            requests copies of the prospectus for use in connection with any
            resale of new notes received for its own account through the
            exchange of outstanding notes acquired for its own account as a
            result of market-making or other trading activities, subject to the
            conditions described under "-- Resale of the Exchange Notes."

EXCHANGE AGENT

     Norwest Bank Minnesota, National Association has been appointed as the
exchange agent for the exchange offer. All questions and requests for assistance
as well as all correspondence in connection with the exchange offer and the
Letter of Transmittal should be addressed to the exchange agent, as follows:

<TABLE>
<S>                                             <C>
      By Registered or Certified Mail:                     By Overnight Courier:
Norwest Bank Minnesota, National Association          Norwest Bank Minnesota, National
         Corporate Trust Operations                             Association
               P.O. Box 1517                             Corporate Trust Operations
         Minneapolis, MN 55480-1517                            Norwest Center
                                                            Sixth and Marquette
                                                         Minneapolis, MN 55479-0113
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                             <C>
                  By Hand:                                     By Facsimile:
Norwest Bank Minnesota, National Association          Norwest Bank Minnesota, National
         Corporate Trust Operations                             Association
         Northstar East, 12th Floor                      Corporate Trust Operations
               608 2nd Avenue                                  (612) 667-4927
           Minneapolis, MN 55402                           Confirm by telephone:
                                                               (612) 667-9764
</TABLE>

     Requests for additional copies of this prospectus, the Letter of
Transmittal or the Notice of Guaranteed Delivery should be directed to the
exchange agent.

FEES AND EXPENSES

     We will bear the expenses of soliciting tenders of outstanding notes. The
principal solicitation is being made by mail; however, additional solicitation
may be made by telegraph, telephone or in person by officers and regular
employees of Park-Ohio and its affiliates.

     We have not retained any dealer-manager or other soliciting agent in
connection with the exchange offer and will not make any payments to brokers,
dealers or others soliciting acceptance of the exchange offer. We will, however,
pay the exchange agent reasonable and customary fees for its services and will
reimburse it for its related reasonable out-of-pocket expenses.

                                       30
<PAGE>   36

     We will pay the cash expenses to be incurred in connection with the
offering of the new notes. These expenses include fees and expenses of the
exchange agent and trustee, accounting and legal fees and printing costs, among
others.

     We will pay all transfer taxes, if any, applicable to the exchange of
outstanding notes in the exchange offer. If, however,

     - certificates representing notes, or outstanding notes for principal
       amounts not tendered or acceptable for exchange, are to be delivered to,
       or are to be issued in the name of, any person other than the registered
       holders of the outstanding notes tendered;

     - if tendered outstanding notes are registered in the name of any person
       other than the person signing the Letter of Transmittal; or

     - if a transfer tax is imposed for any reason other than the exchange of
       Original Notes pursuant to the exchange offer;

then the amount of any such transfer taxes (whether imposed on the registered
holder or any other persons) will be payable by the tendering holder. If
satisfactory evidence of payment of such taxes or exemption is not submitted
with the Letter of Transmittal, the amount of those transfer taxes will be
billed directly to the tendering holder of outstanding notes.

CONSEQUENCES OF FAILURE OF EXCHANGE

     Participation in the exchange offer is voluntary. Holders of the
outstanding notes are urged to consult their financial and tax advisors in
making their own decisions on whether or not to participate in the exchange
offer.

     Outstanding Series C notes that are not exchanged for new notes in the
exchange offer will remain "restricted securities" for the purposes of the
federal securities laws. Accordingly, those outstanding Series C notes may not
be offered, sold, pledged, or otherwise transferred except:

     - to Park-Ohio or any of its subsidiaries;

     - to a "Qualified Institutional Buyer" within the meaning of Rule 144A
       under the Securities Act of 1933 purchasing for its own account or for
       the account of a qualified institutional buyer in a transaction meeting
       for the requirements of Rule 144A;

     - in an offshore transaction complying with Rule 904 of Regulation S under
       the Securities Act;

     - pursuant to an exemption from registration under the Securities Act
       provided by Rule 144 thereunder, if available;

     - to "Institutional Accredited Investors" in a transaction exempt from the
       registration requirements of the Securities Act; or

     - pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Securities Act,
       in accordance with all other applicable securities laws.

     Outstanding Series B notes that are not exchange for new notes in the
exchange offer will not become subject to transfer restrictions and will remain
freely tradeable. However, the principal amount of outstanding Series B notes
will decrease as those notes are exchanged in the exchange offer. This decrease
will reduce the liquidity of any trading market that may exist for the
outstanding Series B notes.

     Outstanding notes that are not exchanged for new notes in the exchange
offer will not retain any rights under the registration rights agreement.

ACCOUNTING TREATMENT

     For accounting purposes, we will recognize no gain or loss as a result of
the exchange offer. The new notes will be recorded at the same carrying value as
the outstanding notes, as reflected in Park-Ohio's accounting records on the
date of the exchange. The expenses of the exchange offer will be amortized over
the term of the notes.

                                       31
<PAGE>   37

                      MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS
                OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

     The consolidated financial statements of our company include the accounts
of Park-Ohio, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Park-Ohio Holdings Corp. and its
subsidiaries. All significant intercompany transactions have been eliminated in
consolidation. The historical financial information is not directly comparable
on a year-to-year basis due to acquisitions in 1998 and 1997. During 1998, we
acquired two businesses for $40.2 million. During 1999, we acquired all of the
shares of The Metalloy Corporation and St. Louis Screw and Bolt and the assets
of PMC Industries, Inc. for $29.1 million. Metalloy is a full service aluminum
casting and machining company. St. Louis Screw is a manufacturer of bolts and
PMC provides capital equipment and associated parts for the oil drilling
industry. During October 1998, we acquired all of the shares of GIS Industries,
Inc., known as Gateway. Gateway is a distributor of fasteners and other
industrial products and a manufacturer of metal products and fasteners. During
April, 1998, we acquired all of the shares of Direct Fasteners Limited, a
distributor of fasteners located in Ontario, Canada. During 1997, we acquired
five businesses for $60.4 million. The largest of the 1997 acquisitions was
Arden Industrial Products, Inc. which was acquired for $44 million as of August
1, 1997. Arden is a national supplier of specialty and standard fasteners to the
industrial market. All acquisitions are accounted for as purchases and
consequently their results are included in the consolidated financial statements
from their respective dates of acquisition. In 1996, we sold substantially all
of the assets of Bennett Industries, Inc., a manufacturer of plastic containers,
in order to focus on our remaining logistics and manufacturing businesses.

OVERVIEW

     We operate diversified manufacturing and logistic businesses that serve a
wide variety of industrial markets. We define our businesses into three
operating segments: Integrated Logistics Solutions, Aluminum Products, and
Manufactured Products. Integrated Logistics Solutions is a leading national
supplier of fasteners, such as nuts, bolts and screws and other industrial
products to original equipment manufacturers, other manufacturers and
distributors. In connection with the supply of such industrial products,
Integrated Logistics Solutions provides a variety of value-added, cost-effective
procurement solutions. The principal customers of Integrated Logistics Solutions
are in the transportation, industrial, electrical and lawn and garden equipment
industries. Aluminum Products manufactures cast aluminum critical components
primarily for automotive original equipment manufacturers. Aluminum Products
provides value-added services such as design and engineering, machining and
assembly. Manufactured Products designs and manufactures a broad range of high
quality products engineered for specific customer applications. The principal
customers of Manufactured Products are original equipment manufacturers and
end-users in the automotive, railroad, truck and aerospace industries.

     Between 1994 and 1998, we have grown significantly, both internally and
through acquisitions. Over this period, our net sales increased at a 43.8%
compounded annual growth rate ("CAGR"), from $129.2 million to $551.8 million,
and income from continuing operations on a fully taxed basis increased at a
33.2% CAGR from $4.1 million to $13.1 million.

     This growth has been primarily attributable to our strategy of making
selective acquisitions in order to complement internal growth. Historically, we
have acquired underperforming businesses with potential for:

     - significant cost reductions through improved labor, supplier and customer
       relations and increased purchasing power and

     - revenue enhancement due to better asset utilization and management
       practices, as well as increased access to capital.

     Our internal growth has been driven primarily by the addition of Integrated
Logistics Solutions customers under total fastener supply contracts and by the
leveraging of existing customer relationships in the Aluminum Products and
Manufactured Products segments.

     Between January 1, 1994 and March 31, 1999, our continuing operations
incurred $70.5 million of capital expenditures, the majority of which was used
to expand and upgrade existing manufacturing facilities and enhance Integrated
Logistics Solutions' management information systems.

                                       32
<PAGE>   38

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

  Three Months 1999 versus Three Months 1998

     Net sales increased by $34.9 million, or 26%, from $136.5 million for the
first three months of 1998 to $171.4 million for the three months ended March
31, 1999. This growth results from acquisitions that we made subsequent to March
31, 1998 and relates primarily to the Integrated Logistics Solutions and the
Aluminum Products segments. For Integrated Logistics Solutions, the growth in
net sales from acquisitions amounted to $12.7 million and related to Gateway and
Direct Fasteners. For Aluminum Products, net sales increased by $21.7 million
and related primarily to the acquisition of Metalloy.

     Gross profit increased by $7.6 million, or 33%, from $23.3 million for the
first three months of 1998 to $30.9 million for the first three months of 1999
and is directly related to acquisitions made in the preceding twelve months. Our
consolidated gross margin increased to 18.1% for the first three months of 1999
from 17.1% for the first three months of 1998. This increase in consolidated
gross margin was due to increased margins in both the Aluminum Products and
Integrated Logistics Solutions segments more than offsetting a decline in gross
margins in the Manufactured Products segment. The increase in the Aluminum
Products segment gross margin was due to increased production at General
Aluminum, thereby allocating fixed manufacturing overhead over a greater
production base and to the acquisition of Metalloy which has a higher overall
gross margin than the existing business. The increase in margins in the
Integrated Logistics Solutions segment is a result of spreading operating costs
over a growing revenue base resulting from the recent acquisitions in Integrated
Logistics Solutions and favorable raw material sourcing. The decline in margins
in the Manufactured Products segment results primarily from reduced production
activity at Ajax Manufacturing Company which caused fixed overhead costs to be
spread over a lesser production base.

     Selling, general and administrative costs increased by 28% to $18.0 million
for the first three months of 1999 from $14.1 million for the first three months
of 1998. This increase was related to the acquisitions that have been
consummated subsequent to the first quarter of 1998. Consolidated selling,
general and administrative expenses as a percentage of net sales was
approximately 10.5% for both periods.

     Interest expense increased by $1.2 million from $4.2 million for the
three-month period ended March 31, 1998 to $5.4 million for the three-month
period ended March 31, 1999 due to higher average debt outstanding during the
current period offset by lower average interest rates in 1999 versus 1998. For
the three-month period ended March 31, 1999, we averaged outstanding borrowings
of $265.2 million as compared to $182.6 million outstanding for the three months
ended March 31, 1998. The $82.6 million increase related primarily to
acquisitions completed during the latter part of 1998 and the first quarter of
1999 with the remainder primarily related to working capital increases to
support the realized and anticipated growth in business and to capital
expenditures to support growth in the business. The average borrowing rate of
8.1% for the three months ended March 31, 1999 is 1.0% lower than the average
rate of 9.1% for the three months ended March 31, 1998 primarily because of
averaging increased borrowings under our revolving credit facility which carry
lower effective interest rates with our subordinated debt which carries a higher
coupon rate.

     The effective income tax rate for the three-month periods ended March 31,
1999 and 1998 was 43%. At December 31, 1998, our subsidiaries had $1.1 million
of net operating loss carryforwards for tax purposes.

  1998 versus 1997

     Net sales increased by $110.7 million, or 25%, from $441.1 million in 1997
to $551.8 million in 1998. Approximately 27% of this increase was attributable
to internal growth and 73% was a result of acquisitions completed in 1997 or
1998. Of the internal sales growth, approximately 66% was primarily attributable
to Integrated Logistics Solutions and the addition of total fastening service
customers, and the remainder was due to increased orders from Manufactured
Products' customers. The growth in net sales from acquisitions applies to
Integrated Logistics Solutions and primarily pertains to Arden and Gateway.

     Gross profit increased by $24.2 million, or 34%, from $72.4 million in 1997
to $96.6 million in 1998. Of the increase, 67% relates to acquisitions and 33%
to internal growth. Our consolidated gross margin increased to 17.5% for 1998
from 16.4% for 1997. This increase in consolidated gross margin was due to
increased margins in

                                       33
<PAGE>   39

both the Integrated Logistics Solutions and Manufactured Products segments. The
increase in Manufactured Products was due to a change in revenue mix and to
increased production thereby allocating fixed manufacturing overhead over a
greater production base. The increase in margins in the Integrated Logistics
Solutions segment is a result of reduced material costs.

     Selling, general and administrative costs increased by $11.9 million or 27%
to $56.3 million in 1998 from $44.4 million in 1997. Approximately 78% of such
increase was related to acquisitions while the remainder related to the increase
in internally generated net sales. Consolidated selling, general and
administrative expenses as a percentage of net sales was approximately 10% for
both periods.

     Interest expense increased by $8.4 million from $9.1 million for 1997 to
$17.5 million for 1998 due to higher average debt outstanding during 1998 and to
higher average interest rates in 1998 versus 1997. For the year ended December
31, 1998, we averaged outstanding borrowings of $205.3 million as compared to
$123.1 million outstanding for 1997. The $82.2 million increase related
primarily to acquisitions completed during the latter part of 1997 and 1998,
working capital increases to support the realized and anticipated growth in
business and capital expenditures to support the operations. The average
borrowing rate of 8.5% for the year ended December 31, 1998 is 1.1% higher than
the average rate of 7.4% for the year ended December 31, 1997 primarily because
of the $150 million debt offering in November, 1997 which carries a coupon of
9.25% versus a 7.3% rate on the bank debt it replaced.

     The effective income tax rate for 1998 was 43% as compared to 41% for 1997.
The increase is directly attributable to an increase in expenses recorded for
financial reporting purposes, but not deductible for income tax purposes,
primarily goodwill amortization. At December 31, 1998, our subsidiaries had $1.1
million of net operating loss carryforwards for tax purposes.

  1997 versus 1996

     Net sales from continuing operations increased by $93.4 million, or 27%,
from $347.7 million in 1996 to $441.1 million in 1997. Approximately 42% of this
increase was attributable to internal growth and 58% was a result of
acquisitions completed in 1997. Of the internal sales growth, approximately 70%
was primarily attributable to the addition of total fastening service customers
in the Integrated Logistics Solutions segment and the remainder was due to
increased orders from Manufactured Products' customers. Of the growth in net
sales attributable to the 1997 acquisitions, the majority applies to the
Integrated Solutions Logistics segment and primarily pertains to Arden, which
was acquired as of August 1, 1997.

     Gross profit from continuing operations increased by $14.1 million, or 24%,
from $58.3 million in 1996 to $72.4 million in 1997. Of the increase, 79%
relates to the 1997 acquisitions and 21% was due to internal growth. A majority
of the increase attributable to the 1997 acquisitions was related to Arden. Our
consolidated gross margin from continuing operations decreased to 16.4% in 1997
from 16.8% in 1996. This decrease in consolidated gross margin was primarily due
to a change in our revenue mix.

     Selling, general and administrative costs from continuing operations
increased by $6.3 million or 16% to $44.4 million in 1997 from $38.1 million in
1996. Approximately 93% of such increase was related to the 1997 acquisitions.
Consolidated selling, general and administrative expenses decreased as a
percentage of net sales to 10.1% in 1997 from 11.0% in 1996 due to economies of
scale resulting from higher sales volume.

     Interest expense from continuing operations increased by $2.2 million from
$6.9 million in 1996 to $9.1 million in 1997 due to average debt outstanding in
1997 increasing by $19.9 million and to the reclassification in 1996 of
approximately $.8 million of interest expense to discontinued operations
resulting from the sale of Bennett Industries. Average interest rates for the
period were approximately the same in 1997 and 1996.

     As a result of the early extinguishment of our 7 1/4% Convertible Senior
Subordinated Debentures due June 15, 2004, and our then existing bank credit
facility, we recorded an extraordinary charge of $1.5 million, net of income
taxes, in 1997.

                                       34
<PAGE>   40

     At December 31, 1997, our subsidiaries had net operating loss carryforwards
for tax purposes of approximately $9.4 million, subject to certain limitations
that expire between 2001 and 2007.

LIQUIDITY AND SOURCES OF CAPITAL

     Our liquidity needs are primarily for working capital and capital
expenditures. Our primary sources of liquidity have been funds provided by
operations and funds available from existing bank credit arrangements. On
November 2, 1998, we amended and restated our credit agreement with a group of
banks under which we may borrow up to $150 million on an unsecured basis. This
agreement, the proceeds of which will be used for general corporate purposes,
expires on April 30, 2001. Amounts borrowed under the agreement may be, at our
election, either (a) the bank's prime lending rate less 100-30 basis points or
(b) LIBOR plus 90-170 basis points depending on the aggregate amount borrowed
under the agreement. Outstanding borrowings under this facility were $86.0
million at December 31, 1998 and $113.0 million at April 30, 1999.

     On November 25, 1997, we sold $150 million of our 9.25% Senior Subordinated
Notes due 2007. We used the net proceeds of those 1997 Notes along with
borrowings under our new credit facility to (a) redeem our 7 1/4% Convertible
Senior Subordinated Debentures due June 15, 2004 and (b) to repay substantially
all amounts outstanding under our then existing credit facility. On June 3,
1999, we sold $50 million of our 9.25% Senior Subordinated Notes. We used the
net proceeds of these 1999 Notes to repay $49.0 million outstanding under our
revolving credit facility.

     Current financial resources (working capital and available bank borrowing
arrangements) and anticipated funds from operations are expected to be adequate
to meet current cash requirements. Capital expenditures for 1999 are projected
to be approximately $15 million which will be used to invest in our current
facilities for projected new business, and for scheduled improvements and new
equipment to expand existing products.

     The ratio of current assets to current liabilities was 2.38 at March 31,
1999, 3.17 at December 31, 1998, and 2.83 at December 31, 1997. Working capital
increased by $30.2 million to $176.6 million at December 31, 1998 from $146.4
million at December 31, 1997 as a result of the inclusion of acquisitions
completed in 1998 and to support our internal growth. Working capital decreased
by $12.5 million to $164.1 million at March 31, 1999 from $176.6 million at
December 31, 1998 largely as a result of implementing systems throughout
Park-Ohio to more efficiently utilize and minimize levels of working capital
necessary to operate our diverse and separate operations, and to purchase
accounting adjustments related to acquisitions completed in 1999.

     During the first three months of 1999, we generated $9.3 million from
operations before changes in operating assets and liabilities. After giving
effect to the generation of $1.6 million in the operating accounts, we provided
$10.9 million from operating activities. During the period we invested $6.3
million in capital expenditures, used $29.1 for acquisitions and used $.5
million for other purposes. These activities were primarily funded by a net
increase in bank borrowings of $25.1 million.

     During 1998, we generated $32.5 million of cash from operations before
changes in operating assets and liabilities. After giving effect to the use of
$28.4 million in the operating accounts, we provided $4.1 million from operating
activities. During the year, we invested $22.7 million in facilities, machinery
and equipment, and information systems, used $40.2 for acquisitions and used
$3.0 million for dividends. These activities were funded by a net increase in
bank borrowings of $64.3 million offset by a $2.5 million increase in cash
during the period.

     During 1997, we generated $27.0 million from continuing operations before
changes in operating assets and liabilities. After giving effect to the use of
$37.0 million in the operating accounts, we used $10.0 million for operating
activities. During the period, we invested $15.9 million in capital expenditures
and $60.4 million for acquisitions and investments including the acquisition of
Arden for $44.0 million. During the year, we bought 221,494 shares of our common
stock in the open market for $3.0 million. As of December 31, 1997, after
issuing 199,000 common shares from the treasury for the exercise of stock
options, we had 148,719 shares of our common stock in the treasury. During the
year, 351,000 shares of common stock were issued under stock option agreements
for which we received $3.2 million from the option holders. In addition, we
purchased in the open

                                       35
<PAGE>   41

market $1.2 million of our convertible senior subordinated debentures. These
activities were funded by a net increase in long-term borrowings of $85.4
million and a decrease in cash balances of $2.8 million.

     During 1996, we generated $20.4 million from continuing operations before
changes in operating assets and liabilities. After giving effect to the use of
$14.7 million in the operating accounts and $2.0 million provided from
discontinued operations, we provided $7.7 million from operating activities.
During 1996, we invested $15.6 million in capital expenditures and purchased
126,225 shares of our common stock for $1.8 million, all of which were funded by
internally generated cash flow and bank borrowings.

IMPACT OF INFLATION

     Although inflation was not a significant factor in 1998, we continue to
seek ways to cope with its impact. To the extent permitted by competition, our
operations generally attempt to pass on increased costs by increasing sales
prices over time. We primarily use the first in, first out method of accounting
for our inventories. Under this method, current costs are generally reflected in
cost of products. The charges to operations for depreciation represent the
allocation of historical costs incurred over past years and are significantly
less than if they were based on the current cost of productive capacity being
consumed.

YEAR 2000 CONVERSION

     The Year 2000 issue is the result of computer programs being written using
two digits rather than four to define the applicable year. Any of our computer
programs or hardware that have date-sensitive software or embedded chips may
recognize a date using "00" as the year 1900 rather than the year 2000. This
could result in a system failure or miscalculations causing disruption of
operations, including, among other things, a temporary inability to process
transactions, send invoices, or engage in similar normal business activities.

     During 1996, we developed a Year 2000 Task Force, which was established to
monitor and track the Year 2000 compliance at our operating units. The Task
Force developed a Year 2000 plan in order to minimize the risk to our operating
units and its customers. The plan to resolve the Year 2000 issues involves four
phases: assessment, remediation, testing and implementation.

     To date, the Task Force has completed its assessment of our computer
hardware and software applications, process control equipment, and other
non-information technology equipment. After taking into consideration
investments in new equipment and systems that have already been made, this
assessment has determined that with only a few exceptions, the systems are Year
2000 compliant. The exceptions require upgrades of software programs or changes
to existing programs. The remediation and testing phases are currently underway,
and upgrades and software corrections are being completed. The target for
completion of all phases is by the third quarter of 1999. We also expect
critical contingency plans to be developed by the end of the third quarter of
1999. Based upon the assessments and remediations completed to date, we do not
expect that the Year 2000 issue will have a material effect on our business
operations, consolidated financial condition, cash flows, or results of
operations.

     In addition, the Task Force is reviewing the Year 2000 compliance of our
significant third parties, including key suppliers, customers and service
providers in an effort to reduce the potential adverse effect on our operations
from non-compliance by those parties. This review of significant third parties
has begun and is expected to be completed by September 30, 1999. Interfaces to
external suppliers and customers are part of this assessment and validation
process. As these significant third parties are reviewed, the Task Force intends
to develop contingency plans, if necessary, for those parties that exhibit
possible Year 2000 problems. We have identified the most likely risk of Year
2000 non-compliance as the risk that significant third parties will not be Year
2000 compliant. Due to the general uncertainty inherent in the Year 2000
problem, we are unable to determine at this time whether the consequences of
Year 2000 compliance failures will have a material effect on our results of
operations or financial condition. If Year 2000 compliance is not achieved by
these significant third parties, over which we have no control, it could,
depending on duration, have a material adverse effect on our operations.

     We are utilizing both internal and external resources to remedy, test, and
implement the software and operating equipment for Year 2000 modifications. The
total cost to achieve Year 2000 compliance is estimated at

                                       36
<PAGE>   42

$9 million. Approximately 75% of this cost represents new systems, which we may
have initiated during the period, notwithstanding the Year 2000 issue. To date,
we have incurred approximately $8.5 million for new systems and equipment, with
the majority of these costs for the conversion/development of systems. The
remaining $.5 million will be funded through operating cash flows. We generally
do not separately identify the direct costs of internal employees working on
Year 2000 projects.

ENVIRONMENTAL

     We have been identified as a potentially responsible party at certain
third-party sites under the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation
and Liability Act of 1980 or comparable state laws which provide for strict and,
under certain circumstances, joint and several liability. We are participating
in the cost of certain clean-up efforts at several of these sites. However, our
share of these costs has not been material and based on available information,
we do not expect our exposure at any of these locations to have a material
adverse effect on our results of operations, liquidity or financial condition.

SEASONALITY; VARIABILITY OF OPERATING RESULTS

     As a result of the significant growth in our net sales and operating income
in recent years, seasonal fluctuations have been substantially mitigated.
However, we perform scheduled plant maintenance in the third quarter to coincide
with customer plant shut downs.

     The timing of orders placed by our customers has varied with, among other
factors, orders for customers' finished goods, customer production schedules,
competitive conditions and general economic conditions. The variability of the
level and timing of orders has, from time to time, resulted in significant
periodic and quarterly fluctuations in the operations of our business units.
This variability is particularly evident at the capital equipment businesses,
which are included in the Manufactured Products segment, which typically ship a
few large systems per year.

QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURE ABOUT MARKET RISK

     Park-Ohio is exposed to market risk including changes in interest rates. We
are subject to interest rate risk on our floating rate revolving credit facility
which consisted of borrowings of $111.5 million at March 31, 1999. A 100 basis
point increase in the interest rate would result in an increase in interest
expense of $.3 million during the period.

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

     This registration statement contains certain statements that are
"forward-looking statements" within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities
Act and Section 21E of the Exchange Act. Certain statements in this Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations contain
forward-looking statements, including without limitation, discussion regarding
our anticipated levels and funding of capital expenditures and the Year 2000
conversion. Forward-looking statements are necessarily subject to risks,
uncertainties and other factors, many of which are outside our control, that
could cause actual results to differ materially from such statements. These
uncertainties and other factors include such things as: general business
conditions, competitive factors, including pricing pressures and product
innovation and quality; raw material availability and pricing; changes in our
relationships with customers and suppliers; our ability to successfully
integrate recent and future acquisitions into our existing operations; changes
in general domestic economic conditions such as inflation rates, interest rates
and tax rates; increasingly stringent domestic and foreign governmental
regulations including those affecting the environment; inherent uncertainties
involved in assessing our potential liability for environmental
remediation-related activities; the outcome of pending and future litigation and
other claims; dependence on the automotive industry; dependence on key
management; dependence on information systems; and our ability, our vendors and
customers to achieve Year 2000 compliance. Any forward-looking statement speaks
only as of the date on which such statement is made, and we undertake no
obligation to update any forward-looking statement, whether as a result of new
information, future events or

                                       37
<PAGE>   43

otherwise. In light of these and other uncertainties, the inclusion of a
forward-looking statement herein should not be regarded as a representation by
us that our plans and objectives will be achieved.

                       DESCRIPTION OF OTHER INDEBTEDNESS

REVOLVING CREDIT FACILITY

     On November 2, 1998, we entered into an amended and restated credit
agreement with KeyBank National Association and The Huntington National Bank.
The lenders under this agreement agreed to lend us up to $150.0 million under a
revolving credit facility.

     Term. Commitments under the revolving credit facility will terminate on
April 30, 2001. We have the option, with the consent of the lenders, to extend
the commitment period by one year.

     Repayment. We have the right to prepay, without penalty at any time, all or
any part of the amount outstanding under the revolving credit facility. Amounts
borrowed and repaid under the revolving credit facility may be reborrowed,
subject to limitations.

     Security and Guaranty. The revolving credit facility is not secured by any
of our assets. However, we have agreed to a negative pledge on our assets which
requires us to keep all of our assets free and clear of liens except for capital
leases and certain purchase money liens. All of our material domestic
subsidiaries guarantee, and any future domestic subsidiaries are required to
guarantee, our debt outstanding under the revolving credit facility.

     Interest. At our option, the interest rates per annum applicable to the
revolving credit facility will be a fluctuating rate of interest measured by
reference to either:

     - LIBOR plus the applicable borrowing margin (the "LIBOR Loans"); or

     - a rate per annum equal to the higher of the published prime rate of the
       administrative agent bank or one and one-half percent (1 1/2%) in excess
       of the Federal Funds Effective Rate (as defined in the revolving credit
       facility) plus the applicable borrowing margin ("Prime Rate Loans").

     The applicable borrowing margins for the LIBOR Loans and the Prime Rate
Loans are based upon whether the loan is in Tranche A, Tranche B or Tranche C.
The commitments for Tranche A, B and C are $100.0 million, $25.0 million and
$25.0 million, respectively. The following matrix sets forth the applicable
borrowing margins for the various loans:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                       APPLICABLE BORROWING MARGIN       APPLICABLE BORROWING MARGIN
   TYPE OF LOAN              FOR LIBOR LOANS                FOR PRIME RATE LOANS
   ------------      -------------------------------   -------------------------------
<S>                  <C>                               <C>
Tranche A                    90 basis points                 (100) basis points
Tranche B                   150 basis points                  (50) basis points
Tranche C                   170 basis points                  (30) basis points
</TABLE>

     Fees. We pay customary fees with respect to the revolving credit facility,
including agent fees and commitment fees on the unused portion of the revolving
credit facility.

     Use of Proceeds. As of March 31, 1999, $111.5 million was outstanding under
the revolving credit facility. After giving pro forma effect to this offering
and the use of the proceeds therefrom, we would have had $62.5 million
outstanding under the revolving credit facility. Subsequent to the offering of
the Series C notes, we borrowed approximately $30 million under our revolving
credit facility to complete the acquisition of Columbia Nut & Bolt and
Industrial Fastener. The revolving credit facility is available to finance
permitted acquisitions, working capital requirements and general corporate
purposes.

INDUSTRIAL REVENUE BONDS

     Our subsidiary, Metalloy, is obligated to repay a loan from the Mississippi
Business Finance Corporation in connection with the Taxable Adjustable Rate
Industrial Revenue Bonds, Series 1994 (the "Bonds") which were issued in June
1994 in connection with a construction project to expand its facilities in
Tupelo, Mississippi. The

                                       38
<PAGE>   44

Bonds bear interest at a floating rate based on commercial paper rates and will
mature in 2003. A portion of the Bonds, approximately $1.2 million, are required
to be redeemed on June 1 of each year until maturity at 100% of the principal
amount redeemed plus accrued interest. As of March 31, 1999, the Bonds had an
interest rate of approximately 5.0% per annum, and $6.1 million aggregate
principal amount of Bonds were outstanding. We recently borrowed $4.5 million
under our revolving credit facility and intend to redeem the Bonds in August,
1999.

STATE LOANS

     We are a borrower under a State of Ohio Department of Development loan,
which was issued in April 1997 in connection with the refurbishment of our
corporate headquarters. This loan bears interest at a rate of 5.0% per annum and
will mature in 2002. As of March 31, 1999, $0.7 million aggregate principal
amount was outstanding under this loan.

     Our subsidiary, General Aluminum Mfg. Company, is a borrower under a State
of Ohio Department of Development loan, which was issued in October 1993 in
connection with the expansion of its facility and the purchase of certain
equipment. This loan bears interest at a rate of 3.0% per annum and will mature
in 2003. As of March 31, 1999, $0.4 million aggregate principal amount was
outstanding under this loan.

OTHER INDEBTEDNESS

     In addition, as of March 31, 1999, Park-Ohio had $1.7 million of other debt
outstanding, which was comprised of capital leases.

SERIES B NOTES

     In November 1997, we issued $150.0 million of Series A 9 1/4% Senior
Subordinated Notes due 2007. In February 1998, we consummated an exchange offer
in which we exchanged all of these Series A notes for our Series B 9 1/4% Senior
Subordinated Notes due 2007 in an offering registered under the Securities Act
of 1933.

     The principal terms of the Series B notes are the same as those of the
Series C notes, including the interest rate, the interest payment dates,
redemption dates, redemption premiums and the maturity date. The indenture
relating to the Series B notes contains covenants which are substantially the
same as those contained in the indenture relating to the Series C notes
described in this prospectus. We are offering to exchange all of the Series B
notes in return for new notes. It is likely that all of the Series C notes and
all of our currently outstanding Series B notes will be tendered for exchange in
the exchange offer; however, we cannot assure you that a significant amount of
the Series B notes will be so tendered. Series B notes not exchanged in the
exchange offer will continue as a separate series of notes under a separate
indenture. If all of the Series B notes and Series C notes are exchanged for new
notes, $200.0 million aggregate principal amount of new notes will be
outstanding following consummation of the exchange offer, and the new exchanged
notes will be deemed to be a single series of notes outstanding under the
indenture relating to the Series C notes described in this prospectus. If all of
the Series B notes are exchanged for new notes, your voting interest in your
Series B notes will be significantly diluted.

                                       39
<PAGE>   45

                                    BUSINESS

     Park-Ohio is an industrial logistics and diversified manufacturing business
which conducts its operations through three business segments: Integrated
Logistics Solutions, Aluminum Products and Manufactured Products.

     INTEGRATED LOGISTICS SOLUTIONS is the leading national supplier of over
150,000 standard and specialty fasteners and other industrial products to a
broad base of industrial original equipment manufacturers. Most of the products
are supplied to customers through integrated supply management programs which
include value-added services, such as:

<TABLE>
<S>                                                   <C>
- - part usage and cost analysis                        - product redesign recommendations
- - supplier selection                                  - quality assurance
- - bar coding                                          - product packaging and tracking
- - just-in-time delivery                               - electronic billing services
- - ongoing technical support
</TABLE>

     Integrated Logistics Solutions supplies over 12,000 customers and generated
net sales of $364.5 million for the year ended December 31, 1998. Integrated
Logistics Solutions' customers typically enter into exclusive, multi-year total
fastening service contracts which enable those customers to both reduce
procurement costs and better focus on their company's core manufacturing
competencies. Integrated Logistics Solutions operates out of 56 branches located
throughout the United States and has branches in Mexico, Canada, Puerto Rico and
England, and has a central distribution center located in Dayton, Ohio.

     ALUMINUM PRODUCTS specializes in casting and machining aluminum components
primarily for the automotive industry. Aluminum Products generated net sales of
$39.9 million for the year ended December 31, 1998. We have invested more than
$36.4 million for capital expenditures (including one acquisition) in this
segment during the last two years to capitalize on the increasing amount of
aluminum being used in automobiles and trucks. Aluminum Products has grown
rapidly recently due to our:

     - acquisition of Metalloy, which added sand and die casting to our existing
       permanent mold casting capabilities;

     - investment in state-of-the-art equipment in connection with a new
       contract with Chrysler which is expected to generate annual net sales of
       approximately $25 million; and

     - additional new business which we have attracted due to our reputation for
       high quality, low production costs and extensive casting capabilities.

     MANUFACTURED PRODUCTS operates a diverse group of niche manufacturing
businesses which vary in net sales from approximately $5 million to $40 million.
This segment generated net sales of $147.4 million for the year ended December
31, 1998. This segment manufactures:

     - large forgings, such as locomotive crankshafts and camshafts, aircraft
       landing gears and specialized hardware for the construction industry;

     - rubber products, such as valve seals, wire harnesses and spark plug
       boots; and

     - capital equipment, such as induction heating systems, forging presses and
       heat processing and curing systems.

                                       40
<PAGE>   46

     The following table highlights Park-Ohio's three business segments, the key
products they sell and the primary industries they serve:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                  1998
                                                                                                 SALES
               SEGMENT                 PRIMARY INDUSTRIES SERVED     KEY PRODUCTS/SERVICES     (MILLIONS)
               -------                 -------------------------    -----------------------    ----------
<S>                                    <C>                          <C>                        <C>
INTEGRATED LOGISTICS SOLUTIONS         Automotive parts and         Inventory management,        $364.5
                                       accessories, electrical      engineering and
                                       equipment, lawn and          procurement of standard
                                       garden equipment, HVAC,      and specialty
                                       industrial equipment,        fasteners, fittings,
                                       railroad and heavy truck     rubber and other
                                                                    industrial products.

ALUMINUM PRODUCTS                      Automotive, truck            Engineering and                39.9
                                                                    manufacturing of
                                                                    aluminum permanent mold
                                                                    castings such as
                                                                    transmission pump
                                                                    housings, pinion
                                                                    carriers, clutch
                                                                    retainers and other
                                                                    die, sand and permanent
                                                                    mold machined castings.

MANUFACTURED PRODUCTS                  Automotive, aerospace,       Engineering and               147.4
                                       power generation,            manufacturing forged
                                       railroad, shipbuilding,      and machined products
                                       steel, telecommunications    such as aircraft
                                       and truck                    landing gears,
                                                                    locomotive crankshafts
                                                                    and camshafts;
                                                                    induction and heating
                                                                    systems; and industrial
                                                                    rubber products.
</TABLE>

                                       41
<PAGE>   47

                                 OUR OPERATIONS

INTEGRATED LOGISTICS SOLUTIONS

     Products and Services. Supply chain management, which is Integrated
Logistics' primary focus for future growth, involves offering customers
procurement solutions and comprehensive, on-site management for most of their
fastener and related hardware needs. Supply chain management customers receive
value-added services, such as part usage and cost analysis, product redesign
recommendations, supplier selection, quality assurance, bar coding, product
packaging and tracking, just-in-time delivery, electronic billing services and
ongoing technical support. Supply chain management services are typically
provided to customers pursuant to total fastening services contracts. Those
contracts enable Integrated Logistics' customers to both reduce procurement
costs and better focus on their companies' core manufacturing competencies by:

     - significantly reducing the administrative and labor costs associated with
       fastener procurement by outsourcing certain internal purchasing, quality
       control and inventory fulfillment responsibilities;

     - reducing the amount of working capital invested in inventory;

     - achieving purchasing efficiencies as a result of vendor consolidation;
       and

     - receiving technical expertise in the selection of fastener and other
       components for certain manufacturing processes.

     Management believes that total fastening service contracts foster
longer-lasting supply relationships with customers, who increasingly rely on us
for their fastener needs, as compared to traditional buy/sell distribution
relationships. Sales pursuant to these contracts have increased significantly in
recent years and represented over 59% of Integrated Logistics' net sales for the
year ended December 31, 1998. Integrated Logistics' remaining sales are
generated through the wholesale supply of fasteners and other industrial
products to original equipment manufacturers, other manufacturers and
distributors pursuant to master or authorized distributor relationships.

     Integrated Logistics supplies standard and specialty engineered fasteners
such as nuts, bolts, screws and washers on a fully integrated basis. The segment
engineers and manufactures precision cold formed and cold extruded products
including locknuts, spac nuts and wheel hardware, which are principally used in
applications where controlled tightening is required due to high vibration.
These are manufactured by shaping cold raw materials. Standard and specialty
nuts are produced to customer specifications, which are used in large volumes by
customers in the automotive, truck and railroad industries.

     In addition to fasteners, Integrated Logistics supplies, among other
things, valves, fittings, clamps and rubber products, which currently represent
approximately 9% of Integrated Logistics' net sales. Integrated Logistics also
provides engineering and design services to its customers.
Applications-engineering specialists and the direct sales force work closely
with the engineering staff of original equipment customers to recommend the
appropriate fasteners for a new product or to suggest alternative fasteners that
reduce overall production costs, streamline assembly or enhance the appearance
or performance of the end product.

     Markets and Customers. In 1998, approximately 89% of Integrated Logistics'
net sales were to domestic customers. Remaining sales were primarily to Canada
and Mexico. The domestic industrial fastener market is estimated by industry
sources to have generated between $7 and $9 billion in annual sales in 1998 at
the wholesale level. Fasteners are used extensively by original equipment
manufacturers in a variety of industries, and demand is generally related to the
state of the economy and to the overall level of manufacturing activity.

     Integrated Logistics markets and sells fasteners and other industrial
products to over 12,000 customers domestically and internationally. The
principal markets served by Integrated Logistics are transportation equipment,
including manufacturers of heavy trucks and recreational vehicles, automotive
parts and accessories, industrial equipment, electrical equipment, including
manufacturers of electrical controls, appliances and motors, lawn and garden
equipment and HVAC.

     In recent years, original equipment manufacturers have made it a priority
to reduce their total cost of purchasing and handling fasteners. Due to the low
unit cost and the large number of different fasteners used to

                                       42
<PAGE>   48

manufacture or assemble a single product, administrative and overhead costs
comprise a substantial portion of an original equipment manufacturers
fastener-related costs. As a result, management believes industrial fastener
suppliers are consolidating as original equipment manufacturers rely on fewer
suppliers to achieve purchasing efficiencies. Integrated Logistics provides a
wide array of value-added services and is a reliable source for just-in-time
delivery and is well positioned to capitalize on these trends. In addition,
original equipment manufacturers are increasingly relying on fastener suppliers
to provide design and applications engineering support, enabling more efficient
use of internal engineering resources and thereby allowing Integrated Logistics
to increase the amount of low unit cost fastener and non-fastener items supplied
to original equipment manufacturers.

     Competition. The industrial fastener supply industry is highly competitive
and fragmented. Management believes that substantially all of Integrated
Logistics' competitors operate on a regional basis and do not provide customers
with the wide array of value-added services offered by Integrated Logistics.
Integrated Logistics competes primarily on the basis of its value-added
services, extensive product selection and price with primarily domestic
competitors who are capable of providing inventory management programs.

MANUFACTURED PRODUCTS

     The Manufactured Products segment includes forged and machined products,
capital equipment, industrial rubber products and other manufactured products.
The three largest customers, of which we sell to multiple operating divisions,
accounted for approximately 31% of Manufactured Products sales in 1998. The loss
of business from any one of these customers would have an adverse effect on this
segment.

  Forged and Machined Products

     Our forged and machined products business is carried out at four operating
units consisting of Park Drop Forge, Ohio Crankshaft, Cleveland City Forge, and
Blue Falcon Forge. The forging process enables metal to be shaped while
generally retaining higher structural integrity than metal shaped through other
processes. Park Drop Forge manufactures closed-die metal forgings of up to 6,000
pounds, including crankshafts and aircraft landing gears, primarily for
customers in the railroad and aerospace industries. Park Drop Forge's products
are sold primarily to machining companies and subassemblers who finish the
products for sale to original equipment manufacturers in the railroad and
aerospace industries. Ohio Crankshaft machines, induction hardens and surface
finishes crankshafts and camshafts used primarily in locomotives, power
generators and ships. Cleveland City Forge manufactures and machines specialized
hardware such as turnbuckles and clevises for construction companies. Its
products are manufactured according to customers' specific dimensional and/or
strength requirements. Blue Falcon Forge produces large forged products such as
center plates and couplings, both of which are used in the undercarriage of rail
cars. Forged and machined products are sold to a wide variety of domestic and
international original equipment manufactures and other manufacturers in the
transportation, power generation and construction industries. Our forged and
machined products business competes domestically and internationally with other
small to medium-sized businesses on the basis of product quality and precision.

  Capital Equipment

     We manufacture large industrial equipment through our Tocco, Ajax, and Feco
operating units. Tocco specializes in the engineering and construction of
induction heating systems primarily for the automotive and truck industries.
Tocco's induction heating systems are engineered and built to customer
specifications and are used primarily by original equipment manufacturers for
surface hardening. Ajax engineers, manufactures and services mechanical forging
presses ranging in size from 500 to 8,000 tons that are used worldwide in the
automotive and truck manufacturing industries. Feco produces complete oven
systems that combine heat processing and curing technologies with material
handling and conveying methods. Feco's principal products include industrial
drying and curing ovens for automotive components, metal can curing ovens,
specialized conveyor and automation systems for lightweight containers, and
plastic and glass bottle coating and finishing systems. Our capital equipment
units compete with large equipment manufacturers on the basis of service
capability, ability to meet customer specifications, delivery performance and
engineering expertise and exists at both domestic and international levels.

                                       43
<PAGE>   49

  Industrial Rubber Products

     We manufacture injection and transfer molded products, lathe-cut goods,
roll coverings and various items requiring rubber to metal bonding for use in
industrial applications through three operating units consisting of Castle
Rubber, Cicero Flexible Products and Geneva Rubber. Castle manufactures valve
seals, power and conveyor rolls and slitter rings. Cicero is a developer and
manufacturer of injection molded silicone rubber products for customers in the
automotive, food processing and consumer appliance industries, such as wire
harnesses, spark plug boots and nipples and general sealing gaskets. Geneva is a
manufacturer of injection molded rubber products for customers in the
automotive, telecommunications, funeral and heavy truck industries. Its products
include primary wire harnesses, transoceanic cable boots, casket gaskets and
shock and vibration mounts. The industrial rubber products operating units
compete primarily on the basis of price and product quality with other domestic
small to medium-sized manufacturers of rubber products.

ALUMINUM PRODUCTS

     Aluminum permanent mold castings are produced at General Aluminum Mfg.
Company and its wholly owned subsidiary. General Aluminum's cast aluminum parts
are critical components manufactured primarily for automotive original equipment
manufacturers. General Aluminum's principal automotive products include:
transmission pump housings, planetary pinion carriers, clutch retainers, rotor
castings and bearing cups. In addition, General Aluminum manufactures products
for non-automotive end users such as surgical table components, light housings
and electrical meter housings. General Aluminum also provides value-added
services such as secondary casting, machining, drilling, tapping and part
assembly. Although these parts are lightweight, they possess high durability and
integrity characteristics even under extreme pressure and temperature
conditions. Demand by automotive original equipment manufacturers for aluminum
permanent mold products has increased in recent years as original equipment
manufacturers have sought lighter alternatives to heavier steel and iron
components. Lighter aluminum cast components increase an automobile's fuel
efficiency without decreasing its structural integrity. Management believes this
replacement trend will continue as government standards regarding fuel
efficiency become increasingly stringent.

     General Aluminum sells its products primarily to customers located in North
America. The market for aluminum permanent mold castings is comprised of two
segments: automotive and non-automotive. The domestic aluminum permanent mold
industry is highly competitive. General Aluminum competes principally on the
basis of its ability to:

     - engineer and manufacture high quality, semi-machined castings in large
       volumes;

     - provide timely delivery; and

     - retain the manufacturing flexibility necessary to quickly adjust to the
       needs of its customers.

     Although there are a number of smaller domestic companies with aluminum
permanent mold casting capabilities, the automotive industry's stringent quality
and service standards enable only large suppliers with the requisite quality
certifications to compete effectively. As one of these suppliers, General
Aluminum has benefitted in recent years as automotive original equipment
manufacturers have consolidated their supplier base. General Aluminum, a
well-established name in the aluminum permanent mold industry, has achieved QS
9000 and ISO 9002 certifications and has been awarded numerous supplier quality
awards.

     In January 1999, General Aluminum acquired all of the shares of The
Metalloy Corporation. Metalloy is a full service aluminum casting and machining
company with operations located in Indiana, Michigan and Mississippi. The
acquisition of Metalloy provides sand and die casting capabilities to complement
General Aluminum's permanent mold process. Our management believes that General
Aluminum is one of the few automotive parts suppliers which has the capabilities
of providing permanent mold, sand-casted and die-casted products.

                                       44
<PAGE>   50

SALES AND MARKETING

     Integrated Logistics markets its products and services in the United
States, Mexico, Canada and Europe, primarily through its direct sales force,
which is assisted by applications engineers who provide the technical expertise
necessary to assist the engineering staff of original equipment customers in
designing new products and improving existing products. Integrated Logistics
often obtains new customers as a result of referrals from existing customers.
Manufactured Products and Aluminum Products market and sell their products
through both internal sales personnel and independent sales representatives. In
some instances, the internal engineering staff assists in the sales and
marketing effort through joint design and applications-engineering efforts with
major customers. In addition, Manufactured Products markets certain of its
products through various regional and national trade shows.

RAW MATERIALS AND SUPPLIERS

     Integrated Logistics purchases substantially all of its fasteners and
Aluminum Products and Manufactured Products purchase substantially all of their
raw materials, principally metals and certain component parts incorporated into
their products, from third-party suppliers and manufacturers. Management
believes that raw materials and component parts other than certain specialty
fasteners are available from alternative sources. Integrated Logistics has
multiple sources of supply for standard products, but has limited supply sources
for certain specialty products. Approximately 10% of Integrated Logistics'
fasteners are purchased from suppliers in foreign countries, primarily Taiwan,
Japan and Korea. We are dependent upon the ability of those suppliers to meet
stringent quality and performance standards and to conform to delivery
schedules. Most raw materials required by Aluminum Products and Manufactured
Products are commodity products available from several domestic suppliers.

BACKLOG

     Management believes that backlog is not a meaningful measure for our
Integrated Logistics operating units, as a majority of Integrated Logistics'
customers require just-in-time delivery of fasteners and other industrial
products. Management believes that neither Aluminum Products' nor Manufactured
Products' backlog as of any particular date is a meaningful measure of sales for
any future period as a significant portion of sales are on a release or firm
order basis.

ENVIRONMENTAL REGULATIONS

     We are subject to numerous federal, state and local laws and regulations
designed to protect public health and the environment, particularly with regard
to discharges and emissions, as well as handling, storage, treatment and
disposal, of various substances and wastes. Pursuant to these environmental
laws, owners or operators of facilities may be liable for the costs of response
or other corrective actions for contamination identified at or emanating from
current or former locations, without regard to whether the owner or operator
knew of, or was responsible for, the presence of any such contamination, and for
related damages to natural resources. Additionally, persons who arrange for the
disposal or treatment of hazardous substances or materials may be liable for
costs of response at sites where they are located, whether or not the site is
owned or operated by that person.

     We believe that we are currently in material compliance with applicable
environmental laws. In general, we have not experienced difficulty in complying
with environmental laws in the past, and compliance with environmental laws has
not had a material adverse effect on our financial condition, liquidity and
results of operations. Our capital expenditures on environmental control
facilities were not material during the past five years and these expenditures
are not expected to be material to us in the foreseeable future.

     We have been identified as a potentially responsible party at certain
third-party sites under the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation
and Liability Act of 1980, or comparable state laws, which provide for strict
and, under certain circumstances, joint and several liability. We are
participating in the cost of certain clean-up efforts at several of these sites.
The availability of third-party payments or insurance for environmental
remediation activities is subject to risks associated with the willingness and
ability of the third party to make

                                       45
<PAGE>   51

payments. However, our share of these costs has not been material and based on
available information, we do not expect its exposure at any of these locations
to have a material adverse effect on our results of operations, liquidity or
financial condition.

EMPLOYEES

     As of March 31, 1999, we had a total of approximately 3,000 employees.

INFORMATION ABOUT INDUSTRY SEGMENTS AND GEOGRAPHIC AREAS

     Approximately 89% of our net sales for the year ended December 31, 1998
were within the United States. None of the net sales to any foreign country
represented more than 6% of our total sales in 1998. Approximately 96% of our
assets are maintained in the United States. For more information see Note F to
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) as of March 31, 1999 and
Note K to Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements as of December 31, 1998,
included in this prospectus.

PROPERTIES

     Park-Ohio's operations include numerous manufacturing and warehousing
facilities located in 23 states in the United States and in 4 other countries.
Approximately 54% of the available square footage is owned. In 1998,
approximately 55% of the available domestic square footage was used by the
Manufactured Products segment, 6% was used by the Aluminum Products segment and
39% by the Integrated Logistics segment. Approximately 19% of the foreign
facilities were used by the Manufactured Products segment and approximately 81%
of these facilities were used by the Integrated Logistics segment. In the
opinion of management, Park-Ohio's facilities are generally well maintained and
are suitable and adequate for their intended uses.

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

     We are subject to various pending and threatened lawsuits in which claims
for monetary damages are asserted in the ordinary course of business. While any
litigation involves an element of uncertainty, in the opinion of management,
liabilities, if any, arising from currently pending or threatened litigation
will not have a material adverse effect on Park- Ohio's financial condition,
liquidity and results of operations.

                                       46
<PAGE>   52

                                   MANAGEMENT

                      DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS OF PARK-OHIO

     Information with respect to the executive officers and employee Directors
of Park-Ohio is as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
        NAME            AGE                              POSITION
        ----            ---                              --------
<S>                     <C>    <C>
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS
Edward F. Crawford      60     Chairman of the Board, Chief Executive Officer and President
James S. Walker         57     Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
Felix J. Tarorick       56     Vice Chairman of the Board, Vice President of Operations and
                               Director
Ronald J. Cozean        35     Secretary and General Counsel
Matthew V. Crawford     30     Assistant Secretary, Corporate Counsel and Director
Patrick W. Fogarty      38     Director of Corporate Development
</TABLE>

     Edward F. Crawford has been Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive
Officer of Park-Ohio since 1992 and President since 1997. Mr. E. Crawford has
also been the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Crawford Group, Inc.
(manufacturing businesses) since 1964 and serves as a director of Continental
Global Group, Inc. and Lesco Inc.

     James S. Walker has served as Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of
Park-Ohio since 1991. Mr. Walker has been with Park-Ohio for over 20 years and
has served in several capacities, including Corporate Controller and Assistant
Treasurer.

     Felix J. Tarorick became Vice Chairman of the Board in 1998 and has been
Vice President of Operations since 1996. From 1992 to 1995, Mr. Tarorick served
as President of the former consumer products group. Mr. Tarorick joined
Park-Ohio in 1992. Mr. Tarorick became a director of Park-Ohio in February,
1998.

     Ronald J. Cozean has served as Secretary and General Counsel since joining
Park-Ohio in 1994. Mr. Cozean was an associate at the law firm of Squire,
Sanders & Dempsey L.L.P. from 1991 to 1994.

     Matthew V. Crawford has served as Assistant Secretary and Corporate Counsel
since joining Park-Ohio in February 1995 and has served as President of Crawford
Container Company since 1991. Mr. M. Crawford became a director of Park-Ohio in
August 1997. Prior to joining Park-Ohio, Mr. M. Crawford worked as a Corporate
Finance Analyst at McDonald & Co. Securities, Inc. Mr. E. Crawford is the father
of Mr. M. Crawford.

     Patrick W. Fogarty has been Director of Corporate Development since 1997
and joined Park-Ohio in 1995 as Director of Finance. Prior thereto, Mr. Fogarty
held various positions, including Senior Manager, at Ernst & Young LLP from 1983
to 1995.

     Information is set forth below regarding the non-employee directors of
Park-Ohio, including their ages, principal occupations during the past five
years and other directorships presently held. Also set forth is the date each
was first elected as a director of Park-Ohio or a corporation that has been
merged into Park-Ohio.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  PRINCIPAL OCCUPATION
        NAME           AGE                      AND OTHER DIRECTORSHIPS
        ----           ---                      -----------------------
<S>                    <C>    <C>
Kevin R. Greene        40     Director of Park-Ohio since 1998; Chairman and Chief
                              Executive Officer of Value Investing Partners, Inc.
                              (international investment banking firm) since 1992; formerly
                              a management consultant with McKinsey & Company (consulting
                              firm); President of Board of Trustees of Oratory Prep in
                              Summit, NJ
Thomas E. McGinty      69     Director of Park-Ohio since 1986; President, Belvoir
                              Consultants, Inc. (management consultants) since 1983
Lewis E. Hatch, Jr.    73     Director of Park-Ohio since 1992; retired, former Chairman
                              and Chief Operating Officer, Rusch International
                              (international medical device company); Director, ImageMax,
                              Inc.
</TABLE>

                                       47
<PAGE>   53

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  PRINCIPAL OCCUPATION
        NAME           AGE                      AND OTHER DIRECTORSHIPS
        ----           ---                      -----------------------
<S>                    <C>    <C>
Lawrence O. Selhorst   66     Director of Park-Ohio since 1995; Chairman of the Board and
                              Chief Executive Officer of American Spring Wire Corporation
                              (spring wire manufacturer) since 1968; former Chairman of
                              the Board of RB&W Corporation (logistics and manufacturing
                              business) from September, 1992 to March, 1995
James W. Wert          52     Director of Park-Ohio since 1992; retired, former Senior
                              Executive Vice President and Chief Investment Officer,
                              KeyCorp (financial services company) from August, 1995 to
                              July, 1996; Chief Financial Officer, KeyCorp from 1994 to
                              1995; Vice Chairman and Chief Financial Officer, Society
                              Corporation (financial services company) from 1990 to 1994;
                              Director of Continental Global Group, Inc., Marlin Leasing
                              Corporation and Paragon Corporate Holdings, Inc.
</TABLE>

COMPENSATION OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS

     We compensate non-employee directors for serving on the Board of Directors
and reimburse them for any expenses incurred in connection with Board of
Directors meetings. During 1998, non-employee directors received compensation in
the form of grants of options to purchase 6,000 shares of common stock of our
parent, Park-Ohio Holdings, in accordance with the 1996 Non-employee Director
Stock Option Plan.

                                       48
<PAGE>   54

                             EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

SUMMARY OF COMPENSATION

     The following table sets forth the respective amounts of compensation paid
to the Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer and the four other
highest paid executive officers of Park-Ohio for each of the years indicated.
All information relating to common stock or options to purchase common stock
refers to shares of common stock of our parent, Park-Ohio Holdings.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                 LONG-TERM
                                                     ANNUAL COMPENSATION                        COMPENSATION
                                                -----------------------------    SECURITIES     ------------
                                                                                 UNDERLYING      ALL OTHER
                   NAME AND                                                       OPTIONS/      COMPENSATION
              PRINCIPAL POSITION                YEAR    SALARY($)    BONUS($)    SARS(#)(1)        ($)(2)
              ------------------                ----    ---------    --------    -----------    ------------
<S>                                             <C>     <C>          <C>         <C>            <C>
Edward F. Crawford............................  1998     500,000      25,000             0           164
  Chairman of the Board,                        1997     225,000      80,000             0           164
  Chief Executive Officer and President         1996     225,000       2,000       500,000           164
Felix J. Tarorick.............................  1998     150,000      55,000         2,000         3,164
  Vice Chairman of the Board and                1997     150,000      50,000             0         3,164
  Vice President of Operations                  1996     150,000      45,000        10,000         3,164
James S. Walker...............................  1998     170,000      30,000         2,000         3,164
  Vice President and                            1997     170,000      36,250             0         3,164
  Chief Financial Officer                       1996     140,000      30,000        10,000         3,464
Ronald J. Cozean..............................  1998     100,000      25,000         3,000         2,664
  Secretary and General Counsel                 1997     100,000      25,000             0         2,664
                                                1996     100,000      25,000         7,000         2,664
Patrick W. Fogarty............................  1998     110,000      35,000         3,000         3,064
  Director of Corporate Development             1997     110,000      35,000             0         3,064
                                                1996     110,000      10,000         4,000         2,564
</TABLE>

- ---------------

(1) Reflects the number of shares of common stock covered by stock options
    granted during the years shown. No stock appreciation rights ("SARs") were
    granted to the officers named in the table above during the years shown.

(2) For the year ended December 31, 1998, all other compensation includes
    contributions made by Park-Ohio under our Supplemental Defined Contribution
    Plan as follows: Mr. Tarorick $3,000 and Mr. Walker $3,000, and under the
    Company's Individual Account Retirement Plan: Mr. Cozean $2,500 and Mr.
    Fogarty $2,900; and insurance premiums of $164 paid by Park-Ohio to each of
    the officers named in the table above.

STOCK BASED COMPENSATION, INCLUDING OPTIONS

     Our 1998 Long-Term Incentive Plan (the "1998 Plan") permits the granting of
stock options (either "incentive stock options" within the meaning of Section
422 of the Internal Revenue Code or nonstatutory stock options), stock
appreciation rights, restricted shares, performance shares or stock awards. The
1998 Plan is administered by the Compensation Committee of the Board of
Directors, which has authority to select officers and key employees to be
participants and to determine the type and number of awards to be granted.

     The number of shares currently available for grant under the 1998 Plan
shall not exceed 550,000, subject to adjustment under certain circumstances when
the number of outstanding shares changes. The option price for stock options
granted under the 1998 Plan is fixed by the Compensation Committee, but in no
event will it be less than the fair market value of Park-Ohio Holdings' common
stock on the date of grant. The 1998 Plan will continue in effect until
terminated by the Board of Directors.

     No awards were made in 1998 under the 1998 Plan. Prior to the 1998 annual
meeting of Park-Ohio Holdings, our Amended and Restated 1992 Stock Option Plan
(the "1992 Plan") was in effect. The Compensation Committee granted stock
options during 1998 under the 1992 Plan. The following tables set forth
information regarding the grant of stock options to the officers named in the
summary compensation table in 1998 and the value of unexercised options as of
December 31, 1998.

                                       49
<PAGE>   55

                           OPTION/SAR GRANTS IN 1998

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   INDIVIDUAL GRANTS
                                -------------------------------------------------------    POTENTIAL REALIZABLE VALUE
                                  NUMBER OF       % OF TOTAL                                 AT ASSUMED ANNUAL RATES
                                 SECURITIES      OPTIONS/SARS                              OF STOCK PRICE APPRECIATION
                                 UNDERLYING       GRANTED TO     EXERCISE                      FOR OPTION TERM(3)
                                OPTIONS/SARS      EMPLOYEES       OR BASE    EXPIRATION   -----------------------------
             NAME               GRANTED(#)(1)   IN FISCAL YEAR   ($/SH)(2)      DATE       0%($)     5%($)      10%($)
             ----               -------------   --------------   ---------   ----------   -------   --------   --------
<S>                             <C>             <C>              <C>         <C>          <C>       <C>        <C>
Ronald J. Cozean..............      3,000            2.6%          18.25      5/27/08         0      34,440     87,270
Edward F. Crawford............          0              0%            N/A          N/A       N/A         N/A        N/A
Patrick W. Fogarty............      3,000            2.6%          18.25      5/27/08         0      34,440     87,270
Felix J. Tarorick.............      2,000            1.7%          18.25      5/27/08         0      22,960     58,180
James S. Walker...............      2,000            1.7%          18.25      5/27/08         0      22,960     58,180
</TABLE>

- ---------------

(1) Options become exercisable to the extent of 33 1/3% of the subject shares
    after one year from the date of grant, 66 2/3% after two years from the date
    of grant, and 100% after three years from the date of grant.

(2) Represents the NASDAQ closing price on the day prior to grant.

(3) The assumed rates of appreciation are not intended to represent either past
    or future appreciation rates with respect to Park-Ohio Holdings' common
    stock. The rates are prescribed in the applicable SEC rules for use by all
    companies for the purpose of this table.

                    AGGREGATED OPTION/SAR EXERCISES IN 1998
                    AND DECEMBER 31, 1998 OPTION/SAR VALUES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                VALUE OF
                                                                           NUMBER OF           UNEXERCISED
                                                                          UNEXERCISED         IN-THE-MONEY
                                                                        OPTIONS/SARS AT      OPTIONS/SARS AT
                                              SHARES                   DECEMBER 31, 1998    DECEMBER 31, 1998
                                             ACQUIRED       VALUE        EXERCISABLE/         EXERCISABLE/
                   NAME                     ON EXERCISE    REALIZED      UNEXERCISABLE      UNEXERCISABLE(1)
                   ----                     -----------    --------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                                         <C>            <C>         <C>                  <C>
Ronald J. Cozean..........................      None           N/A         34,667/5,333     $   92,000/$3,500
Edward F. Crawford........................      None           N/A      200,000/300,000     $300,000/$450,000
Patrick W. Fogarty........................      None           N/A         22,667/4,333     $   21,500/$2,000
Felix J. Tarorick.........................      None           N/A         36,667/5,333     $  153,125/$5,000
James S. Walker...........................     1,500        $6,563         35,167/5,333     $  144,125/$5,000
</TABLE>

- ---------------

(1) The "Value of Unexercised In-the-Money Options/SARs at December 31, 1998"
    was calculated by determining the difference between the fair market value
    of the underlying common stock at December 31, 1998 (the Nasdaq closing
    price of the Park-Ohio Holdings' common stock on December 31, 1998 was
    $15.125) and the exercise price of the option. An option is "In-the-Money"
    when the fair market value of the underlying Park-Ohio Holdings' common
    stock exceeds the exercise price of the option.

                                       50
<PAGE>   56

                             PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS

     All of our outstanding common stock is held by our parent, Park-Ohio
Holdings Corp. The following table sets forth information with respect to the
beneficial ownership of the common stock of Park-Ohio Holdings by:

     - each person (or group of affiliated persons) known to us to be the
       beneficial owner of more than five percent of the outstanding common
       stock of Park-Ohio Holdings;

     - each director of Park-Ohio and Park-Ohio Holdings;

     - each executive officer named in the summary compensation table
       individually; and

     - all directors and executive officers of Park-Ohio and Park-Ohio Holdings
       as a group.

     Unless otherwise indicated, the information is as of June 1, 1999 and the
nature of beneficial ownership consists of sole voting and investment power.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             TOTAL          CURRENTLY
                                                           SHARES OF       EXERCISABLE    PERCENT
               NAME OF BENEFICIAL OWNER                 COMMON STOCK(a)      OPTIONS      OF CLASS
               ------------------------                 ---------------    -----------    --------
<S>                                                     <C>                <C>            <C>
Edward F. Crawford....................................     2,807,000(b)(c)   300,000       25.3%
Matthew V. Crawford...................................       583,934(c)       28,334        5.4%
Thomas E. McGinty.....................................       129,700          18,000        1.2%
Felix J. Tarorick.....................................        93,167          40,667           *
James W. Wert.........................................        60,000          18,000           *
James S. Walker.......................................        58,267          39,167           *
Lawrence O. Selhorst..................................        49,701          18,000           *
Ronald J. Cozean......................................        38,000          38,000           *
Lewis E. Hatch, Jr....................................        32,060          18,000           *
Patrick W. Fogarty....................................        25,000          25,000           *
Kevin R. Greene.......................................        11,000           6,000           *
Capital Research and Management Company...............       750,000(d)                     7.0%
Artisan Partners Limited Partnership..................       730,400(e)                     6.8%
Dimensional Fund Advisors, Inc........................       704,561(f)                     6.5%
GAMCO Investors, Inc..................................       913,929(g)                     8.5%
Directors and executive Officers as a group (11
  persons)............................................     3,837,829                       33.9%
</TABLE>

- ---------------

* Less than one percent.

(a) Total includes currently exercisable options.

(b) The total includes 2,525,000 shares over which Mr. E. Crawford has sole
    voting and investment power, 22,500 shares owned by L'Accent de Provence of
    which Mr. E. Crawford is President and owner of 25% of its capital stock and
    over which Mr. E. Crawford shares voting and investment power, and 9,500
    shares owned by Mr. E. Crawford's wife as to which Mr. E. Crawford disclaims
    beneficial ownership. The address of Mr. E. Crawford is the business address
    of Park-Ohio

(c) Messrs. E. Crawford and M. Crawford have shared voting power and investment
    power with respect to 50,000 shares held by a charitable foundation. The
    50,000 shares are included in the beneficial ownership amounts reported for
    both Mr. E. Crawford and Mr. M. Crawford.

(d) Based on information set forth on Schedule 13G dated February 8, 1999.
    Capital Research and Management Company, a registered investment adviser,
    reported no voting power and sole investment power over 750,000 shares, but
    disclaimed beneficial ownership of all such shares, as of December 31, 1998.
    The address for Capital Research is 333 South Hope Street, Los Angeles,
    California 90071.

                                       51
<PAGE>   57

(e) Based on information set forth on Amendment No. 1 to Schedule 13G dated
    February 10, 1999. Artisan Partners Limited Partnership reported beneficial
    ownership of 730,400 shares as of December 31, 1998. Artisan Partners
    reported shared voting and investment power with respect to all such shares.
    The address for Artisan Partners is 1000 North Water Street, #1770,
    Milwaukee, Wisconsin 53202.

(f) Based on information set forth on Amendment No. 2 to Schedule 13G dated
    February 11, 1999. Dimensional Fund Advisors Inc., a registered investment
    advisor, furnishes investment advice to four investment companies and serves
    as investment manager to certain other investment vehicles, including
    commingled group trusts (the "Portfolios"). Dimensional reported beneficial
    ownership of 704,561 shares as of December 31, 1998, all of which shares
    were held by the Portfolios. Dimensional reported sole voting and investment
    power with respect to all of such shares, but disclaimed beneficial
    ownership of all such shares. The address for Dimensional is 1299 Ocean
    Avenue, 11th Floor, Santa Monica, California 90401.

(g) Based on information set forth on Amendment No. 4 to Schedule 13D dated June
    17, 1999. Includes 730,375 shares held by GAMCO Investors, Inc., 170,715
    shares held by Gabelli Funds, LLC, 7,500 shares held by Gabelli Performance
    Partnership L.P., 2,000 shares held by Gabelli International Limited and
    3,339 shares held by Mr. Mario J. Gabelli, as of June 14, 1999. Gabelli
    Funds, Inc. is the ultimate parent holding company for the above listed
    companies, and Mr. Mario J. Gabelli is the majority owner of Gabelli Funds,
    Inc. which has its principal business office at One Corporate Center, Rye,
    New York 10580.

                           RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

     General Aluminum, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Park-Ohio, leases space in
three buildings in Conneaut, Ohio:

     - a 91,500 square foot facility owned by a company owned by Mr. M.
       Crawford, at a monthly rent of $27,000;

     - a 70,000 square foot attached facility owned by the same company, at a
       monthly rent of $9,000; and

     - a separate 50,000 square foot facility owned by Mrs. E. Crawford, at a
       monthly rent of $3,000.

     In addition, Ajax, a wholly owned subsidiary of Park-Ohio, leases a
facility in Cleveland, Ohio at a monthly rent of $23,833. This facility is owned
by a corporation whose shareholders are Mr. E. Crawford and his son, Mr. M.
Crawford.

     We believe that all of these transactions were on terms at least as
favorable to us as if negotiated on an arms-length basis with unrelated third
parties.

                                       52
<PAGE>   58

                            DESCRIPTION OF THE NOTES

     The notes and the Exchange Notes (collectively the "Notes") were issued
under an indenture, dated as of June 2, 1999 (the "Indenture") by and between
Park-Ohio Industries, Inc. (the "Company") and Norwest Bank Minnesota, N.A., as
trustee (the "Trustee"). The terms of the Notes include those stated in the
Indenture and those made part of the Indenture by reference to the Trust
Indenture Act of 1939, as amended (the "Trust Indenture Act") as in effect on
the date of the Indenture. The Notes are subject to all such terms, and holders
of the Notes are referred to the Indenture and the Trust Indenture Act for a
statement of them. The following is a summary of the material terms and
provisions of the Notes. This summary does not purport to be a complete
description of the Notes and is subject to the detailed provisions of, and
qualified in its entirety by reference to, the Notes and the Indenture
(including the definitions contained therein). A copy of the form of Indenture
may be obtained from the Company by any holder or prospective investor upon
request. Definitions relating to certain capitalized terms are set forth under
"-- Certain Definitions". Capitalized terms that are used but not otherwise
defined herein have the meanings ascribed to them in the Indenture and such
definitions are incorporated herein by reference.

GENERAL

     The Notes will be limited in aggregate principal amount to $200.0 million,
provided that $150.0 million of notes reserved for issuance under the Indenture
will be available only in connection with the exchange of Series B Notes for
Exchange Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer. The Notes will be general
unsecured obligations of the Company and will rank subordinate in right of
payment to any Senior Indebtedness of the Company, pari passu with any senior
subordinated indebtedness and senior in right of payment to any existing or
future subordinated Indebtedness of the Company.

     A majority of the operations of the Company are conducted through its
Subsidiaries and, therefore, the Company is dependent upon the cash flow of its
Subsidiaries to meet its obligations, including its obligations under the Notes.
The Notes will be effectively subordinated to all Indebtedness and other
liabilities (including trade payables) of the Company's Subsidiaries. Any right
of the Company to receive assets of any of its Subsidiaries upon a Subsidiary's
liquidation or reorganization (and the consequent right of the holders of the
Notes to participate in those assets) will be effectively subordinated to the
claims of that Subsidiary's creditors.

MATURITY, INTEREST AND PRINCIPAL

     The Notes will mature on December 1, 2007. The Notes will bear interest at
a rate of 9 1/4% per annum from the Issue Date until maturity. Interest is
payable semiannually in arrears on each June 1 and December 1 commencing
December 1, 1999, to holders of record of the Notes at the close of business on
the immediately preceding May 15 and November 15, respectively. The interest
rate on the Notes is subject to increase, and such Additional Interest will be
payable on the payment dates set forth above, in certain circumstances, if the
Notes (or other securities substantially similar to the Notes) are not
registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission within the prescribed
time periods. See "Exchange Offer; Registration Rights."

OPTIONAL REDEMPTION

     The Notes will be redeemable at the option of the Company, in whole at any
time or in part from time to time on or after December 1, 2002 at the following
redemption prices (expressed as percentages of the principal amount thereof),
together, in each case, with accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the
redemption date, if redeemed during the twelve-month period beginning on
December 1 of each year listed below:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                       YEAR                            PERCENTAGE
                       ----                            ----------
<S>                                                    <C>
2002...............................................    104.625%
2003...............................................    103.083%
2004...............................................    101.542%
2005 and thereafter................................    100.000%
</TABLE>

                                       53
<PAGE>   59

     Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Company may redeem in the aggregate up
to 35% of the original principal amount of Notes at any time and from time to
time prior to December 1, 2000 at a redemption price equal to 109.250% of the
aggregate principal amount so redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if
any, to the redemption date out of the Net Proceeds of one or more Public Equity
Offerings; provided that at least 65% of the principal amount of Notes
originally issued remains outstanding immediately after the occurrence of any
such redemption and that any such redemption occurs within 60 days following the
closing of any such Public Equity Offering.

     In the event of a redemption of fewer than all of the Notes, the Trustee
shall select the Notes to be redeemed in compliance with the requirements of the
principal national securities exchange, if any, or while such Notes are listed,
or if such Notes are not then listed on a national securities exchange, on a pro
rata basis, by lot or in such other manner as the Trustee shall deem fair and
equitable. The Notes will be redeemable in whole or in part upon not less than
30 nor more than 60 days' prior written notice, mailed by first class mail to a
holder's last address as it shall appear on the register maintained by the
Registrar of the Notes. On and after any redemption date, interest will cease to
accrue on the Notes or portions thereof called for redemption unless the Company
shall fail to redeem any such Note.

SUBORDINATION

     The indebtedness represented by the Notes is, to the extent and in the
manner provided in the Indenture, subordinated in right of payment to the prior
indefeasible payment and satisfaction in full in cash of all existing and future
Senior Indebtedness of the Company. As of March 31, 1999, after giving pro forma
effect to the application of the net proceeds of the Offering, the principal
amount of outstanding Senior Indebtedness of the Company, on a consolidated
basis, would have been $71.3 million.

     In the event of any insolvency or bankruptcy case or proceeding, or any
receivership, arrangement, reorganization, liquidation, dissolution or other
winding-up or other similar case or proceeding in connection therewith whether
or not involving insolvency or bankruptcy, relative to the Company or to its
creditors, as such, or to the Company's assets, whether voluntary or
involuntary, or any general assignment for the benefit of creditors or other
marshaling of assets or liabilities of the Company (except in connection with
the merger or consolidation of the Company or its liquidation or dissolution
following the transfer of all or substantially all of its assets, upon the terms
and conditions permitted under the circumstances described under ' -- Merger,
Consolidation or Sale of Assets" below) (all of the foregoing referred to herein
individually as a "Bankruptcy Proceeding" and collectively as "Bankruptcy
Proceedings"), the holders of Senior Indebtedness of the Company will be
entitled to receive payment and satisfaction in full in cash of all amounts due
on or in respect of all Senior Indebtedness of the Company before the holders of
the Notes are entitled to receive or retain any payment or distribution of any
kind on account of the Notes.

     In the event that, notwithstanding the foregoing, the Trustee or any holder
of Notes receives any payment or distribution of assets of the Company of any
kind, whether in cash, property or securities, including, without limitation, by
way of set-off or otherwise, in respect of the Notes before all Senior
Indebtedness of the Company is paid and satisfied in full in cash, then such
payment or distribution will be held by the recipient in trust for the benefit
of holders of Senior Indebtedness and will be immediately paid over or delivered
to the holders of Senior Indebtedness or their representative or representatives
to the extent necessary to make payment in full of all Senior Indebtedness
remaining unpaid, after giving effect to any concurrent payment or distribution,
or provision therefor, to or for the holders of Senior Indebtedness. By reason
of such subordination, in the event of any such Bankruptcy Proceeding, creditors
of the Company who are holders of Senior Indebtedness may recover more, ratably,
than other creditors of the Company, including holders of the Notes.

     Upon the occurrence of a Payment Default on Designated Senior Indebtedness,
no payment or distribution of any kind or character (including, without
limitation, cash, property and any payment or distribution which may be payable
or deliverable by reason of the payment of any other Indebtedness of the Company
being subordinated to the payment of the Notes by the Company) may be made by or
on behalf of the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company, including, without
limitation, by way of set-off or otherwise, for or on account of the Notes, or
for or on account of the purchase, redemption or other acquisition of any Notes,
and neither the Trustee nor any

                                       54
<PAGE>   60

holder or owner of any Notes shall take or receive from the Company or any
Subsidiary of the Company, directly or indirectly in any manner, payment in
respect of all or any portion of Notes commencing on the date of receipt by the
Trustee of written notice from the representative of the holders of Designated
Senior Indebtedness (the "Representative") of the occurrence of such Payment
Default, and in any such event, such prohibition shall continue until such
Payment Default is cured, waived in writing or otherwise ceases to exist. At
such time as the prohibition set forth in the preceding sentence shall no longer
be in effect, subject to the provisions of the following paragraph, the Company
shall resume making any and all required payments in respect of the Notes,
including any missed payments.

     Upon the occurrence of a Non-Payment Event of Default on Designated Senior
Indebtedness, no payment or distribution of any kind or character (including,
without limitation, cash, property and any payment or distribution which may be
payable or deliverable by reason of the payment of any other indebtedness of the
Company being subordinated to the payment of the Notes by the Company) may be
made by the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company, including, without
limitation, by way of set-off or otherwise, for or on account of the Notes, or
for or on account of the purchase, redemption or other acquisition of any Notes,
and neither the Trustee nor any holder or owner of any Notes shall take or
receive from the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company, directly or
indirectly in any manner, payment in respect of all or any portion of the Notes
for a period (a "Payment Blockage Period") commencing on the date of receipt by
the Trustee of written notice from the Representative of such Non-Payment Event
of Default unless and until (subject to any blockage of payments that may then
be in effect under the preceding paragraph) the earliest of:

          (i) more than 179 days shall have elapsed since receipt of such
     written notice by the Trustee,

          (ii) such Non-Payment Event of Default shall have been cured or waived
     in writing or otherwise shall have ceased to exist or such Designated
     Senior Indebtedness shall have been paid in full, or

          (iii) such Payment Blockage Period shall have been terminated by
     written notice to the Company or the Trustee from such Representative,

after which, in the case of clause (i), (ii) or (iii), the Company shall resume
making any and all required payments in respect of the Notes, including any
missed payments.

     Notwithstanding any other provision of the Indenture, in no event shall a
Payment Blockage Period commenced in accordance with the provisions of the
Indenture described in this paragraph extend beyond 179 days from the date of
the receipt by the Trustee of the notice referred to above (the "Initial
Blockage Period"). Any number of additional Payment Blockage Periods may be
commenced during the Initial Blockage Period; provided, however, that no such
additional Payment Blockage Period shall extend beyond the Initial Blockage
Period. After the expiration of the Initial Blockage Period, no Payment Blockage
Period may be commenced until at least 180 consecutive days have elapsed from
the last day of the Initial Blockage Period. Notwithstanding any other provision
of the Indenture, no Non-Payment Event of Default with respect to Designated
Senior Indebtedness which existed or was continuing on the date of the
commencement of any Payment Blockage Period initiated by the Representative
shall be, or be made, the basis for the commencement of a second Payment
Blockage Period initiated by the Representative, whether or not within the
Initial Blockage Period, unless such Non-Payment Event of Default shall have
been cured or waived for a period of not less than 90 consecutive days.

     If the Company fails to make any payment on the Notes when due or within
any applicable grace period, whether or not on account of payment blockage
provisions, such failure would constitute an Event of Default under the
Indenture and would enable the holders of the Notes to accelerate the maturity
thereof. See "-- Events of Default."

     A holder of Notes by its acceptance of Notes agrees to be bound by such
provisions and authorizes and expressly directs the Trustee, on its behalf, to
take such action as may be necessary or appropriate to effectuate the
subordination provided for in the Indenture and appoints the Trustee its
attorney-in-fact for such purpose.

                                       55
<PAGE>   61

COVENANTS

     The Indenture will contain, among others, the following covenants:

LIMITATION ON ADDITIONAL INDEBTEDNESS

     The Company will not, directly or indirectly, incur (as defined) any
Indebtedness (including Acquired Indebtedness); provided that if no Default or
Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing at the time or as a
consequence of the incurrence of such Indebtedness, the Company may incur
Indebtedness (including Acquired Indebtedness) if after giving effect to the
incurrence of such Indebtedness and the receipt and application of the proceeds
thereof, the Company's Consolidated Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio is at least 2.25
to 1. In addition, none of the Subsidiaries of the Company will, directly or
indirectly, incur any Subsidiary Indebtedness; provided that if no Default or
Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing at the time or as a
consequence of the incurrence of such Subsidiary Indebtedness, any of the
Company's Subsidiaries may incur Subsidiary Indebtedness if after giving effect
to the incurrence of such Subsidiary Indebtedness and the receipt and
application of the proceeds thereof, such Subsidiary's Consolidated Fixed Charge
Coverage Ratio is at least 2.5 to 1.

     Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Company and its Subsidiaries may incur
Permitted Indebtedness; provided that the Company will not incur any Permitted
Indebtedness that ranks junior in right of payment to the Notes that has a
maturity or mandatory sinking fund payment prior to the maturity of the Notes.

LIMITATION ON OTHER SENIOR SUBORDINATED INDEBTEDNESS

     The Company will not, and will not permit any of its Subsidiaries to,
directly or indirectly, incur, contingently or otherwise, any Indebtedness that
is both:

          (i) subordinated in right of payment to any Senior Indebtedness of the
     Company or any of its Subsidiaries, as the case may be, and

          (ii) in right of payment to the Notes.

     For purposes of this covenant, Indebtedness is deemed to be senior in right
of payment to the Notes, if it is not explicitly subordinated in right of
payment to Senior Indebtedness at least to the same extent as the Notes are
subordinated to such Senior Indebtedness.

LIMITATION ON RESTRICTED PAYMENTS

     The Company will not make, and will not permit any of its Subsidiaries to,
directly or indirectly, make, any Restricted Payment, unless:

          (a) no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be
     continuing at the time of or immediately after giving effect to such
     Restricted Payment,

          (b) immediately after giving pro forma effect to such Restricted
     Payment, the Company could incur $1.00 of additional Indebtedness (other
     than Permitted Indebtedness) under " -- Limitation on Additional
     Indebtedness" above, and

          (c) immediately after giving effect to such Restricted Payment, the
     aggregate of all Restricted Payments declared or made after the Original
     Issue Date does not exceed the sum of:

             (1) 50% of the Company's cumulative Consolidated Net Income
        subsequent to the Original Issue Date (or minus 100% of any cumulative
        deficit in Consolidated Net Income during such period) subsequent to the
        Original Issue Date, plus

             (2) 100% of the aggregate Net Proceeds received by the Company from
        the issue or sale after the Original Issue Date of Capital Stock (other
        than Disqualified Capital Stock or Capital Stock of the Company issued
        to any Subsidiary of the Company) of the Company or any Indebtedness or
        other securities of the Company convertible into or exercisable or
        exchangeable for Capital Stock (other than

                                       56
<PAGE>   62

        Disqualified Capital Stock) of the Company which has been so converted,
        exercised or exchanged, as the case may be, plus

             (3) without duplication of any amounts included in clause (c)(2)
        above, 100% of the aggregate Net Proceeds received by the Company of any
        equity contribution from a holder of the Company's Capital Stock, plus

             (4) $5,000,000, excluding in the case of clauses (c)(2) and (3),
        any Net Proceeds from a Public Equity Offering to the extent used to
        redeem the Notes.

     For purposes of determining under this clause (c) the amount expended for
Restricted Payments, cash distributed shall be valued at the face amount thereof
and property other than cash shall be valued at its fair market value.

     The provisions of this covenant shall not prohibit:

          (i) the payment of any distribution within 60 days after the date of
     declaration thereof, if at such date of declaration such payment would
     comply with the provisions of the Indenture,

          (ii) the repurchase, redemption or other acquisition or retirement of
     any shares of Capital Stock of the Company or Indebtedness subordinated to
     the Notes by conversion into, or by or in exchange for, shares of Capital
     Stock of the Company (other than Disqualified Capital Stock), or out of the
     Net Proceeds of the substantially concurrent sale (other than to a
     Subsidiary of the Company) of other shares of Capital Stock of the Company
     (other than Disqualified Capital Stock),

          (iii) the redemption or retirement of Indebtedness of the Company
     subordinated to the Notes in exchange for, by conversion into, or out of
     the Net Proceeds of, a substantially concurrent sale or incurrence of
     Indebtedness of the Company (other than any Indebtedness owed to a
     Subsidiary) that is contractually subordinated in right of payment to the
     Notes to at least the same extent as the Indebtedness being redeemed or
     retired,

          (iv) the retirement of any shares of Disqualified Capital Stock of the
     Company by conversion into, or by exchange for, shares of Disqualified
     Capital Stock of the Company, or out of the Net Proceeds of the
     substantially concurrent sale (other than to a Subsidiary of the Company)
     of other shares of Disqualified Capital Stock of the Company,

          (v) so long as no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and
     be continuing, payments made with respect to extinguishment of fractional
     shares or odd-lot shares not to exceed $250,000 in the aggregate,

          (vi) payments to a holding company that, directly or indirectly, owns
     all of the outstanding Capital Stock of the Company, in amounts sufficient
     to pay:

             (a) franchise taxes and other fees required to maintain its
        corporate existence,

             (b) costs associated with preparation of required documents for
        filing with the Securities and Exchange Commission and with any exchange
        on which such company's securities are traded,

             (c) federal, state, foreign and local taxes to the extent that such
        taxes are attributable to the ownership of the Company and its
        Subsidiaries, and

             (d) other operating or administrative costs of up to $200,000 per
        year, or

          (vii) payments, directly or indirectly, to employees to repurchase
     Capital Stock or other securities of the Company or of a holding company
     that, directly or indirectly, owns all of the outstanding Capital Stock of
     the Company upon the death, disability or termination of employment of such
     employees, in amounts not to exceed, in the aggregate, $1,500,000 per year;

provided that in calculating the aggregate amount of Restricted Payments made
subsequent to the Original Issue Date for purposes of clause (c) of the
immediately preceding paragraph, amounts expended pursuant to clauses (i), (v)
and (vii) shall be included in such calculation.

                                       57
<PAGE>   63

     Not later than the date of making any Restricted Payment, the Company shall
deliver to the Trustee an Officers' Certificate stating that such Restricted
Payment is permitted and setting forth the basis upon which the calculations
required by the covenant described above were computed, which calculations may
be based upon the Company's latest available financial statements, and that no
Default or Event of Default has occurred and is continuing and no Default or
Event of Default will occur immediately after giving effect to any such
Restricted Payments.

LIMITATION ON LIENS

     The Company will not, and will not permit any of its Subsidiaries to,
create, incur or otherwise cause or suffer to exist or become effective any
Liens of any kind (other than Permitted Liens) upon any property or asset of the
Company or any of its Subsidiaries or any shares of Capital Stock or
Indebtedness of any Subsidiary of the Company which owns property or assets, now
owned or hereafter acquired, unless:

          (i) if such Lien secures Indebtedness which is pari passu with the
     Notes, then the Notes are secured on an equal and ratable basis with the
     obligations so secured until such time as such obligation is no longer
     secured by a Lien, or

          (ii) if such Lien secures Indebtedness which is subordinated to the
     Notes, any such Lien shall be subordinated to the Lien granted to the
     holders of the Notes to the same extent as such Indebtedness is
     subordinated to the Notes.

LIMITATION ON TRANSACTIONS WITH AFFILIATES

     The Company will not, and will not permit any of its Subsidiaries to,
directly or indirectly, enter into or suffer to exist any transaction or series
of related transactions (including, without limitation, the sale, purchase,
exchange or lease of assets, property or services) with any Affiliate (each an
"Affiliate Transaction") or extend, renew, waive or otherwise modify the terms
of any Affiliate Transaction entered into prior to the Original Issue Date
unless:

          (i) such Affiliate Transaction is between or among the Company and its
     Wholly Owned Subsidiaries, or

          (ii) the terms of such Affiliate Transaction are fair and reasonable
     to the Company or such Subsidiary, as the case may be, and the terms of
     such Affiliate Transaction are at least as favorable as the terms which
     could be obtained by the Company or such Subsidiary, as the case may be, in
     a comparable transaction made on an arm's-length basis between unaffiliated
     parties.

     In any Affiliate Transaction (or any series of related Affiliate
Transactions which are similar or part of a common plan) involving an amount or
having a fair market value in excess of $2 million which is not permitted under
clause (i) above, the Company must obtain a resolution of the Board of Directors
of the Company certifying that such Affiliate Transaction complies with clause
(ii) above. In any Affiliate Transaction (or any series of related Affiliate
Transactions which are similar or part of a common plan) involving an amount or
having a fair market value in excess of $10 million which is not permitted under
clause (i) above, the Company must obtain a favorable written opinion as to the
fairness of such transaction or transactions, as the case may be, from an
Independent Financial Advisor.

     The foregoing provisions will not apply to:

          (i) any Restricted Payment that is not prohibited by the provisions
     described under "-- Limitation on Restricted Payments" above, or

          (ii) reasonable fees and compensation paid to and indemnity provided
     on behalf of, officers, directors or employees of the Company or any
     Subsidiary of the Company as determined in good faith by the Company's
     Board of Directors or senior management.

LIMITATION ON CERTAIN ASSET SALES

     The Company will not, and will not permit any of its Subsidiaries to,
consummate an Asset Sale unless:

                                       58
<PAGE>   64

          (i) the Company or such applicable Subsidiary, as the case may be,
     receives consideration at the time of such sale or other disposition at
     least equal to the fair market value of the assets sold or otherwise
     disposed of (as determined in good faith by the Board of Directors of the
     Company, and evidenced by a board resolution),

          (ii) not less than 80% of the consideration received by the Company or
     such applicable Subsidiary, as the case may be, is in the form of cash or
     Cash Equivalents, and

          (iii) the Asset Sale Proceeds received by the Company or such
     Subsidiary are applied:

             (a) first, to the extent the Company or any such Subsidiary, as the
        case may be, elects, or is required, to prepay, repay or purchase
        indebtedness under any then existing Senior Indebtedness of the Company
        or any such Subsidiary within 12 months following the receipt of the
        Asset Sale Proceeds from any Asset Sale; provided that any such
        repayment shall result in a permanent reduction of the commitments
        thereunder in an amount equal to the principal amount so repaid,

             (b) second, to the extent of the balance of Asset Sale Proceeds
        after application as described above, to the extent the Company elects,
        to an investment in assets (including Capital Stock or other securities
        purchased in connection with the acquisition of Capital Stock or
        property of another Person) used or useful in businesses similar or
        ancillary to the business of the Company or any such Subsidiary as
        conducted on the Original Issue Date; provided that such investment
        occurs on or prior to the 365th day following receipt of such Asset Sale
        Proceeds (the "Reinvestment Date"), and

             (c) third, if on the Reinvestment Date the Available Asset Sale
        Proceeds exceed $10 million, the Company shall apply an amount equal to
        such Available Asset Sale Proceeds, first, to an offer to purchase the
        Series A/B Notes, if any are outstanding, in accordance with the terms
        of the Series A/B Indenture (as in effect on the Issue Date) (the
        "Series A/B Asset Sale Offer") and second, in the event that any
        available Asset Sale Proceeds are not applied to a Series A/B Asset Sale
        Offer, an offer to repurchase the Notes, at a purchase price in cash
        equal to 100% of the principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid
        interest, if any, to the purchase date (an "Excess Proceeds Offer"). If
        an Excess Proceeds Offer is not fully subscribed, the Company may retain
        the portion of the Available Asset Sale Proceeds not required to
        purchase Notes.

     If the Company is required to make an Excess Proceeds Offer, the Company
shall mail, within 30 days following the Reinvestment Date, a notice to the
holders stating, among other things:

          (i) that such holders have the right to require the Company to apply
     the Available Asset Sale Proceeds to repurchase such Notes at a purchase
     price in cash equal to 100% of the principal amount thereof plus accrued
     and unpaid interest, if any, to the purchase date,

          (ii) the purchase date, which shall be no earlier than 30 days and not
     later than 45 days from the date such notice is mailed,

          (iii) the instructions that each holder must follow in order to have
     such Notes purchased, and

          (iv) the calculations used in determining the amount of Available
     Asset Sale Proceeds to be applied to the purchase of such Notes.

     In the event of the transfer of substantially all of the property and
assets of the Company and its Subsidiaries as an entirety to a Person in a
transaction permitted under "-- Merger, Consolidation or Sale of Assets" below,
the successor Person shall be deemed to have sold the properties and assets of
the Company and its Subsidiaries not so transferred for purposes of this
covenant, and shall comply with the provisions of this covenant with respect to
such deemed sale as if it were an Asset Sale.

     The Company will comply with the requirements of Rule 14e-1 under the
Exchange Act and other securities laws and regulations thereunder to the extent
such laws and regulations are applicable in connection with the repurchase of
Notes pursuant to an Excess Proceeds Offer. To the extent that the provisions of
any securities laws or regulations conflict with the "Asset Sale" provisions of
the Indenture, the Company shall comply with the

                                       59
<PAGE>   65

applicable securities laws and regulations and shall not be deemed to have
breached its obligations under the "Asset Sale" provisions of the Indenture by
virtue thereof.

LIMITATION ON PREFERRED STOCK OF SUBSIDIARIES

     The Company will not permit any of its Subsidiaries to issue any Preferred
Stock (except Preferred Stock issued to the Company or a Wholly Owned Subsidiary
of the Company) or permit any Person (other than the Company or a Wholly Owned
Subsidiary of the Company) to hold any such Preferred Stock unless the Company
or such Subsidiary would be entitled to incur or assume Indebtedness under
"-- Limitation on Additional Indebtedness" above (other than Permitted
Indebtedness) in the aggregate principal amount equal to the aggregate
liquidation value of the Preferred Stock to be issued.

LIMITATION ON CAPITAL STOCK OF SUBSIDIARIES

     The Company will not:

          (i) sell, pledge, hypothecate or otherwise convey or dispose of any
     Capital Stock of a Subsidiary of the Company, or

          (ii) permit any of its Subsidiaries to issue any Capital Stock, other
     than to the Company or a Wholly Owned Subsidiary of the Company.

     The foregoing restrictions shall not apply to an Asset Sale made in
compliance with "-- Limitation on Certain Asset Sales" above or the issuance of
Preferred Stock in compliance with "-- Limitation on Preferred Stock of
Subsidiaries" above.

LIMITATION ON DIVIDEND AND OTHER PAYMENT RESTRICTIONS AFFECTING SUBSIDIARIES

     The Company will not, and will not permit any of its Subsidiaries to,
directly or indirectly, create or otherwise cause or suffer to exist or become
effective any encumbrance or restriction on the ability of any Subsidiary of the
Company to:

          (i) (a) pay dividends or make any other distributions to the Company
     or any Subsidiary of the Company:

             (1) on its Capital Stock, or

             (2) with respect to any other interest or participation in, or
        measured by, its profits, or

          (b) repay any Indebtedness or any other obligation owed to the Company
     or any Subsidiary of the Company,

          (ii) make loans or advances or capital contributions to the Company or
     any of its Subsidiaries, or

          (iii) transfer any of its properties or assets to the Company or any
     of its Subsidiaries, except for such encumbrances or restrictions existing
     under or by reason of:

             (a) encumbrances or restrictions existing on the Original Issue
        Date to the extent and in the manner such encumbrances and restrictions
        are in effect on the Original Issue Date or encumbrances or restrictions
        existing on the Issue Date in compliance with the Series A/B Indenture,

             (b) applicable law,

             (c) any instrument governing Acquired Indebtedness, which
        encumbrance or restriction is not applicable to any Person, or the
        properties or assets of any Person, other than the Person, or the
        property or assets of the Person (including any Subsidiary of the
        Person), so acquired,

             (d) customary non-assignment provisions in leases or other
        agreements entered in the ordinary course of business and consistent
        with past practices,

                                       60
<PAGE>   66

             (e) Refinancing Indebtedness; provided that such restrictions are
        no more restrictive than those contained in the agreements governing the
        Indebtedness being extended, refinanced, renewed, replaced, defeased or
        refunded, or

             (f) customary restrictions in security agreements or mortgages
        securing Indebtedness of the Company or a Subsidiary to the extent such
        restrictions restrict the transfer of the property subject to such
        security agreements and mortgages.

LIMITATION ON SALE AND LEASE-BACK TRANSACTIONS

     The Company will not, and will not permit any of its Subsidiaries to, enter
into any Sale and Lease-Back Transaction unless:

          (i) the consideration received in such Sale and Lease-Back Transaction
     is at least equal to the fair market value of the property sold, as
     determined in good faith by the Board of Directors of the Company and
     evidenced by a board resolution, and

          (ii) the Company could incur the Attributable Indebtedness in respect
     of such Sale and Lease-Back Transaction in compliance with "-- Limitation
     on Additional Indebtedness" above.

PAYMENTS FOR CONSENT

     The Company will not, and will not permit any of its Subsidiaries to,
directly or indirectly, pay or cause to be paid any consideration, whether by
way of interest, fee or otherwise, to any holder of any Notes for or as an
inducement to any consent, waiver or amendment of any of the terms or provisions
of the Indenture or the Notes unless such consideration is offered to be paid or
agreed to be paid to all holders of the Notes which so consent, waive or agree
to amend in the time frame set forth in solicitation documents relating to such
consent, waiver or agreement.

CHANGE OF CONTROL OFFER

     Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control, the Company shall be obligated
to make an offer to purchase (the "Change of Control Offer") each holder's
outstanding Notes at a purchase price (the "Change of Control Purchase Price")
equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest,
if any, to the Change of Control Payment Date (as defined) in accordance with
the procedures set forth below.

     Within 20 days of the occurrence of a Change of Control, the Company shall:

          (i) cause a notice of the Change of Control Offer to be sent at least
     once to the Dow Jones News Service or similar business news service in the
     United States, and

          (ii) send by first-class mail, postage prepaid, to the Trustee and to
     each holder of the Notes, at the address appearing in the register
     maintained by the Registrar of the Notes, a notice stating:

             (a) that the Change of Control Offer is being made pursuant to this
        covenant and that all Notes tendered will be accepted for payment,

             (b) the Change of Control Purchase Price and the purchase date
        (which shall be a Business Day no earlier than 30 days nor later than 45
        days from the date such notice is mailed (the "Change of Control Payment
        Date"),

             (c) that any Note not tendered will continue to accrue interest,

             (d) that, unless the Company defaults in the payment of the Change
        of Control Purchase Price, any Notes accepted for payment pursuant to
        the Change of Control Offer shall cease to accrue interest after the
        Change of Control Payment Date,

             (e) that holders accepting the offer to have their Notes purchased
        pursuant to a Change of Control Offer will be required to surrender the
        Notes to the Paying Agent at the address specified in the notice prior
        to the close of business on the Business Day preceding the Change of
        Control Payment Date,

                                       61
<PAGE>   67

             (f) that holders will be entitled to withdraw their acceptance if
        the Paying Agent receives, not later than the close of business on the
        third Business Day preceding the Change of Control Payment Date, a
        telegram, telex, facsimile transmission or letter setting forth the name
        of the holder, the principal amount of the Notes delivered for purchase,
        and a statement that such holder is withdrawing his election to have
        such Notes purchased,

             (g) that holders whose Notes are being purchased only in part will
        be issued new Notes equal in principal amount to the unpurchased portion
        of the Notes surrendered,

             (h) any other procedures that a holder must follow to accept a
        Change of Control Offer or effect withdrawal of such acceptance, and

             (i) the name and address of the Paying Agent.

     On the Change of Control Payment Date, the Company shall, to the extent
lawful:

          (i) accept for payment Notes or portions thereof tendered pursuant to
     the Change of Control Offer,

          (ii) deposit with the Paying Agent money sufficient to pay the
     purchase price of all Notes or portions thereof so tendered, and

          (iii) deliver or cause to be delivered to the Trustee Notes so
     accepted together with an Officers' Certificate stating the Notes or
     portions thereof tendered to the Company.

     The Paying Agent shall promptly mail to each holder of Notes so accepted
payment in an amount equal to the purchase price for such Notes, and the Company
shall execute and issue, and the Trustee shall promptly authenticate and mail to
such holder, a new Note equal in principal amount to any unpurchased portion of
the Notes surrendered; provided that each such new Note shall be issued in an
original principal amount in denominations of $1,000 and integral multiples
thereof.

     The Indenture requires that if the Revolving Credit Facility is in effect,
or any amounts are owing thereunder or in respect thereof, at the time of the
occurrence of a Change of Control, prior to the mailing of the notice to holders
described in the second preceding paragraph, but in any event within 20 days
following any Change of Control, the Company covenants to:

          (i) repay in full all obligations and terminate all commitments under
     or in respect of the Revolving Credit Facility and all other Senior
     Indebtedness the terms of which require repayment upon a Change of Control
     or offer to repay in full all obligations and terminate all commitments
     under or in respect of the Revolving Credit Facility and all such Senior
     Indebtedness and repay the Indebtedness owed to each such lender who has
     accepted such offer, or

          (ii) obtain the requisite consents under the Revolving Credit Facility
     and all such other Senior Indebtedness to permit the repurchase of the
     Notes as described above.

     The Company must first comply with the covenant described in the preceding
sentence before it shall be required to purchase Notes in the event of a Change
of Control; provided that the Company's failure to comply with the covenant
described in the preceding sentence constitutes an Event of Default described in
clause (iii) under "-- Events of Default" below if not cured within 30 days
after the notice required by such clause. As a result of the foregoing, a holder
of the Notes may not be able to compel the Company to purchase the Notes unless
the Company is able at the time to refinance all of the obligations under or in
respect of the Revolving Credit Facility and all such other Senior Indebtedness
or obtain requisite consents under the Revolving Credit Facility and all such
other Senior Indebtedness.

                                       62
<PAGE>   68

     The Indenture will further provide that:

          (i) if the Company or any Subsidiary thereof has issued any
     outstanding:

             (a) indebtedness that is subordinated in right of payment to the
        Notes, or

             (b) Preferred Stock, and the Company or such Subsidiary is required
        to make a Change of Control Offer or to make a distribution with respect
        to such subordinated indebtedness or Preferred Stock in the event of a
        Change of Control, the Company shall not consummate any such offer or
        distribution with respect to such subordinated indebtedness or Preferred
        Stock until such time as the Company shall have paid the Change of
        Control Purchase Price in full to the holders of Notes that have
        accepted the Company's Change of Control Offer and shall otherwise have
        consummated the Change of Control Offer made to holders of the Notes,
        and

          (ii) the Company will not issue Indebtedness that is subordinated in
     right of payment to the Notes or Preferred Stock with change of control
     provisions requiring the payment of such Indebtedness or Preferred Stock
     prior to the payment of the Notes in the event of a Change in Control under
     the Indenture.

     The Company will comply with the requirements of Rule 14e-1 under the
Exchange Act and any other securities laws and regulations thereunder to the
extent such laws and regulations are applicable in connection with the
repurchase of Notes pursuant to a Change of Control Offer. To the extent that
the provisions of any securities laws or regulations conflict with the "Change
of Control" provisions of the Indenture, the Company shall comply with the
applicable securities laws and regulations and shall not be deemed to have
breached its obligations under the "Change of Control" provisions of the
Indenture by virtue thereof.

MERGER, CONSOLIDATION OR SALE OF ASSETS

     The Company will not and will not permit any of its Subsidiaries to
consolidate with, merge with or into, or sell, assign, transfer, lease, convey
or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company
(as an entirety or substantially as an entirety in one transaction or a series
of related transactions), to any Person unless:

          (i) the Company or such Subsidiary, as the case may be, shall be the
     continuing Person, or the Person (if other than the Company or such
     Subsidiary) formed by such consolidation or into which the Company or such
     Subsidiary, as the case may be, is merged or to which the properties and
     assets of the Company or such Subsidiary, as the case may be, are sold,
     assigned, transferred, leased, conveyed or otherwise disposed of shall be a
     corporation organized and existing under the laws of the United States or
     any State thereof or the District of Columbia and shall expressly assume,
     by a supplemental indenture, executed and delivered to the Trustee, in form
     satisfactory to the Trustee, all of the obligations of the Company or such
     Subsidiary, as the case may be, under the Indenture, the Notes and the
     obligations thereunder shall remain in full force and effect,

          (ii) immediately before and immediately after giving effect to such
     transaction, no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be
     continuing, and

          (iii) immediately after giving effect to such transaction on a pro
     forma basis the Company or such Person could incur at least $1.00 of
     additional Indebtedness (other than Permitted Indebtedness) under
     "-- Certain Covenants -- Limitation on Additional Indebtedness" above;

provided, however that this provision will not prevent the Company from merging
into an Affiliate of the Company for the sole purpose of creating a holding
company whose sole asset will be all of the outstanding capital stock of the
Company.

     In connection with any consolidation, merger or transfer of assets
contemplated by this provision, the Company shall deliver, or cause to be
delivered, to the Trustee, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the
Trustee, an Officers' Certificate and an opinion of counsel, each stating that
such consolidation, merger or transfer and the supplemental indenture in respect
thereto comply with this provision and that all conditions precedent herein
provided for relating to such transaction or transactions have been complied
with.

                                       63
<PAGE>   69

     For purposes of the foregoing, the transfer (by lease, assignment, sale or
otherwise, in a single transaction or series of transactions) of all or
substantially all of the properties or assets of one or more Subsidiaries of the
Company the Capital Stock of which constitutes all or substantially all of the
properties and assets of the Company, shall be deemed to be the transfer of all
or substantially all of the properties and assets of the Company.

EVENTS OF DEFAULT

     The following events are defined in the Indenture as "Events of Default":

          (i) default in payment of any principal of, or premium, if any, on the
     Notes whether at maturity, upon redemption or otherwise (whether or not
     such payment shall be prohibited by the subordination provisions of the
     Indenture),

          (ii) default for 30 days in payment of any interest on the Notes,

          (iii) default by the Company or any Subsidiary in the observance or
     performance of any other covenant in the Notes or the Indenture for 30 days
     after written notice from the Trustee or the holders of not less than 25%
     in aggregate principal amount of the Notes then outstanding (except in the
     case of a default with respect to the "Change of Control" or "Merger,
     Consolidation or Sale of Assets" covenant which shall constitute an Event
     of Default with such notice requirement but with such passage of time
     requirement),

          (iv) failure to pay when due principal, interest or premium in an
     aggregate amount of $5 million or more with respect to any Indebtedness of
     the Company or any Subsidiary thereof, or the acceleration of any such
     Indebtedness aggregating $3 million or more which default shall not be
     cured, waived or postponed pursuant to an agreement with the holders of
     such Indebtedness within 60 days after written notice as provided in the
     Indenture, or such acceleration shall not be rescinded or annulled within
     20 days after written notice as provided in the Indenture,

          (v) any final judgment or judgments which can no longer be appealed
     for the payment of money in excess of $5 million shall be rendered against
     the Company or any Subsidiary thereof, and shall not be discharged for any
     period of 60 consecutive days during which a stay of enforcement shall not
     be in effect, and

          (vi) certain events involving bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization
     of the Company or any Subsidiary thereof.

     The Indenture provides that the Trustee may withhold notice to the holders
of the Notes of any default (except in payment of principal or premium, if any,
or interest on the Notes) if the Trustee considers it to be in the best interest
of the holders of the Notes to do so.

     The Indenture will provide that if an Event of Default (other than an Event
of Default resulting from certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency or
reorganization) shall have occurred and be continuing, then the Trustee or the
holders of not less than 25% in aggregate principal amount of the Notes then
outstanding may declare to be immediately due and payable the entire principal
amount of all the Notes then outstanding plus accrued interest to the date of
acceleration and

          (i) such amounts shall become immediately due and payable, or

          (ii) if there are any amounts outstanding under the Revolving Credit
     Facility, such amounts shall become immediately due and payable upon the
     first to occur of an acceleration under the Revolving Credit Facility or
     five business days after receipt by the Company and the representative
     under the Revolving Credit Facility of a notice of acceleration;

                                       64
<PAGE>   70

provided, however, that after such acceleration but before a judgment or decree
based on acceleration is obtained by the Trustee, the holders of a majority in
aggregate principal amount of outstanding Notes may, under certain
circumstances, rescind and annul such acceleration if:

          (i) all Events of Default, other than nonpayment of principal,
     premium, if any, or interest that has become due solely because of the
     acceleration, have been cured or waived as provided in the Indenture,

          (ii) to the extent the payment of such interest is lawful, interest on
     overdue installments of interest and overdue principal, which has become
     due otherwise than by such declaration of acceleration, has been paid,

          (iii) in the event of the cure or waiver of an Event of Default of the
     type described in clause (vi) of the above Events of Default, the Trustee
     shall have received an officers' certificate and an opinion of counsel that
     such Event of Default has been cured or waived.

     No such rescission shall affect any subsequent Default or impair any right
consequent thereto. In case an Event of Default resulting from certain events of
bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization shall occur, the principal, premium and
interest amount with respect to all of the Notes shall be due and payable
immediately without any declaration or other act on the part of the Trustee or
the holders of the Notes.

     The holders of a majority in principal amount of the Notes then outstanding
shall have the right to waive any existing default or compliance with any
provision of the Indenture or the Notes and to direct the time, method and place
of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee, subject to
certain limitations provided for in the Indenture and under the Trust Indenture
Act.

     No holder of any Note will have any right to institute any proceeding with
respect to the Indenture or for any remedy thereunder, unless such holder shall
have previously given to the Trustee written notice of a continuing Event of
Default and unless the holders of at least 25% in aggregate principal amount of
the outstanding Notes shall have made written request and offered reasonable
indemnity to the Trustee to institute such proceeding as Trustee, and unless the
Trustee shall not have received from the holders of a majority in aggregate
principal amount of the outstanding Notes a direction inconsistent with such
request and shall have failed to institute such proceeding within 60 days.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, such limitations do not apply to a suit
instituted on such Note on or after the respective due dates expressed in such
Note.

DEFEASANCE AND COVENANT DEFEASANCE

     The Indenture provides, the Company may elect either:

          (i) to defease and be discharged from any and all of its obligations
     with respect to the Notes (except for the obligations to register the
     transfer or exchange of such Notes, to replace temporary or mutilated,
     destroyed, lost or stolen Notes, to maintain an office or agency in respect
     of the Notes and to hold monies for payment in trust) ("defeasance"), or

          (ii) to be released from its obligations with respect to the Notes
     under certain covenants contained in the Indenture ("covenant defeasance")
     upon the deposit with the Trustee (or other qualifying trustee), in trust
     for such purpose, of money and/or non-callable U.S. government obligations
     which through the payment of principal and interest in accordance with
     their terms will provide money, in an amount sufficient to pay the
     principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the Notes, on the scheduled
     due dates therefor or on a selected date of redemption in accordance with
     the terms of the Indenture.

     Such a trust may only be established if, among other things:

          (i) the Company has delivered to the Trustee an opinion of counsel (as
     specified in the Indenture):

             (a) to the effect that neither the trust nor the Trustee will be
        required to register as an investment company under the Investment
        Company Act of 1940, as amended, and

             (b) describing either a private ruling concerning the Notes or a
        published ruling of the Internal Revenue Service, to the effect that
        holders of the Notes or persons in their positions will not recognize
        income, gain or loss for federal income tax purposes as a result of such
        deposit, defeasance and

                                       65
<PAGE>   71

        discharge and will be subject to federal income tax on the same amount
        and in the same manner and at the same times, as would have been the
        case if such deposit, defeasance and discharge had not occurred,

          (ii) no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be
     continuing on the date of such deposit or insofar as Events of Default from
     bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization events are concerned, at any time
     in the period ending on the 91st day after the date of deposit,

          (iii) such defeasance or covenant defeasance shall not result in a
     breach or violation of, or constitute a default under the Indenture or any
     other material agreement or instrument to which the Company or any of its
     Subsidiaries is a party or by which the Company or any or its Subsidiaries
     is bound,

          (iv) the Company shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officers'
     Certificate stating that the deposit was not made by the Company with the
     intent of preferring the holders of the Notes over any other creditors of
     the Company or with the intent of defeating, hindering, delaying or
     defrauding any other creditors of the Company or others,

          (v) the Company shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officers'
     Certificate and an opinion of counsel, each stating that all conditions
     precedent provided for or relating to the defeasance or the covenant
     defeasance have been complied with,

          (vi) the Company shall have delivered to the Trustee an opinion of
     counsel to the effect that:

             (a) the trust funds will not be subject to any rights of holders of
        Senior Indebtedness, including, without limitation, those arising under
        the Indenture, and

             (b) after the 91st day following the deposit, the trust funds will
        not be subject to the effect of any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency,
        reorganization or similar laws affecting creditors' rights generally,
        and

          (vii) certain other customary conditions precedent are satisfied.

MODIFICATION OF INDENTURE

     From time to time, the Company and the Trustee may, without the consent of
holders of the Notes, amend or supplement the Indenture for certain specified
purposes, including providing for uncertificated Notes in addition to
certificated Notes, and curing any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency, or making
any other change that does not materially and adversely affect the rights of any
holder.

     The Indenture contains provisions permitting the Company and the Trustee,
with the consent of holders of at least a majority in principal amount of the
outstanding Notes, to modify or supplement the Indenture, except that no such
modification shall, without the consent of each holder affected thereby:

          (i) reduce the amount of Notes whose holders must consent to an
     amendment, supplement, or waiver to the Indenture or the Notes,

          (ii) reduce the rate of or change the time for payment of interest,
     including defaulted interest, on any Note,

          (iii) reduce the principal of or premium on or change the stated
     maturity of any Note or change the date on which any Notes may be subject
     to redemption or repurchase or reduce the redemption or repurchase price
     therefor,

          (iv) make any Note payable in money other than that stated in the Note
     or change the place of payment from New York, New York,

          (v) waive a default on the payment of the principal of, interest on,
     or redemption payment with respect to any Note,

          (vi) make any change in provisions of the Indenture protecting the
     right of each holder of Notes to receive payment of principal of and
     interest on such Note on or after the due date thereof or to bring suit to

                                       66
<PAGE>   72

     enforce such payment, or permitting holders of a majority in principal
     amount of Notes to waive Defaults or Events of Default,

          (vii) amend, change or modify in any material respect the obligation
     of the Company to make and consummate a Change of Control Offer in the
     event of a Change of Control or make and consummate an Asset Sale Offer
     with respect to any Asset Sale that has been consummated or modify any of
     the provisions or definitions with respect thereto, or

          (viii) modify or change any provision of the Indenture or the related
     definitions affecting the subordination or ranking of the Notes in a manner
     which adversely affects the holders of Notes.

REPORTS TO HOLDERS

     So long as the Company is subject to the periodic reporting requirements of
the Exchange Act, it will continue to furnish the information required thereby
to the Securities and Exchange Commission and to the holders of the Notes. The
Indenture provides that even if the Company is entitled under the Exchange Act
not to furnish such information to the Securities and Exchange Commission or to
the holders of the Notes, it will nonetheless continue to furnish such
information to the Securities and Exchange Commission and holders of the Notes.

COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATE

     The Company will deliver to the Trustee on or before 90 days after the end
of the Company's fiscal year and on or before 45 days after the end of each of
the first, second and third fiscal quarters in each year an Officers'
Certificate stating whether or not the signers know of any Default or Event of
Default that has occurred. If they do, the certificate will describe the Default
or Event of Default, its status and the intended method of cure, if any.

THE TRUSTEE

     The Trustee under the Indenture will be the Registrar and Paying Agent with
regard to the Notes. The Indenture provides that, except during the continuance
of an Event of Default, the Trustee will perform only such duties as are
specifically set forth in the Indenture. During the existence of an Event of
Default, the Trustee will exercise such rights and powers vested in it under the
Indenture and use the same degree of care and skill in its exercise as a prudent
person would exercise under the circumstances in the conduct of such person's
own affairs.

TRANSFER AND EXCHANGE

     Holders of the Notes may transfer or exchange Notes in accordance with the
Indenture. The Registrar under such Indenture may require a holder, among other
things, to furnish appropriate endorsements and transfer documents, and to pay
any taxes and fees required by law or permitted by the Indenture. The Registrar
is not required to transfer or exchange any Note selected for redemption and,
further, is not required to transfer or exchange any Note for a period of 15
days before selection of the Notes to be redeemed.

     The Notes will be issued in a transaction exempt from registration under
the Act and will be subject to the restrictions on transfer described in "Notice
to Investors."

     The registered holder of a Note may be treated as the owner of it for all
purposes.

DEFINITIONS

     Set forth below is a summary of certain of the defined terms used in the
Indenture. Reference is made to the Indenture for the full definition of all
such terms as well as any other capitalized terms used herein for which no
definition is provided.

     "Acquired Indebtedness" means Indebtedness of a Person existing at the time
such Person becomes a Subsidiary or is merged into or consolidated with any
other Person or which is assumed in connection with the acquisition of assets
from such Person and, in each case, not incurred by such Person in connection
with, or in

                                       67
<PAGE>   73

anticipation or contemplation of, such Person becoming a Subsidiary or such
merger, consolidation or acquisition.

     "Affiliate" means, with respect to any specific Person, any other Person
that directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries controls, or is
controlled by, or is under common control with, such specified Person. For the
purposes of this definition, "control" (including, with correlative meanings,
the terms "controlling," "controlled by," and "under common control with"), as
used with respect to any Person, means the possession, directly or indirectly,
of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management or policies of
such Person, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by agreement or
otherwise.

     "Asset Acquisition" means:

          (i) an Investment by the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company in
     any other Person pursuant to which such Person shall become a Subsidiary of
     the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company, or shall be merged with or
     into the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company, or

          (ii) the acquisition by the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company
     of the assets of any Person (other than a Subsidiary of the Company) which
     constitute all or substantially all of the assets of such Person or
     comprise any division or line of business of such Person or any other
     properties or assets of such Person or any other properties or assets of
     such Person other than in the ordinary course of business.

     "Asset Sale" means any direct or indirect sale, issuance, conveyance,
assignment, transfer, lease or other disposition (including any Sale and
Lease-Back Transaction), other than to the Company or any of its Wholly Owned
Subsidiaries, in any single transaction or series of related transactions of:

          (i) any Capital Stock of or other equity interest in any Subsidiary of
     the Company, or

          (ii) any other property or assets of the Company or of any Subsidiary
     thereof; provided that Asset Sales shall not include:

             (a) a transaction or series of related transactions for which the
        Company or its Subsidiaries receive aggregate consideration of less than
        $2 million,

             (b) the sale, lease, conveyance, disposition or other transfer of
        all or substantially all of the assets of the Company as permitted under
        "--Merger, Consolidation or Sale of Assets,"

             (c) a disposition of inventory in the ordinary course of business,

             (d) an exchange of property for other similar property structured
        on a tax-free, like-kind basis, or

             (e) the issuance of shares of a wholly owned Subsidiary of the
        Company solely to the shareholders of the Company in a transaction
        pursuant to which the Company becomes a wholly owned direct or indirect
        subsidiary of such Subsidiary.

     "Asset Sale Proceeds" means, with respect to any Asset Sale:

          (i) cash received by the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company from
     such Asset Sale (including cash received as consideration for the
     assumption of liabilities incurred in connection with or in anticipation of
     such Asset Sale), after

             (a) provision for all income or other taxes measured by or
        resulting from such Asset Sale,

             (b) payment of all brokerage commissions, underwriting and other
        fees and expenses related to such Asset Sale,

             (c) provision for minority interest holders in any Subsidiary of
        the Company as a result of such Asset Sale,

             (d) repayment of Indebtedness that is required to be repaid in
        connection with such Asset Sale, and

                                       68
<PAGE>   74

             (e) deduction of appropriate amounts to be provided by the Company
        or a Subsidiary of the Company as a reserve, in accordance with GAAP,
        against any liabilities associated with the assets sold or disposed of
        in such Asset Sale and retained by the Company or a Subsidiary after
        such Asset Sale, including, without limitation, pension and other
        post-employment benefit liabilities and liabilities related to
        environmental matters or against any indemnification obligations
        associated with the assets sold or disposed of in such Asset Sale, and

          (ii) promissory notes and other noncash consideration received by the
     Company or any Subsidiary of the Company from such Asset Sale or other
     disposition upon the liquidation or conversion of such notes or noncash
     consideration into cash.

     "Attributable Indebtedness" in respect of a Sale and Lease-Back Transaction
means, as at the time of determination, the greater of:

          (i) the fair value of the property subject to such arrangement, and

          (ii) the present value (discounted at the rate of 10%, compounded
     annually) of the total obligations of the lessee for rental payments during
     the remaining term of the lease included in such Sale and Lease-Back
     Transaction (including any period for which such lease has been extended).

     "Available Asset Sale Proceeds" means, with respect to any Asset Sale, the
aggregate Asset Sale Proceeds from such Asset Sale that have not been applied in
accordance with clauses (iii)(a) or (iii)(b), and which have not yet been the
basis for a Series A/B Asset Sale Offer or an Excess Proceeds Offer in
accordance with clause (iii)(c) of the first paragraph of "-- Certain
Covenants -- Limitation on Certain Asset Sales".

     "Capital Stock" means, with respect to any Person, any and all shares,
interests, participations or other equivalents (however designated and whether
or not voting) of corporate stock, partnership interests or any other
participation, right or other interest in the nature of an equity interest in
such Person including, without limitation, Common Stock and Preferred Stock of
such Person, or any option, warrant or other security convertible into any of
the foregoing.

     "Capitalized Lease Obligations" means, with respect to any Person,
Indebtedness represented by obligations under a lease that is required to be
capitalized for financial reporting purposes in accordance with GAAP, and the
amount of such Indebtedness shall be the capitalized amount of such obligations
determined in accordance with GAAP.

     "Cash Equivalents" means:

          (i) marketable direct obligations issued by, or unconditionally
     guaranteed by, the United States Government or issued by any agency thereof
     and backed by the full faith and credit of the United States, in each case
     maturing within one year from the date of acquisition thereof,

          (ii) marketable direct obligations issued by any state of the United
     States of America or any political subdivision of any such state or any
     public instrumentality thereof maturing within one year from the date of
     acquisition thereof and, at the time of acquisition, having one of the two
     highest ratings obtainable from either Standard & Poor's Corporation
     ("S&P") or Moody's Investors Service, Inc. ("Moody's"),

          (iii) commercial paper maturing no more than one year from the date of
     creation thereof and, at the time of acquisition, having a rating of at
     least A-1 from S&P or at least P-1 from Moody's,

          (iv) certificates of deposit or bankers' acceptances maturing within
     one year from the date of acquisition thereof issued by any bank organized
     under the laws of the United States of America or any state thereof or the
     District of Columbia or any U.S. branch of a foreign bank having at the
     date of acquisition thereof combined capital and surplus of not less than
     $250,000,000, and

          (v) shares of any mutual funds or other pooled investment vehicles, in
     each case having assets of $500,000,000, investing solely in investments of
     the types described in (i) through (iv) above.

                                       69
<PAGE>   75

     A "Change of Control" of the Company will be deemed to have occurred at
such time as:

          (i) any Person (including a Person's Affiliates and associates), other
     than a Permitted Holder, becomes the beneficial owner (as defined under
     Rule 13d-3 or any successor rule or regulation promulgated under the
     Exchange Act) of 50% or more of the total voting or economic power of the
     Company's Common Stock,

          (ii) any Person (including a Person's Affiliates and associates),
     other than a Permitted Holder, becomes the beneficial owner of more than
     33 1/3% of the total voting power of the Company's Common Stock, and the
     Permitted Holders beneficially own, in the aggregate, a lesser percentage
     of the total voting power of the Common Stock of the Company than such
     other Person and do not have the right or ability by voting power, contract
     or otherwise to elect or designate for election a majority of the Board of
     Directors of the Company,

          (iii) there shall be consummated any consolidation or merger of the
     Company in which the Company is not the continuing or surviving corporation
     or pursuant to which the Common Stock of the Company would be converted
     into cash, securities or other property, other than:

             (a) a merger or consolidation of the Company in which the holders
        of the Common Stock of the Company outstanding immediately prior to the
        consolidation or merger hold, directly or indirectly, at least a
        majority of the Common Stock of the surviving corporation immediately
        after such consolidation or merger, or

             (b) a merger of the Company with an Affiliate of the Company (or a
        shell corporation with no shareholders formed solely for the purpose of
        creating a holding company) for the sole purpose of creating a holding
        company whose sole asset, directly or indirectly, will be all of the
        outstanding capital stock of the Company, or

          (iv) during any period of two consecutive years, individuals who at
     the beginning of such period constituted the Board of Directors of the
     Company (together with any new directors whose election by such Board of
     Directors or whose nomination for election by the shareholders of the
     Company has been approved by 66 2/3% of the directors then still in office
     who either were directors at the beginning of such period or whose election
     or recommendation for election was previously so approved) cease to
     constitute a majority of the Board of Directors of the Company.

     "Common Stock" of any Person means all Capital Stock of such Person that is
generally entitled to:

          (i) vote in the election of directors of such Person, or

          (ii) if such Person is not a corporation, vote or otherwise
     participate in the selection of the governing body, partners, managers or
     others that will control the management and policies of such Person.

     "Company" means Park-Ohio Industries, Inc.

     "Consolidated Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio" means, with respect to any
Person, the ratio of EBITDA of such Person during the four full fiscal quarters
(the "Four Quarter Period") ending on or prior to the date of the transaction
giving rise to the need to calculate the Consolidated Fixed Charge Coverage
Ratio (the "Transaction Date") to Consolidated Fixed Charges of such Person for
the Four Quarter Period.

     In addition to and without limitation of the foregoing, for purposes of
this definition, "Consolidated EBITDA" and "Consolidated Fixed Charges" shall be
calculated after giving effect on a pro forma basis for the period of such
calculation to:

          (i) the incurrence (and the application of the proceeds thereof) or
     repayment of any Indebtedness of such Person or any of its Subsidiaries
     giving rise to the need to make such calculation and any incurrence (and
     the application of the proceeds thereof) or repayment of other
     Indebtedness, other than the incurrence or repayment of Indebtedness in the
     ordinary course of business for working capital purposes pursuant to
     working capital facilities, occurring during the Four Quarter Period or at
     any time subsequent to the last day of the Four Quarter Period and on or
     prior to the Transaction Date, as if such incurrence (and the application
     of the proceeds thereof) or repayment, as the case may be, occurred on the
     first day of the Four Quarter Period, and

                                       70
<PAGE>   76

          (ii) any Asset Sales or Asset Acquisitions (including, without
     limitation, any Asset Acquisition giving rise to the need to make such
     calculation as a result of such Person or one of its Subsidiaries
     (including any Person who becomes a Subsidiary as a result of the Asset
     Acquisition) incurring, assuming or otherwise being liable for Acquired
     Indebtedness and also including any EBITDA (provided that such EBITDA shall
     be included only to the extent includable pursuant to the definition of
     "Consolidated Net Income") attributable to the assets which are the subject
     of the Asset Acquisition or Asset Sale during the Four Quarter Period)
     occurring during the Four Quarter Period or at any time subsequent to the
     last day of the Four Quarter Period and on or prior to the Transaction
     Date, as if such Asset Sale or Asset Acquisition (including the incurrence,
     assumption or liability for any such Acquired Indebtedness) occurred on the
     first day of the Four Quarter Period.

     If such Person or any of its Subsidiaries directly or indirectly guarantees
Indebtedness of a third Person, the preceding sentence shall give effect to the
incurrence of such guaranteed Indebtedness as if such Person or any Subsidiary
of such Person had directly incurred or otherwise assumed such guaranteed
Indebtedness.

     Furthermore, in calculating "Consolidated Fixed Charges" for purposes of
determining the denominator (but not the numerator) of this "Consolidated Fixed
Charge Coverage Ratio":

          (i) interest on outstanding Indebtedness determined on a fluctuating
     basis as of the Transaction Date and which will continue to be so
     determined thereafter shall be deemed to have accrued at a fixed rate per
     annum equal to the rate of interest on such Indebtedness in effect on the
     Transaction Date,

          (ii) if interest on any Indebtedness actually incurred on the
     Transaction Date may optionally be determined at an interest rate based
     upon a factor of a prime or similar rate, a eurocurrency interbank offered
     rate, or other rates, then the interest rate in effect on the Transaction
     Date will be deemed to have been in effect during the Four Quarter Period,
     and

          (iii) notwithstanding clause (i) above, interest on Indebtedness
     determined on a fluctuating basis, to the extent such interest is covered
     by one or more Interest Rate Agreements, shall be deemed to accrue at the
     rate per annum resulting after giving effect to the operation of such
     agreements.

     "Consolidated Fixed Charges" means, with respect to any Person, for any
period, the sum, without duplication, of:

          (i) Consolidated Interest Expense, plus

          (ii) the product of:

             (a) the amount of all dividend payments on any series of Preferred
        Stock of such Person (other than dividends paid in Capital Stock (other
        than Disqualified Capital Stock)) paid, accrued or scheduled to be paid
        or accrued during such period times,

             (b) a fraction, the numerator of which is one and the denominator
        of which is one minus the then current effective consolidated federal,
        state and local tax rate of such Person, expressed as a decimal.

     "Consolidated Interest Expense" means, with respect to any Person, for any
period, the aggregate amount of interest which, in conformity with GAAP, would
be set forth opposite the caption "interest expense" or any like caption on an
income statement for such Person and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis
(including, but not limited to:

          (i) Redeemable Dividends, whether paid or accrued,

          (ii) imputed interest included in Capitalized Lease Obligations,

          (iii) all commissions, discounts and other fees and charges owed with
     respect to letters of credit and bankers' acceptance financing,

          (iv) the net costs associated with Interest Rate Agreements and other
     hedging obligations,

          (v) the interest portion of any deferred payment obligation,

                                       71
<PAGE>   77

          (vi) amortization of discount or premium, if any, and

          (vii) all other non-cash interest expense (other than interest
     amortized to cost of sales), plus, without duplication, all net capitalized
     interest for such period and all interest incurred or paid under any
     guarantee of Indebtedness (including a guarantee of principal, interest or
     any combination thereof) of any Person,

     plus the amount of all dividends or distributions paid on Disqualified
Capital Stock (other than dividends paid or payable in shares of Capital Stock
of the Company) minus amortization of deferred financing costs and expenses.

     "Consolidated Net Income" means, with respect to any Person, for any
period, the aggregate of the Net Income of such Person and its Subsidiaries for
such period, on a consolidated basis, determined in accordance with GAAP;
provided, however, that:

          (i) the Net Income of any Person (the "other Person") in which the
     Person in question or any of its Subsidiaries has less than a 100% interest
     (which interest does not cause the Net Income of such other Person to be
     consolidated into the Net Income of the Person in question in accordance
     with GAAP) shall be included only to the extent of the amount of dividends
     or distributions paid to the Person in question or the Subsidiary,

          (ii) the Net Income of any Subsidiary of the Person in question that
     is subject to any restriction or limitation on the payment of dividends or
     the making of other distributions shall be excluded to the extent of such
     restriction or limitation,

          (iii) (a) the Net Income of any Person acquired in a pooling of
     interests transaction for any period prior to the date of such acquisition,
     and

             (b) any net gain (but not loss) resulting from an Asset Sale by the
     Person in question or any of its Subsidiaries other than in the ordinary
     course of business shall be excluded,

          (iv) extraordinary or unusual and non-recurring gains and losses shall
     be excluded,

          (v) income or loss attributable to discontinued operations (including,
     without limitation, operations disposed of during such period whether or
     not such operations were classified as discontinued) shall be excluded, and

          (vi) in the case of a successor to the referent Person by
     consolidation or merger or as a transferee of the referent Person's assets,
     any earnings of the successor corporation prior to such consolidation,
     merger or transfer of assets shall be excluded.

     "Designated Senior Indebtedness," means:

          (i) any Senior Indebtedness under the Revolving Credit Facility, and

          (ii) any other Senior Indebtedness which at the time of determination
     exceeds $25 million in aggregate principal amount (or accreted value in the
     case of Indebtedness issued at a discount) outstanding or available under a
     committed facility, which is specifically designated in the instrument
     evidencing such Senior Indebtedness as "Designated Senior Indebtedness" by
     such Person and as to which the Trustee has been given written notice of
     such designation.

     "Disqualified Capital Stock" means any Capital Stock of a Person or a
Subsidiary thereof which, by its terms (or by the terms of any security into
which it is convertible or for which it is exchangeable at the option of the
holder), or upon the happening of any event, matures or is mandatorily
redeemable, pursuant to a sinking fund obligation or otherwise, or is redeemable
at the option of the holder thereof, in whole or in part, on or prior to the
maturity date of the Notes, for cash or securities constituting Indebtedness.

     Without limitation of the foregoing, Disqualified Capital Stock shall be
deemed to include any Preferred Stock of a Person or a Subsidiary of such
Person, with respect to either of which, under the terms of such Preferred
Stock, by agreement or otherwise, such Person or Subsidiary is obligated to pay
current dividends or distributions in cash during the period prior to the
maturity date of the Notes; provided, however, that Preferred

                                       72
<PAGE>   78

Stock of a Person or any Subsidiary thereof that is issued with the benefit of
provisions requiring a change of control offer to be made for such Preferred
Stock in the event of a change of control of such Person or Subsidiary which
provisions have substantially the same effect as the provisions of the Indenture
described under "Change of Control," shall not be deemed to be Disqualified
Capital Stock solely by virtue of such provisions.

     "EBITDA" means, with respect to any Person and its Subsidiaries, for any
period, an amount equal to:

          (i) the sum of:

             (a) Consolidated Net Income for such period, plus

             (b) the provision for taxes for such period based on income or
        profits to the extent such income or profits were included in computing
        Consolidated Net Income and any provision for taxes utilized in
        computing net loss under clause (a) hereof, plus

             (c) Consolidated Interest Expense for such period (but only
        including Redeemable Dividends in the calculation of such Consolidated
        Interest Expense to the extent that such Redeemable Dividends have not
        been excluded in the calculation of Consolidated Net Income), plus

             (d) depreciation for such period on a consolidated basis, plus

             (e) amortization of intangibles for such period on a consolidated
        basis, plus

             (f) any other non-cash items reducing Consolidated Net Income for
        such period, minus

          (ii) all non-cash items increasing Consolidated Net Income for such
     period, all for such Person and its Subsidiaries determined on a
     consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP,

     and provided, however, that, for purposes of calculating EBITDA during any
fiscal quarter, cash income from a particular Investment of such Person shall be
included only:

          (i) if cash income has been received by such Person with respect to
     such Investment during each of the previous four fiscal quarters, or

          (ii) if the cash income derived from such Investment is attributable
     to Cash Equivalents.

     "Exchange Act" means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended and
the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission promulgated
thereunder.

     "fair market value" means, with respect to any asset or property, the price
which could be negotiated in an arm's-length, free market transaction, for cash,
between a willing seller and a willing and able buyer, neither of whom is under
undue pressure or compulsion to complete the transaction. Fair market value
shall be determined by the Board of Directors of the Company acting reasonably
and in good faith and shall be evidenced by a resolution of the Board of
Directors of the Company delivered to the Trustee.

     "GAAP" means generally accepted accounting principles consistently applied
as in effect in the United States from time to time, except that with respect to
changes in generally accepted accounting principles that become effective
following the Original Issue Date with respect to non-cash items, such changes
shall not be given effect if the Company and its lenders under the Revolving
Credit Facility agree not to give effect to such changes for the purpose of
evaluating the Company and its Subsidiaries' financial condition or performance
under the Revolving Credit Facility.

     "incur" means, with respect to any Indebtedness or other obligation of any
Person, to create, issue, incur (by conversion, exchange or otherwise), assume,
guarantee or otherwise become liable in respect of such Indebtedness or other
obligation or the recording, as required pursuant to GAAP or otherwise, of any
such Indebtedness or other obligation on the balance sheet of such Person (and
"incurrence," "incurred," "incurable," and "incurring" shall have meanings
correlative to the foregoing); provided that a change in GAAP that results in an
obligation of such Person that exists at such time becoming Indebtedness shall
not be deemed an incurrence of such Indebtedness.

                                       73
<PAGE>   79

     "Indebtedness" means (without duplication), with respect to any Person, any
indebtedness at any time outstanding, secured or unsecured, contingent or
otherwise, which is for borrowed money (whether or not the recourse of the
lender is to the whole of the assets of such Person or only to a portion
thereof), or evidenced by bonds, notes, debentures or similar instruments or
representing the balance deferred and unpaid of the purchase price of any
property (excluding, without limitation, any balances that constitute accounts
payable or trade payables, and other accrued liabilities arising in the ordinary
course of business) if and to the extent any of the foregoing indebtedness would
appear as a liability upon a balance sheet of such Person prepared in accordance
with GAAP, and shall also include, to the extent not otherwise included:

          (i) any Capitalized Lease Obligations of such Person,

          (ii) obligations secured by a lien to which the property or assets
     owned or held by such Person is subject, whether or not the obligation or
     obligations secured thereby shall have been assumed,

          (iii) guarantees of items of other Persons which would be included
     within this definition for such other Persons (whether or not such items
     would appear upon the balance sheet of the guarantor),

          (iv) all obligations for the reimbursement of any obligor on any
     letter of credit, banker's acceptance or similar credit transaction,

          (v) Disqualified Capital Stock of such Person or any Subsidiary
     thereof, and

          (vi) obligations of any such Person under any currency agreement or
     any Interest Rate Agreement applicable to any of the foregoing (if and to
     the extent such currency agreement or Interest Rate Agreement obligations
     would appear as a liability upon a balance sheet of such Person prepared in
     accordance with GAAP).

     The amount of Indebtedness of any Person at any date shall be the
outstanding balance at such date of all unconditional obligations as described
above and, with respect to contingent obligations, the maximum liability upon
the occurrence of the contingency giving rise to the obligation; provided that:

          (i) the amount outstanding at any time of any Indebtedness issued with
     original issue discount is the principal amount of such Indebtedness less
     the remaining unamortized portion of the original issue discount of such
     Indebtedness at such time as determined in conformity with GAAP,

          (ii) Indebtedness shall not include any liability for federal, state,
     local or other taxes, and

          (iii) Indebtedness shall not include interest on, and any and all
     other fees, expense reimbursement obligations and other amounts due
     pursuant to any Indebtedness.

     "Independent Financial Advisor" means an investment banking firm of
national reputation in the United States:

          (i) which does not, and whose directors, officers and employees or
     Affiliates do not, have a direct or indirect financial interest in the
     Company, and

          (ii) which, in the judgment of the Board of Directors of the Company,
     is otherwise independent and qualified to perform the task for which it is
     to be engaged.

     "Interest Rate Agreement" means, with respect to any Person, any interest
rate swap agreement, interest rate cap agreement, interest rate collar agreement
or other similar agreement designed to protect the party indicated therein
against fluctuations in interest rates.

     "Investments" means, with respect of any Person, directly or indirectly,
any advance, account receivable (other than an account receivable arising in the
ordinary course of business of such Person), loan or capital contribution to (by
means of transfers of property to others, payments for property or services for
the account or use of others or otherwise), the purchase of any Capital Stock,
bonds, notes, debentures, partnership or joint venture interests or other
securities of, the acquisition, by purchase or otherwise, of all or
substantially all of the business or assets or stock or other evidence of
beneficial ownership of, any Person or the making of any investment in any
Person.

                                       74
<PAGE>   80

     Investments shall exclude:

          (i) extensions of trade credit on commercially reasonable terms in
     accordance with normal trade practices of such Person, and

          (ii) the repurchase of securities of any Person by such Person.

     For the purposes of the "Limitation on Restricted Payments" covenant, the
amount of any Investment shall be the original cost of such Investment plus the
cost of all additional Investments by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries,
without any adjustments for increases or decreases in value, or write-ups,
write-downs or write-offs with respect to such Investment, reduced by the
payment of dividends or distributions in connection with such Investment or any
other amounts received in respect of such Investment; provided that no such
payment of dividends or distributions or receipt of any such other amounts shall
reduce the amount of any Investment if such payment of dividends or
distributions or receipt of any such amounts would be included in Consolidated
Net Income.

     If the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company sells or otherwise disposes
of any Common Stock of any direct or indirect Subsidiary of the Company such
that, after giving effect to any such sale or disposition, the Company no longer
owns, directly or indirectly, greater than 50% of the outstanding Common Stock
of such Subsidiary, the Company shall be deemed to have made an Investment on
the date of any such sale or disposition equal to the fair market value of the
Common Stock of such Subsidiary not sold or disposed of.

     "Issue Date" means the date the Notes are first issued by the Company and
authenticated by the Trustee under the Indenture.

     "Lien" means, with respect to any property or assets of any Person, any
mortgage or deed of trust, pledge, hypothecation, assignment, deposit
arrangement, security interest, lien, charge, easement, encumbrance, preference,
priority, or other security agreement or preferential arrangement of any kind or
nature whatsoever on or with respect to such property or assets (including
without limitation, any Capitalized Lease Obligation, conditional sales, or
other title retention agreement having substantially the same economic effect as
any of the foregoing).

     "Net Income" means, with respect to any Person, for any period, the net
income (loss) of such Person determined in accordance with GAAP.

     "Net Proceeds" means in the case of any sale of Capital Stock by or equity
contribution to any Person, the aggregate net cash proceeds received by such
Person, after payment of expenses, commissions and the like incurred in
connection therewith.

     "Non-Payment Event of Default" means any event (other than a Payment
Default) the occurrence of which entitles one or more Persons to accelerate the
maturity of any Designated Senior Indebtedness.

     "Officers' Certificate" means, with respect to any Person, a certificate
signed by the Chief Executive Officer, the President or any Vice President and
the Chief Financial Officer, Treasurer or any Corporate Controller of such
Person that shall comply with applicable provisions of the Indenture.

     "Original Issue Date" means November 25, 1997.

     "Payment Default" means any default, whether or not any requirement for the
giving of notice, the lapse of time or both, or any other condition to such
default becoming an event of default has occurred, in the payment of principal
of or premium, if any, or interest on or any other amount payable in connection
with Designated Senior Indebtedness.

     "Permitted Holders" means:

          (i) a holding company formed for the sole purpose of owning, directly
     or indirectly all of the outstanding capital stock of the Company,

          (ii) Edward F. Crawford, his children or other lineal descendants,
     probate estate of any such individual, and any trust, so long as one or
     more of the foregoing individuals is the beneficiary thereunder, and any
     other

                                       75
<PAGE>   81

     corporation, partnership or other entity all of the shareholders, partners,
     members or owners of which are any of the foregoing, or

          (iii) any employee stock ownership plan, or any "group" (as defined in
     Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act) in which employees of the
     Company or its subsidiaries beneficially own at least 33 1/3% of the Common
     Stock of the Company or of a holding company that directly or indirectly
     owns all of the outstanding Capital stock of the Company.

     "Permitted Indebtedness" means:

          (i) Indebtedness of the Company or any Subsidiary solely for working
     capital purposes and not for acquisitions arising under or in connection
     with the Revolving Credit Facility in an aggregate principal amount not to
     exceed the greater of:

             (a) $50 million, or

             (b) the sum of:

                (1) 45% of the book value of the accounts receivable of the
           Company and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, and

                (2) 25% of the book value of the inventory of the Company and
           its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis outstanding at any time,
           less any mandatory prepayment actually made thereunder (to the
           extent, in the case of payments of revolving credit borrowings, that
           the corresponding commitments have been permanently reduced below $50
           million) or scheduled payments actually made thereunder,

          (ii) Indebtedness under the Series A/B Notes and the Notes,

          (iii) Indebtedness not covered by any other clause of this definition
     which was outstanding on the Original Issue Date or is outstanding on the
     Issue Date and was incurred subsequent to the Original Issue Date in
     compliance with the Series A/B Indenture,

          (iv) Indebtedness of the Company to any Wholly Owned Subsidiary and
     Indebtedness of any Wholly Owned Subsidiary to the Company or another
     Wholly Owned Subsidiary,

          (v) Purchase Money Indebtedness and Capitalized Lease Obligations
     incurred to acquire property in the ordinary course of business which
     Purchase Money Indebtedness and Capitalized Lease Obligations do not in the
     aggregate exceed 5% of the Company's tangible consolidated total assets,

          (vi) Interest Rate Agreements,

          (vii) Refinancing Indebtedness, and

          (viii) additional Indebtedness of the Company and its Subsidiaries not
     to exceed $10 million in aggregate principal amount at any one time
     outstanding.

     "Permitted Investments" means Investments made on or after the Original
Issue Date consisting of:

          (i) Investments by the Company, or by a Subsidiary thereof, in the
     Company or a Wholly Owned Subsidiary,

          (ii) Investments by the Company, or by a Subsidiary thereof, in a
     Person, if as a result of such Investment:

             (a) such Person becomes a Wholly Owned Subsidiary of the Company,
        or

             (b) such Person is merged, consolidated or amalgamated with or
        into, or transfers or conveys substantially all of its assets to, or is
        liquidated into, the Company or a Wholly Owned Subsidiary thereof,

          (iii) Investments in cash and Cash Equivalents,

                                       76
<PAGE>   82

          (iv) reasonable and customary loans made to employees in connection
     with their relocation not to exceed $1 million in the aggregate at any one
     time outstanding,

          (v) an Investment that is made by the Company or a Subsidiary thereof
     in the form of any Capital Stock, bonds, notes, debentures, partnership or
     joint venture interests or other securities that are issued by a third
     party to the Company or such Subsidiary solely as partial consideration for
     the consummation of an Asset Sale that is otherwise permitted under
     "-- Certain Covenants -- Limitation on Certain Asset Sales" above,

          (vi) Interest Rate Agreement entered into in the ordinary course of
     the Company's or its Subsidiaries' business, and

          (vii) additional Investments not to exceed $10 million at any one time
     outstanding.

     "Permitted Liens" means:

          (i) Liens on property or assets of, or any      shares of Capital
     Stock of or secured indebtedness of, any corporation existing at the time
     such corporation becomes a Subsidiary of the Company or at the time such
     corporation is merged into the Company or any of its Subsidiaries; provided
     that such Liens are not incurred in connection with, or in contemplation
     of, such corporation becoming a Subsidiary of the Company or merging into
     the Company or any of its Subsidiaries,

          (ii) Liens securing Refinancing Indebtedness; provided that any such
     Lien does not extend to or cover any Property, Capital Stock or
     Indebtedness other than the Property, shares or debt securing the
     Indebtedness so refunded, refinanced or extended,

          (iii) Liens in favor of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries,

          (iv) Liens securing industrial revenue bonds,

          (v) Liens to secure Purchase Money Indebtedness that is otherwise
     permitted under the Indenture; provided that:

             (a) any such Lien is created solely for the purpose of securing
        Indebtedness representing, or incurred to finance, refinance or refund,
        the cost (including sales and excise taxes, installation and delivery
        charges and other direct costs of, and other direct expenses paid or
        charged in connection with, such purchase or construction) of such
        Property,

             (b) the principal amount of the Indebtedness secured by such Lien
        does not exceed 100% of such costs, and

             (c) such Lien does not extend to or cover any Property other than
        such item of Property and any improvements on such item,

          (vi) statutory liens or landlords', carriers', warehouseman's,
     mechanics', suppliers', materialmen's, repairmen's or other like Liens
     arising in the ordinary course of business which do not secure any
     Indebtedness and with respect to amounts not yet delinquent or being
     contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings, if a reserve or other
     appropriate provision, if any, as shall be required in conformity with GAAP
     shall have been made therefor,

          (vii) other Liens securing obligations incurred in the ordinary course
     of business which obligations do not exceed $3 million in the aggregate at
     any one time outstanding,

          (viii) Liens for taxes, assessments or governmental charges that are
     being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings,

          (ix) Liens securing Capitalized Lease Obligations permitted to be
     incurred under clause (v) of the definition of "Permitted Indebtedness";
     provided that such Lien does not extend to any property other than that
     subject to the underlying lease,

          (x) liens to secure the Revolving Credit Facility,

                                       77
<PAGE>   83

          (xi) Liens securing Interest Rate Agreements,

          (xii) easements or other minor defect or irregularities in title and
     other charges and encumbrances on property not interfering in any material
     respect with the use of such property in the business of the Company or the
     applicable Subsidiary,

          (xiii) liens that arose subsequent to the Original Issue Date in
     compliance with the Series A/B Indenture, and

          (xiv) any extensions, substitutions, replacements or renewals of the
     foregoing.

     "Person" means any individual, corporation, partnership, joint venture,
association, joint-stock company, trust, unincorporated organization or
government (including any agency or political subdivision thereof).

     "Preferred Stock" means any Capital Stock of a Person, however designated,
which entitles the holder thereof to a preference with respect to dividends,
distributions or liquidation proceeds of such Person over the holders of other
Capital Stock issued by such Person.

     "Property" of any Person means all types of real, personal, tangible,
intangible or mixed property owned by such Person whether or not included in the
most recent consolidated balance sheet of such Person and its Subsidiaries under
GAAP.

     "Public Equity Offering" means a public offering by the Company or by a
holding company which owns, directly or indirectly, all of the outstanding
capital stock of the Company of shares of its Common Stock (however designated
and whether voting or non-voting) and any and all rights, warrants or options to
acquire such Common Stock.

     "Purchase Money Indebtedness" means any Indebtedness incurred in the
ordinary course of business by a Person to finance the cost (including the cost
of construction) of an item of property, the principal amount of which
Indebtedness does not exceed the sum of:

          (i) 100% of such cost, and

          (ii) reasonable fees and expenses of such Person incurred in
     connection therewith.

     "Redeemable Dividend" means, for any dividend or distribution with regard
to Disqualified Capital Stock, the quotient of the dividend or distribution
divided by the difference between one and the maximum statutory federal income
tax rate (expressed as a decimal number between 1 and 0) then applicable to the
issuer of such Disqualified Capital Stock.

     "Refinancing Indebtedness" means Indebtedness that refunds, refinances or
extends any Indebtedness of the Company outstanding on the Original Issue Date
or which is outstanding on the Issue Date and was incurred subsequent to the
Issue Date in compliance with the Series A/B Indenture or other Indebtedness
permitted to be incurred by the Company or its Subsidiaries pursuant to the
terms of the Indenture, but only to the extent that:

          (i) the Refinancing Indebtedness is subordinated to the Notes to at
     least the same extent as the Indebtedness being refunded, refinanced or
     extended, if at all,

          (ii) the Refinancing Indebtedness is scheduled to mature either:

             (a) no earlier than the Indebtedness being refunded, refinanced or
        extended, or

             (b) after the maturity date of the Notes,

          (iii) the portion, if any, of the Refinancing Indebtedness that is
     scheduled to mature on or prior to the maturity date of the Notes has a
     weighted average life to maturity at the time such Refinancing Indebtedness
     is incurred that is equal to or greater than the weighted average life to
     maturity of the portion of the Indebtedness being refunded, refinanced or
     extended that is scheduled to mature on or prior to the maturity date of
     the Notes,

                                       78
<PAGE>   84

          (iv) such Refinancing Indebtedness is in an aggregate principal amount
     that is equal to or less than the sum of:

             (a) the aggregate principal amount then outstanding under the
        Indebtedness being refunded, refinanced or extended,

             (b) the amount of accrued and unpaid interest, if any, and premiums
        owed, if any, not in excess of preexisting prepayment provisions on such
        Indebtedness being refunded, refinanced or extended, and

             (c) the amount of customary fees, expenses and costs related to the
        incurrence of such Refinancing Indebtedness, and

          (v) such Refinancing Indebtedness is incurred by the same Person that
     initially incurred the Indebtedness being refunded, refinanced or extended.

     "Restricted Payment" means any of the following:

          (i) the declaration or payment of any dividend or any other
     distribution or payment on Capital Stock of the Company or any Subsidiary
     of the Company or any payment made to the direct or indirect holders (in
     their capacities as such) of Capital Stock of the Company or any Subsidiary
     of the Company (other than:

             (a) dividends or distributions payable solely in Capital Stock
        (other than Disqualified Capital Stock) or in options, warrants or other
        rights to purchase such Capital Stock (other than Disqualified Capital
        Stock), and

             (b) in the case of Subsidiaries of the Company, dividends or
        distributions payable to the Company or to a Wholly Owned Subsidiary of
        the Company),

          (ii) the purchase, redemption or other acquisition or retirement for
     value of any Capital Stock of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries (other
     than Capital Stock owned by the Company or a Wholly Owned Subsidiary of the
     Company, excluding Disqualified Capital Stock) or any option, warrants or
     other rights to purchase such Capital Stock,

          (iii) the making of any principal payment on, or the purchase,
     defeasance, repurchase, redemption or other acquisition or retirement for
     value, prior to any scheduled maturity, scheduled repayment or scheduled
     sinking fund payment of any Indebtedness which is subordinated in right of
     payment to the Notes other than subordinated Indebtedness acquired in
     anticipation of satisfying a scheduled sinking fund obligation, principal
     installment or final maturity (in each case due within one year of the date
     of acquisition),

          (iv) the making of any Investment or guarantee of any Investment in
     any Person other than a Permitted Investment, and

          (v) forgiveness of any Indebtedness of an Affiliate of the Company to
     the Company or a Subsidiary of the Company.

     For purposes of determining the amount expended for Restricted Payments,
cash distributed or invested shall be valued at the face amount thereof and
property other than cash shall be valued at its fair market value.

     "Revolving Credit Facility" means the Amended and Restated Credit Agreement
dated as of November 2, 1998, between the Company, the lenders party thereto in
their capacities as lenders thereunder and Key Bank, National Association, as
agent, together with the related documents thereto (including, without
limitation, any guarantee agreements and security documents), in each case as
such agreements may be or have been amended (including any amendment and
restatement thereof), supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time,
including any agreement extending the maturity of, refinancing, replacing or
otherwise restructuring (including increasing the amount of available borrowings
thereunder (provided that such increase in borrowings is permitted by the
"Limitation on Additional Indebtedness" covenant) or adding Subsidiaries of the
Company as additional borrowers or guarantors thereunder) all or any portion of
the Indebtedness under such agreement or any successor or replacement agreement
and whether by the same or any other agent, lender or group of lenders.

                                       79
<PAGE>   85

     "Sale and Lease-Back Transaction" means any arrangement with any Person
providing for the leasing by the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company of any
real or tangible personal property, which property has been or is to be sold or
transferred by the Company or such Subsidiary to such Person in contemplation of
such leasing.

     "Senior Indebtedness" means the principal of and premium, if any, and
interest on, and any and all other fees, expense reimbursement obligations and
other amounts due pursuant to the terms of all agreements, documents and
instruments providing for, creating, securing or evidencing or otherwise entered
into in connection with:

          (i) all Indebtedness of the Company owed to lenders under the
     Revolving Credit Facility,

          (ii) all obligations of the Company with respect to any Interest Rate
     Agreement,

          (iii) all obligations of the Company to reimburse any bank or other
     person in respect of amounts paid under letters of credit, acceptances or
     other similar instruments,

          (iv) all other Indebtedness of the Company which does not provide that
     it is to rank pari passu with or subordinate to the Notes, and

          (v) all deferrals, renewals, extensions and refundings of, and
     amendments, modifications and supplements to, any of the Senior
     Indebtedness described above.

     Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the foregoing, Senior
Indebtedness will not include:

          (i) Indebtedness of the Company to any of its Subsidiaries, or to any
     Affiliate of the Company or any of such Affiliate's Subsidiaries,

          (ii) Indebtedness represented by the Notes,

          (iii) any Indebtedness which by the express terms of the agreement or
     instrument creating, evidencing or governing the same is junior or
     subordinate in right of payment to any item of Senior Indebtedness,

          (iv) any trade payable arising from the purchase of goods or materials
     or for services obtained in the ordinary course of business,

          (v) Indebtedness incurred in violation of the Indenture,

          (vi) Indebtedness represented by Disqualified Capital Stock, and

          (vii) any Indebtedness to or guaranteed on behalf of, any
     shareholders, director, officer or employee of the Company or any
     Subsidiary of the Company.

     "Series A/B Indenture" means the indenture dated as of November 25, 1997
between the Company and the Trustee relating to the Series A/B Notes.

     "Series A/B Notes" means the $150.0 million aggregate principal amount of
9 1/4% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007 issued under the Series A/B Indenture.

     "Subsidiary" of any specified Person means any corporation, partnership,
joint venture, association or other business entity, whether now existing or
hereafter organized or acquired:

          (i) in the case of a corporation, of which more than 50% of the total
     voting power of the Capital Stock entitled (without regard to the
     occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of directors,
     officers or trustees thereof is held by such first-named Person or any of
     its Subsidiaries, or

          (ii) in the case of a partnership, joint venture, association or other
     business entity, with respect to which such first-named Person or any of
     its Subsidiaries has the power to direct or cause the direction of the
     management and policies of such entity by contract or otherwise or if in
     accordance with GAAP such entity is consolidated with the first-named
     Person for financial statement purposes.

                                       80
<PAGE>   86

     "Subsidiary Indebtedness" means any Indebtedness other than:

          (i) Indebtedness in the form of, or represented by, bonds or other
     securities or any guarantee thereof, and

          (ii) Indebtedness which is, or may be, quoted, listed or ordinarily
     purchased and sold on any stock exchange, automated trading system or
     over-the-counter or other securities market (including, without prejudice
     to the generality of the foregoing, the market for securities eligible for
     resale pursuant to Rule 144A under the Securities Act).

     "Wholly Owned Subsidiary" means any Subsidiary, all of the outstanding
voting securities (other than directors' qualifying shares) of which are owned,
directly or indirectly, by the Company.

BOOK-ENTRY; DELIVERY AND FORM

     The Notes are being offered and sold to QIBs (as defined) in reliance on
Rule 144A under the Securities Act ("Rule 144A Notes"). Notes also may be
offered and sold in offshore transactions in reliance on Regulation S
("Regulation S Notes"). In addition, Notes may be subsequently transferred to
institutional "accredited investors" within the meaning of subparagraph (a)(1),
(2), (3) or (7) of Rule 501 under the Securities Act ("Institutional Accredited
Investors") in transactions exempt from registration under the Securities Act
not made in reliance on Rule 144A or Regulation S under the Securities Act
("Other Notes").

     Rule 144A Notes initially will be represented by one or more notes in
registered, global form without interest coupons (collectively, the "Rule 144A
Global Note"). The Rule 144A Global Note will be deposited upon issuance with
the Trustee as custodian for The Depository Trust Company ("DTC"), in New York,
New York, and registered in the name of DTC or its nominee, in each case for
credit to an account of a direct or indirect participant as described below.
Other Notes held by Institutional Accredited Investors will be represented by
one or more certificated Notes bearing the restrictive legend described under
"Notice to Investors" ("Accredited Investor Certificated Notes"). Regulation S
Notes initially will be represented by one or more notes in registered, global
form without interest coupons (collectively, the "Regulation S Global Note,"
and, together with the Rule 144A Global Note, the "Global Notes"). The
Regulation S Global Note will be deposited upon issuance with the Trustee as
custodian for DTC, and registered in the name of a nominee of DTC, in each case
for credit to the accounts of Euroclear System ("Euroclear") and Cedel Bank,
S.A. ("CEDEL"). On or prior to the 40th day after the later of the commencement
of the Offering and the Issue Date (such period through and including such 40th
day, the "Restricted Period"), beneficial interests in the Regulation S Note may
be held only through Euroclear or CEDEL, as indirect participants in DTC, unless
transferred to a person that takes delivery in the form of an interest in the
corresponding Rule 144A Global Note in accordance with the certification
requirements described below. Beneficial interests in the Rule 144A Global Note
may not be exchanged for beneficial interests in the Regulation S Global Note at
any time except in the limited circumstances described below. See "--Exchanges
between Regulation S Notes and Rule 144A Notes and Other Notes."

     Except as set forth below, the Global Notes may be transferred, in whole
but not in part, only to another nominee of DTC or to a successor of DTC or its
nominee. Beneficial interests in the Global Notes may not be exchanged for Notes
in certificated form except in the limited circumstances described below. See
"--Exchange of Book-Entry Notes for Certificated Notes."

     Rule 144A Notes (including beneficial interests in the Rule 144A Global
Note), Regulation S Notes (including beneficial interests in the Regulation S
Note) and Other Notes will be subject to certain restrictions on transfer and
will bear a restrictive legend as described under "Notice to Investors." In
addition, transfer of beneficial interests in the Global Notes will be subject
to the applicable rules and procedures of DTC and its direct or indirect
participants (including, if applicable, those of Euroclear and CEDEL), which may
change from time to time.

     The Notes may be presented for registration of transfer and exchange at the
offices of the Registrar.

                                       81
<PAGE>   87

  Depository Procedures

     DTC has advised the issuer that DTC is a limited-purpose trust company
created to hold securities for its participating organizations (collectively,
the "Participants") and to facilitate the clearance and settlement of
transactions in those securities between the Participants through electronic
book-entry changes in accounts of the Participants. The Participants include
securities brokers and dealers (including the Initial Purchasers), banks, trust
companies, clearing corporations and certain other organizations. Access to
DTC's system is also available to other entities such as banks, brokers, dealers
and trust companies that clear through or maintain a custodial relationship with
a Participant, either directly or indirectly (collectively, the "Indirect
Participants"). Persons who are not Participants may beneficially own securities
held by or on behalf of DTC only through the Participants or the Indirect
Participants. The ownership interest and transfer of ownership interest of each
actual purchaser of each security held by or on behalf of DTC are recorded on
the records of the Participants and the Indirect Participants.

     DTC has also advised the issuer that pursuant to procedures established by
it, (i) upon deposit of the Global Notes, DTC will credit the accounts of
Participants designated by the Initial Purchasers with portions of the principal
amount of the Global Notes and (ii) ownership of such interests in the Global
Notes will be shown on, and the transfer of ownership thereof will be effected
only through, records maintained by DTC (with respect to the Participants) or by
the Participants and the Indirect Participants (with respect to other owners of
beneficial interests in the Global Notes).

     Investors in the Rule 144A Global Note may hold their interests therein
directly through DTC, if they are Participants in such system, or indirectly
through organizations (including Euroclear and CEDEL) which are Participants in
such system. Investors in the Regulation S Global Note must initially hold their
interests therein through Euroclear or CEDEL, if they are accountholders in such
systems, or indirectly through organizations which are accountholders in such
systems. After the expiration of the Restricted Period (but not earlier),
investors may also hold interests in the Regulation S Global Note through
organizations other than Euroclear and CEDEL that are Participants in the DTC
system. Euroclear and CEDEL will hold interests in the Regulation S Global Note
on behalf of their participants through their respective depositories, which in
turn will hold such interests in the Regulation S Global Note customers'
securities accounts in their respective names on the books of DTC. The Chase
Manhattan Bank, Brussels office, will initially act as depository for Euroclear,
and Citibank, N.A., will initially act as depository for CEDEL. All interests in
a Global Note, including those held through Euroclear or CEDEL, may be subject
to the procedures and requirements of DTC. Those interests held through
Euroclear or CEDEL may also be subject to the procedures and requirements of
such system.

     The laws of some states require that certain persons take physical delivery
in definitive form of securities that they own. Consequently, the ability to
transfer beneficial interests in a Global Note to such persons may be limited to
that extent. Because DTC can act only on behalf of the Participants, which in
turn act on behalf of the Indirect Participants and certain banks, the ability
of a person having beneficial interests in a Global Note to pledge such
interests to persons or entities that do not participate in the DTC system, or
otherwise take actions in respect of such interests, may be affected by the lack
of a physical certificate evidencing such interests. For certain other
restrictions on the transferability of the Notes, see "--Exchange of Book-Entry
Notes for Certificated Notes" and "--Exchanges between Regulation S Notes and
Rule 144A Notes and Other Notes."

     EXCEPT AS DESCRIBED BELOW, OWNERS OF INTERESTS IN THE GLOBAL NOTES WILL NOT
HAVE NOTES REGISTERED IN THEIR NAMES, WILL NOT RECEIVE PHYSICAL DELIVERY OF
NOTES IN CERTIFICATED FORM AND WILL NOT BE CONSIDERED THE REGISTERED OWNERS OR
HOLDERS THEREOF UNDER THE INDENTURE FOR ANY PURPOSE.

     Payments in respect of the principal of (and premium, if any) and interest
on a Global Note registered in the name of DTC or its nominee will be payable to
DTC or its nominee in its capacity as the registered holder under the Indenture.
Under the terms of the Indenture, the issuer and the Trustee will treat the
persons in whose names the Notes, including the Global Notes, are registered as
the owners thereof for the purpose of receiving such payments and for any and
all other purposes whatsoever. Consequently, none of the issuer, the Initial
Purchasers, the Trustee nor any agent of the issuer, the Initial Purchasers or
the Trustee has or will have any responsibility or liability for (i) any aspect
or accuracy of DTC's records or any Participant's or Indirect Participant's
records relating to or payments made on account of beneficial ownership
interests in the Global Notes, or for maintaining,

                                       82
<PAGE>   88

supervising or reviewing any of DTC's records or any Participant's or Indirect
Participant's records relating to the beneficial ownership interests in the
Global Notes, or (ii) any other matter relating to the actions and practices of
DTC or any of the Participants or the Indirect Participants.

     DTC has advised the issuer that its current practice, upon receipt of any
payment in respect of securities such as the Notes (including principal and
interest), is to credit the accounts of the relevant Participants with the
payment on the payment date, in amounts proportionate to their respective
holdings in principal amount of beneficial interests in the relevant security as
shown on the records of DTC. Payments by the Participants and the Indirect
Participants to the beneficial owners of Notes will be governed by standing
instructions and customary practices and will not be the responsibility of DTC,
the Trustee or us. Neither we nor the Trustee will be liable for any delay by
DTC or any of the Participants in identifying the beneficial owners of the
Notes, and we and the Trustee may conclusively rely on and will be protected in
relying on instructions from DTC or its nominee as the registered owner of the
Global Notes for all purposes.

     Except for trades involving only Euroclear and CEDEL participants,
interests in the Global Notes will trade in DTC's Same-Day Funds Settlement
System and secondary market trading activity in such interests will therefore
settle in immediately available funds, subject in all cases to the rules and
procedures of DTC and the Participants.

     Transfers between Participants in DTC will be effected in accordance with
DTC's procedures and will be settled in same-day funds. Transfers between
accountholders in Euroclear and CEDEL will be effected in the ordinary way in
accordance with their respective rules and operating procedures.

     Subject to compliance with the transfer restrictions applicable to the
Notes described herein, cross-market transfers between the accountholders in
DTC, on the one hand, and directly or indirectly through Euroclear or CEDEL
accountholders, on the other hand, will be effected through DTC in accordance
with DTC's rules on behalf of Euroclear or CEDEL, as the case may be, by its
respective depository; however, such cross-market transactions will require
delivery of instructions to Euroclear or CEDEL, as the case may be, by the
counterparty in such system in accordance with the rules and procedures and
within the established deadlines (Brussels time) of such system. Euroclear or
CEDEL, as the case may be, will, if the transaction meets its settlement
requirements, deliver instructions to its respective depository to take action
to effect final settlement on its behalf by delivering or receiving interests in
the relevant Global Note in DTC, and making or receiving payment in accordance
with normal procedures for same-day funds settlement applicable to DTC.
Euroclear and CEDEL accountholders may not deliver instructions directly to the
depositories for Euroclear or CEDEL.

     Because of time zone differences, the securities account of a Euroclear or
CEDEL accountholder purchasing an interest in a Global Note from an
accountholder in DTC will be credited, and any such crediting will be reported
to the relevant Euroclear or CEDEL participant, during the securities settlement
processing day (which must be a business day for Euroclear or CEDEL) immediately
following the settlement date of DTC. Cash received in Euroclear or CEDEL as a
result of sales of interests in a Global Note by or through a Euroclear or CEDEL
accountholder to a Participant in DTC will be received with value on the
settlement date of DTC but will be available in the relevant Euroclear or CEDEL
cash account only as of the business day for Euroclear or CEDEL following DTC's
settlement date.

     DTC has advised the issuer that it will take any action permitted to be
taken by a holder of Notes only at the direction of one or more Participants to
whose account with DTC interests in the Global Notes are credited and only in
respect of such portion of the aggregate principal amount of the Notes as to
which such Participant or Participants has or have given such direction.
However, if any of the events described under "--Exchange of Book Entry Notes
for Certificated Notes" occurs, DTC reserves the right to exchange the Global
Notes for (in the case of the Rule 144A Global Note) legended Notes in
certificated form and to distribute such Notes to its Participants.

     The information in this section concerning DTC, Euroclear and CEDEL and
their book-entry systems has been obtained from sources that the Company
believes to be reliable, but the Company takes no responsibility for the
accuracy thereof.

                                       83
<PAGE>   89

     Although DTC, Euroclear and CEDEL have agreed to the foregoing procedures
to facilitate transfers of interests in the Regulation S Global Note and in the
Rule 144A Global Note among accountholders in DTC and accountholders of
Euroclear and CEDEL, they are under no obligation to perform or to continue to
perform such procedures, and such procedures may be discontinued at any time.
None of the issuer, the Initial Purchasers or the Trustee nor any agent of the
issuer, the Initial Purchasers or the Trustee will have any responsibility for
the performance by DTC, Euroclear or CEDEL or their respective participants,
indirect participants or accountholders of their respective obligations under
the rules and procedures governing their operations.

  Exchange of Book-Entry Notes for Certificated Notes

     Notes transferred to Institutional Accredited Investors who are not QIBs
will be issued in registered certificated form. In addition, a Global Note is
exchangeable for definitive Notes in registered certificated form if (i) DTC (x)
notifies the issuer that it is unwilling or unable to continue as depository for
the Global Note and the Issuer thereupon fails to appoint a successor depository
or (y) has ceased to be a clearing agency registered under the Exchange Act,
(ii) the issuer, at its option, notifies the Trustee in writing that it elects
to cause the issuance of the Notes in certificated form or (iii) there shall
have occurred and be continuing a Default or an Event of Default with respect to
the Notes. In all cases, certificated Notes delivered in exchange for any Global
Note or beneficial interests therein will be registered in the names, and issued
in any approved denominations, requested by or on behalf of DTC (in accordance
with its customary procedures) and will bear the restrictive legend described in
"Notice to Investors" unless the issuer determines otherwise in compliance with
applicable law.

  Exchanges between Regulation S Notes and Rule 144A Notes and Other Notes

     Prior to the expiration of the Restricted Period, a beneficial interest in
a Regulation S Global Note may be transferred to a person who takes delivery in
the form of an interest in the corresponding Rule 144A Global Note or in the
form of an Accredited Investor Certificated Note only upon receipt by the
Trustee of a written certification from the transferor to the effect that such
transfer is being made (i)(a) to a person whom the transferor reasonably
believes is a QIB in a transaction meeting the requirements of Rule 144A or (b)
pursuant to another exemption from the registration requirements under the
Securities Act which is accompanied by an opinion of counsel regarding the
availability of such exemption and (ii) in accordance with all applicable
securities laws of any state of the United States or any other jurisdiction.

     Beneficial interests in a Rule 144A Global Note may be transferred to a
person who takes delivery in the form of an interest in the Regulation S Global
Note, whether before or after the expiration of the Restricted Period, only if
the transferor first delivers to the Trustee a written certificate to the effect
that such transfer is being made in accordance with Rule 903 or 904 of
Regulation S or Rule 144 under the Securities Act (if available) and that, if
such transfer occurs prior to the expiration of the Restricted Period, the
interest transferred will be held immediately thereafter through Euroclear or
CEDEL.

     Beneficial interests in a Global Note may be transferred to a person who
takes delivery in the form of an Accredited Investor Certificated Note only upon
compliance with the procedures set forth in "Notice to Investors."

     Any beneficial interest in one of the Global Notes that is transferred to a
person who takes delivery in the form of an interest in another Global Note
will, upon transfer, cease to be an interest in such Global Note and become an
interest in such other Global Note and, accordingly, will thereafter be subject
to all transfer restrictions and other procedures applicable to beneficial
interests in such other Global Note for as long as it remains such an interest.

     Transfers involving an exchange of a beneficial interest in the Regulation
S Global Note for a beneficial interest in the Rule 144A Global Note or vice
versa will be effected in DTC by means of an instruction originated by DTC
through the DTC/Deposit Withdraw at Custodian ("DWAC") system. Accordingly, in
connection with such transfer, upon notice from DTC through the DWAC system
appropriate adjustments, this is initiated by beneficial holder through
Participant through DTC to Trustee, will be made to reflect a decrease in the
principal amount of the Regulation S Global Note and a corresponding increase in
the principal amount of the Rule 144A Global Note or vice versa, as applicable.

                                       84
<PAGE>   90

                        FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

     The following discussion summarizes the material U.S. federal income tax
aspects of your acceptance of, and participation in, the exchange offer. This
discussion is a summary for general information purposes and does not consider
all aspects of U.S. federal income taxation that may be relevant to your
surrender of outstanding notes in the exchange offer or your ownership or
disposition of new notes thereafter. This discussion also does not address the
U.S. federal income tax consequences of ownership of notes not held as capital
assets within the meaning of Section 1221 of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of
1986, as amended (the "Code"), or the U.S. federal income tax consequences to
investors subject to special treatment under the U.S. federal income tax laws,
such as dealers in securities or foreign currency, tax-exempt entities,
financial institutions, insurance companies, persons that hold the notes as part
of a "straddle," a "hedge" or a "conversion transaction," persons that have a
"functional currency" other than the U.S. dollar, and investors in pass-through
entities. In addition, this discussion does not describe any tax consequences
arising under U.S. federal gift and estate taxes or out of the tax laws of any
state, local or foreign jurisdiction.

     This discussion is based upon the Code, existing Treasury regulations
thereunder, and current administrative rulings and court decisions. All of the
foregoing is subject to change, possibly on a retroactive basis, and any such
change could affect the continuing validity of this discussion.

     PERSONS CONSIDERING THE PURCHASE OF NOTES SHOULD CONSULT THEIR OWN TAX
ADVISORS CONCERNING THE APPLICATION OF FEDERAL INCOME TAX LAWS, AS WELL AS THE
LAWS OF ANY STATE, LOCAL OR FOREIGN TAXING JURISDICTION, TO THEIR PARTICULAR
SITUATIONS.

                                  U.S. HOLDERS

     The following discussion is limited to the U.S. federal income tax
consequences relevant to a beneficial owner of a note that is (i) a citizen or
resident (as defined in Section 7701 (b) (1) of the Code) of the United States,
(ii) a corporation organized under the laws of the United States or any
political subdivision thereof or therein, (iii) an estate, the income of which
is subject to U.S. federal income tax regardless of the source or (iv) a trust
with respect to which a court within the United States is able to exercise
primary supervision over its administration and one or more United States
persons have the authority to control all of its substantial decisions (a "U.S.
Holder"). Certain U.S. federal income tax consequences relevant to a holder
other than a U.S. Holder are discussed separately below.

  Stated Interest

     Stated interest on a note should be taxable to a U.S. Holder as ordinary
interest income at the time it accrues or is received in accordance with such
Holder's method of accounting for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

  Market Discount

     If a note is acquired at a "market discount," some or all of any gain
realized upon a sale or other disposition or payment at maturity or some or all
of a partial principal payment of such note may be treated as ordinary income,
as described below. For this purpose, "market discount" is the excess (if any)
of the stated redemption price at maturity of a note over its purchase price,
subject to a statutory de minimis exception. Unless a U.S. Holder has elected to
include market discount in income as it accrues, any gain realized on a
subsequent disposition of a note (other than in connection with certain
nonrecognition transactions) or payment at maturity, or some or all of any
partial principal payment with respect to the note, will be treated as ordinary
income to the extent of the market discount that is treated as having accrued
during the period such U.S. Holder held the note.

     The amount of market discount treated as having accrued will be determined
either (i) on a straight-line basis by multiplying the market discount times a
fraction, the numerator of which is the number of days the note was held by the
U.S. Holder and the denominator of which is the total number of days after the
date such U.S. Holder acquired the note up to and including the date of its
maturity or (ii) if the U.S. Holder so elects, on a constant interest rate
method. A U.S. Holder may make that election with respect to any note but, once
made, such election is irrevocable.
                                       85
<PAGE>   91

     In lieu of recharacterizing gain upon disposition as ordinary income to the
extent of accrued market discount at the time of disposition, a U.S. Holder of a
note acquired at a market discount may elect to include market discount in
income currently, through the use of either the straight-line inclusion method
or the elective constant interest method. Once made, the election to include
market discount in income currently applies to all notes and other obligations
held by the U.S. Holder that are purchased at a market discount during the
taxable year for which the election is made, and all subsequent taxable years of
the U.S. Holder, unless the Internal Revenue Service (the "IRS") consents to a
revocation of the election. If an election is made to include market discount in
income currently, the basis of the note in the hands of the U.S. Holder will be
increased by the market discount thereon as it is included in income.

     Unless a U.S. Holder who acquires a note at a market discount elects to
include market discount in income currently, such U.S. Holder may be required to
defer deductions for any interest paid on indebtedness allocable to such notes
in an amount not exceeding the deferred income until such income is realized.

BOND PREMIUM

     If a U.S. Holder purchases a note and immediately after the purchase the
adjusted basis of the note exceeds the sum of all amounts payable on the
instrument after the purchase date (other than qualified stated interest), the
note has "bond premium." A U.S. Holder may elect to amortize such bond premium
over the remaining term of such note (or if it results in a smaller amount of
amortizable bond premium, until an earlier call date).

     If bond premium is amortized, the amount of interest that must be included
in the U.S. Holder's income for each period ending on an interest payment date
or at the stated maturity, as the case may be, will be reduced by the portion of
premium allocable to such period based on the note's yield to maturity. If such
an election to amortize bond premium is not made, a U.S. Holder must include the
full amount of each interest payment in income in accordance with its regular
method of accounting and will receive a tax benefit from the premium only in
computing such U.S. Holder's gain or loss upon the sale or other disposition or
payment of the principal amount of the note.

     An election to amortize premium will apply to amortizable bond premium on
all notes and other bonds, the interest on which is includable in the U.S.
Holder's gross income, held at the beginning of the U.S. Holder's first taxable
year to which the election applies or that are thereafter acquired and may be
revoked only with the consent of the IRS.

  Exchange Offer

     The exchange of outstanding notes for new notes pursuant to the exchange
offer will not be a taxable exchange. Therefore, you will not recognize any
taxable income or loss as a result of exchanging an outstanding note for a new
note. The holding period for new notes received pursuant to the exchange offer
will include the holding period of the outstanding notes exchanged therefor.
Your federal income tax basis in new notes received pursuant to the exchange
offer will be the same as your federal income tax basis in the outstanding notes
surrendered in the exchange. We must pay additional cash interest on the notes
if we fail to comply with certain of our obligations in connection with the
exchange offer. That additional interest should be treated for tax purposes as
interest, taxable to holders in the manner described in "Stated Interest" above.
However, it is possible that the IRS may take a different position, in which
case a United States holder may have to include such additional interest in
income as the interest accrues or becomes fixed, regardless of that holder's
usual method of accounting.

  Disposition of the Notes

     Upon sale, redemption or other disposition of a note, a U.S. Holder will
generally recognize gain or loss equal to the difference between (i) the amount
realized on the disposition (other than amounts attributable to accrued interest
not yet taken into income which will be taxed as ordinary income) and (ii) the
U.S. Holder's adjusted tax basis in the note. A U.S. Holder's adjusted tax basis
in a note generally will equal the cost of the note to the U.S. Holder increased
by amounts includable in income as market discount (if the U.S. Holder elects to
include market discount on a current basis) and reduced by any bond premium
amortized by any U.S. Holder.

                                       86
<PAGE>   92

     Such gain or loss (except to the extent that the market discount rules
otherwise provide) will generally constitute capital gain or loss and will be
long-term capital gain (taxed, in the case of individuals, at a maximum rate of
20%) or loss if the U.S. Holder has held such note for longer than 12 months.

  Backup Withholding and Information Reporting

     Under the Code, a U.S. Holder of a note may be subject, under certain
circumstances, to information reporting and/or backup withholding at a 31% rate
with respect to cash payments in respect of interest on, or the gross proceeds
from disposition of, a note. This withholding applies only if a U.S. Holder (I)
fails to furnish its social security or other taxpayer identification number
("TIN") within a reasonable time after a request therefor, (ii) furnishes an
incorrect TIN, (iii) is notified by the IRS that it has failed to report
interest or dividends properly, or (iv) fails, under certain circumstances, to
provide a certified statement, signed under penalty of perjury, that the TIN
provided is its correct number and that it is not subject to backup withholding.
Any amount withheld from a payment to a U.S. Holder under the backup withholding
rules is allowable as a credit (and may entitle such holder to a refund) against
such Holder's U.S. federal income tax liability, provided that the required
information is furnished to the IRS. Certain persons are exempt from backup
withholding, including corporations and financial institutions. Holders of notes
should consult their tax advisors as to their qualification for exemption from
withholding and the procedure for obtaining such exemption.

                                NON-U.S. HOLDERS

     The following discussion is limited to the U.S. federal income tax
consequences relevant to a holder of a note that is not a U.S. Holder (a
"Non-U.S. Holder").

     This discussion does not address all aspects of U.S. federal income
taxation that may be relevant to your surrender of outstanding notes in the
exchange offer or your ownership or disposition of new notes thereafter. For
example, persons who are partners in foreign partnerships or beneficiaries of
foreign trusts or estates and who are subject to U.S. federal income tax because
of their own status, such as U.S. residence or foreign persons engaged in a
trade or business in the United States, may be subject to U.S. federal income
tax even though the entity is not subject to income tax on disposition of its
note.

     For purposes of the following discussion, interest and gain on the sale,
redemption or other disposition of the note will be considered "U.S. trade or
business income" if such income or gain is (i) effectively connected with the
conduct of a U.S. trade or business or (ii) in the case of an applicable income
tax treaty between the United States and the country of which the Holder is a
qualified resident, attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment (or to a
fixed base) in the United States.

  Stated Interest

     Generally, any interest paid to a Non-U.S. Holder of a note that is not
U.S. trade or business income will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax if
the interest qualifies as "portfolio interest." Interest on the notes will
qualify as portfolio interest if (i) the Non-U.S. Holder does not actually or
constructively own 10% or more of the voting power of the Company and is not a
"controlled foreign corporation" with respect to which the issuer is a "related
person" within the meaning of Section 881(c)(3)(C) of the Code, and (ii) the
beneficial owner, under penalties of perjury, certifies using the requisite form
that the beneficial owner is not a U.S. person and such certificate provides the
beneficial owner's name and address.

     The gross amount of payments to a Non-U.S. Holder of interest that do not
qualify for the portfolio interest exception and that are not U.S. trade or
business income will be subject to U.S. withholding tax at the rate of 30%,
unless a U.S. income tax treaty applies to reduce or eliminate withholding. U.S.
trade or business income will be taxed at regular U.S. federal income tax rates
rather than the 30% gross rate. To claim the benefit of a tax treaty or to claim
exemption from withholding because the income is U.S. trade or business income,
the Non-U.S. Holder must provide a properly executed Form 1001 or 4224 (or such
successor forms as the IRS designates), as applicable, prior to payment of
interest. These forms must be periodically updated. Under regulations effective
beginning after December 31, 2000, the Forms 1001 and 4224 will be replaced by
Form W-8, and a Non-U.S.

                                       87
<PAGE>   93

Holder who is claiming the benefits of a tax treaty may be required to obtain a
U.S. TIN and to provide certain documentary evidence issued by foreign
governmental authorities to prove residence in the foreign country.

  Disposition of the Notes

     Subject to the discussion concerning backup withholding, any gain realized
by a Non-U.S. Holder on the sale, redemption or other disposition of a note
generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax unless (i) such gain is
U.S. trade or business income or (ii) subject to certain exceptions, the
Non-U.S. Holder is an individual who holds the note as a capital asset and is
present in the United States for 183 days or more in the taxable year of the
disposition.

                  INFORMATION REPORTING AND BACKUP WITHHOLDING

     The issuers must report annually to the IRS and to each Non-U.S. Holder any
interest that is subject to U.S. withholding tax or that is exempt from
withholding pursuant to a tax treaty or the portfolio interest exception. Copies
of these information returns may also be made available under the provisions of
a specific treaty or agreement to the tax authorities of the country in which
the Non-U.S. Holder resides.

     Backup withholding and information reporting will not apply to payments of
principal on the notes by the issuers to a Non-U.S. Holder, if the Holder
certifies as to its non-U.S. status under penalties of perjury or otherwise
establishes an exemption (provided that neither the issuers nor their paying
agent has actual knowledge that the Holder is a U.S. Holder or that the
conditions of any other exemption are not, in fact, satisfied).

     The payment of the proceeds from the disposition of notes to or through the
U.S. office of any broker, U.S. or foreign, will be subject to information
reporting and possible backup withholding unless the owner certifies as to its
non-U.S. status under penalties of perjury or otherwise establishes an
exemption, provided that the broker does not have actual knowledge that the
holder is a U.S. Holder or that the conditions of any other exemption are not,
in fact, satisfied. The payment of the proceeds from the disposition of a note
to or through a non-U.S. office of a foreign broker that is not a "U.S. related
person" will not be subject to information reporting or backup withholding. (For
this purpose, a "U.S. related person" is (i) a "controlled foreign corporation"
for U.S. federal income tax purposes or (ii) a foreign person 50% or more of
whose gross income from all sources for the three-year period ending with the
close of its taxable year preceding the payment (or for such part of the period
that the broker has been in existence) is derived from activities that are
effectively connected with the conduct of a U.S. trade or business).

     In the case of the payment of proceeds from the disposition of notes to or
through a non-U.S. office of a broker that is either a U.S. person or a U.S.
related person, the regulations require information reporting on the payment
unless the broker has documentary evidence in its files that the owner is a
Non-U.S. Holder and the broker has no knowledge to the contrary. Backup
withholding will not apply to payments made through foreign offices of a broker
that is a U.S. person or a U.S. related person (absent actual knowledge that the
payee is a U.S. Holder).

     Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules from a payment to a
Non-U.S. Holder will be allowed as a refund or a credit against such Non-U.S.
Holder's U.S. federal income tax liability, provided that the requisite
procedures are followed.

                              PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

     Based on interpretations by the staff of the Securities and Exchange
Commission in no-action letters issued to third parties, we believe that new
notes may be offered for resale, resold and otherwise transferred by holders
unless the holder is:

     - an "affiliate" of Park-Ohio,

     - a broker-dealer who acquired outstanding notes directly from Park-Ohio,
       or

     - a broker-dealer who acquired outstanding notes as a result of
       market-making or other trading activities.

                                       88
<PAGE>   94

     Transfers will be permitted without compliance with the registration and
prospectus delivery provisions of the Securities Act of 1933, provided that the
new notes are acquired in the ordinary course of the holders' business and the
holder has no arrangement with any person to participate in a distribution of
the new notes. Broker-dealers receiving new notes in the exchange offer will be
subject to a prospectus delivery requirement with respect to resales of those
new notes.

     Each broker-dealer that receives new notes for its own account in the
exchange offer must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection
with any resale of those new notes. This prospectus, as it may be amended or
supplemented from time to time, may be used by a broker-dealer in connection
with resales of new notes received in exchange for outstanding notes where such
outstanding notes were acquired as a result of market-making activities or other
trading activities. We have agreed that, for a period of 180 days after the
expiration date of the exchange offer, we will make this prospectus, as amended
or supplemented, available to any broker-dealer for use in connection with any
resale.

     We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of new notes by
broker-dealers. New notes received by broker-dealers for their own account in
the exchange offer may be sold from time to time in one or more transactions in
the over-the-counter market transactions, in negotiated transactions, through
the writing of options on the new notes or a combination of those methods of
resale, at market prices prevailing at the time of resale, at prices related to
such prevailing market prices or at negotiated prices. Any resale may be made
directly to purchasers or to or through brokers or dealers who may receive
compensation in the form of commissions or concessions from the broker-dealer or
the purchasers of any new notes. Any broker-dealer that resells new notes that
were received by it for its own account in the exchange offer and any broker or
dealer that participates in a distribution of new notes may be deemed to be an
"underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act and any profit on the
resale of new notes and any commission or concessions received by any of those
persons may be deemed to be underwriting compensation under the Securities Act.
The Letter of Transmittal states that, by acknowledging that it will deliver,
and by delivering the SEC a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be deemed to
admit that it is an "underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act.
Despite this acknowledgment, a broker-dealer may nonetheless be determined to be
an "underwriter" by the SEC.

     For a period of 180 days after the expiration date of the exchange offer,
we will promptly send additional copies of this prospectus and any amendment or
supplement to any broker-dealer that requests those documents in the Letter of
Transmittal. We have agreed to pay all expenses incident to the exchange offer,
including the expenses of one counsel for the holders of the notes, other than
commissions or concessions of any broker-dealer.

     The initial purchasers and their affiliates have provided in the past, and
may provide in the future, investment banking and financial advisory services to
us for which they have received, and in the future may receive, customary fees.

                                 LEGAL MATTERS

     The validity of the new notes we will issue in the exchange offer will be
passed upon for us by Jones, Day, Reavis & Pogue, Cleveland, Ohio.

                                    EXPERTS

     The consolidated financial statements of Park-Ohio Industries, Inc. and
Subsidiaries at December 31, 1998 and 1997, and for each of the three years in
the period ended December 31, 1998 appearing in this prospectus and registration
statement have been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent auditors, as set
forth in their report appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance
upon such report given upon the authority of such firm as experts in accounting
and auditing.

                                       89
<PAGE>   95

                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

                   INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               PAGE
                                                              NUMBER
                                                              ------
<S>                                                           <C>
Consolidated Balance Sheet -- March 31, 1999 (Unaudited)....  F-2
Consolidated Statements of Income -- Three Months Ended
  March 31, 1998 and March 31, 1999 (Unaudited).............  F-3
Consolidated Statement of Shareholder's Equity -- Three
  Months Ended March 31, 1999 (Unaudited)...................  F-4
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows -- Three Months Ended
  March 31, 1998 and March 31, 1999 (Unaudited).............  F-5
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)......  F-6
Report of Ernst & Young LLP, Independent Auditors...........  F-9
Consolidated Balance Sheets --
  December 31, 1997 and December 31, 1998...................  F-10
Consolidated Statements of Income --
  Years Ended December 31, 1996, 1997 and 1998..............  F-11
Consolidated Statements of Shareholder's Equity -- Years
  Ended December 31, 1996, 1997 and 1998....................  F-12
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows --
  Years Ended December 31, 1996, 1997 and 1998..............  F-13
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements..................  F-14
</TABLE>

                                       F-1
<PAGE>   96

                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
                     CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET (UNAUDITED)

                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              MARCH 31,
                                                                1999
                                                              ---------
<S>                                                           <C>
ASSETS
Current Assets
  Cash and cash equivalents.................................  $  4,482
  Accounts receivable, less allowances for doubtful accounts
     of $3,060 at March 31, 1999............................   101,761
  Inventories...............................................   168,072
  Deferred tax assets.......................................     2,232
  Other current assets......................................     6,614
                                                              --------
          Total Current Assets..............................   283,161
Property, Plant and Equipment...............................   198,909
  Less accumulated depreciation.............................    74,488
                                                              --------
                                                               124,421
Other Assets
  Excess purchase price over net assets acquired, net of
     accumulated amortization of $8,919 at March 31, 1999...   109,873
  Deferred taxes............................................     8,900
  Other.....................................................    38,926
                                                              --------
                                                              $565,281
                                                              ========
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY
Current Liabilities
  Trade accounts payable....................................  $ 62,066
  Accrued expenses..........................................    54,986
  Current portion of long-term liabilities..................     2,034
                                                              --------
          Total Current Liabilities.........................   119,086
Long-Term Liabilities, less current portion
  Long-term debt............................................   270,032
  Other postretirement benefits.............................    26,152
  Other.....................................................     4,572
                                                              --------
                                                               300,756
Shareholder's Equity
  Common stock, par value $1 a share........................       -0-
  Additional paid-in capital................................    64,844
  Retained earnings.........................................    81,928
  Accumulated other comprehensive earnings (loss)...........    (1,333)
                                                              --------
                                                               145,439
                                                              --------
                                                              $565,281
                                                              ========
</TABLE>

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                       F-2
<PAGE>   97

                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
                 CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME (UNAUDITED)

                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                                                   MARCH 31,
                                                              --------------------
                                                                1998        1999
                                                              --------    --------
<S>                                                           <C>         <C>
Net sales...................................................  $136,503    $171,403
Cost of products sold.......................................   113,171     140,436
                                                              --------    --------
  Gross profit..............................................    23,332      30,967
Selling, general and administrative expenses................    14,137      17,952
                                                              --------    --------
  Operating income..........................................     9,195      13,015
Interest expense............................................     4,152       5,378
                                                              --------    --------
  Income before income taxes................................     5,043       7,637
Income taxes................................................     2,169       3,289
                                                              --------    --------
  Net income................................................  $  2,874    $  4,348
                                                              ========    ========
</TABLE>

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                       F-3
<PAGE>   98

                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

           CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY (UNAUDITED)

                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            ACCUMULATED
                                                                               OTHER
                                                   ADDITIONAL              COMPREHENSIVE
                                          COMMON    PAID-IN     RETAINED     EARNINGS
                                          STOCK     CAPITAL     EARNINGS      (LOSS)        TOTAL
                                          ------   ----------   --------   -------------   --------
<S>                                       <C>      <C>          <C>        <C>             <C>
Balance January 1, 1999.................  $ -0-     $64,844     $77,580       $(1,582)     $140,842
Comprehensive income:
  Net income............................                          4,348                       4,348
  Foreign currency translation
     adjustment.........................                                          249           249
                                                                                           --------
     Comprehensive income...............                                                      4,597
                                          -----     -------     -------       -------      --------
Balance March 31, 1999..................  $ -0-     $64,844     $81,928       $(1,333)     $145,439
                                          =====     =======     =======       =======      ========
</TABLE>

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                       F-4
<PAGE>   99

                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

               CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS (UNAUDITED)

                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                                                   MARCH 31,
                                                              --------------------
                                                                1998        1999
                                                              --------    --------
<S>                                                           <C>         <C>
OPERATING ACTIVITIES
  Net income................................................  $  2,874    $  4,348
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided
     (used) by operating activities:
       Depreciation and amortization........................     3,731       4,984
                                                              --------    --------
                                                                 6,605       9,332
Changes in operating assets and liabilities excluding
  acquisitions of businesses:
  Accounts receivable.......................................    (9,348)      2,002
  Inventories and other current assets......................   (17,148)     (8,737)
  Accounts payable and accrued expenses.....................    10,249      11,066
  Other.....................................................    (2,296)     (2,737)
                                                              --------    --------
     Net Cash Provided (Used) by Operating Activities.......   (11,938)     10,926
INVESTING ACTIVITIES
  Purchases of property, plant and equipment, net...........    (6,254)     (6,304)
  Costs of acquisitions, net of cash acquired...............       -0-     (29,146)
  Purchase of investments...................................      (101)       (446)
                                                              --------    --------
     Net Cash (Used) by Investing Activities................    (6,355)    (35,896)
FINANCING ACTIVITIES
  Proceeds from bank arrangements for acquisitions..........       -0-      29,000
  Proceeds from bank arrangements for operations............    17,500         -0-
  Payments on debt..........................................       (74)     (3,868)
  Purchase of treasury stock................................      (237)        -0-
  Issuance of common stock under stock option plan..........        73         -0-
                                                              --------    --------
     Net Cash Provided by Financing Activities..............    17,262      25,132
                                                              --------    --------
     Increase (Decrease) in Cash and Cash Equivalents.......    (1,031)        162
     Cash and Cash Equivalents at Beginning of Period.......     1,814       4,320
                                                              --------    --------
     Cash and Cash Equivalents at End of Period.............  $    783    $  4,482
                                                              ========    ========
</TABLE>

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                       F-5
<PAGE>   100

                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (UNAUDITED)

                                 MARCH 31, 1999
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

NOTE A -- BASIS OF PRESENTATION

     The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Park-Ohio
Industries, Inc. and its subsidiaries ("Park-Ohio," "the Company"). Park-Ohio is
a wholly-owned subsidiary of Park-Ohio Holdings Corp. as of June 10, 1998. All
significant intercompany transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

     The accompanying unaudited consolidated financial statements have been
prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles for interim
financial information and with the instructions to Form 10-Q and Article 10 of
Regulation S-X. Accordingly, they do not include all of the information and
footnotes required by generally accepted accounting principles for complete
financial statements. In the opinion of management, all adjustments (consisting
of normal recurring accruals) considered necessary for a fair presentation have
been included. Operating results for the three month period ended March 31, 1999
are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be expected for the year
ending December 31, 1999. For further information, refer to the consolidated
financial statements and footnotes thereto included in the Company's Annual
Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1998.

NOTE B -- ACQUISITIONS AND DISPOSITION

     During April 1998, the Company completed the acquisition of Direct
Fasteners Limited ("Direct") located in Ontario, Canada. The transaction was
accounted for as a purchase. Direct is a distributor of fasteners. The aggregate
purchase price and the results of operations of Direct prior to the date of
acquisition were not material to the Company.

     During September 1998, the Company completed the sale of the assets of
Friendly and Safe Packaging Systems, Inc. to Kerr Group. The transaction had an
immaterial effect on the consolidated results of operation and financial
position of the Company.

     During October 1998, the Company acquired all of the shares of GIS
Industries, Inc. ("Gateway"). The transaction has been accounted for as a
purchase. Gateway is a distributor of fasteners and a manufacturer of fabricated
metal products and fasteners. The aggregate purchase price and the results of
operations of Gateway prior to the date of acquisition were not material to the
Company.

     During 1999, the Company acquired all of the shares of The Metalloy
Corporation ("Metalloy") and substantially all of the assets of St. Louis Screw
and Bolt ("St. Louis Screw") and PMC Industries, Inc. ("PMC") for cash. Metalloy
is a full service aluminum casting and machining company. St. Louis Screw is a
manufacturer of bolts and PMC provides capital equipment and associated parts
for the oil drilling industry. Each of these transactions has been accounted for
as a purchase. The purchase price and the results of operations of Metalloy and
the two other businesses prior to the date of acquisition were not material to
the Company.

NOTE C -- INVENTORIES

     The components of inventory consist of the following:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                MARCH 31,
                                                                  1999
                                                                ---------
<S>                                                             <C>
In process and finished goods...............................    $135,709
Raw materials and supplies..................................      32,363
                                                                --------
                                                                $168,072
                                                                ========
</TABLE>

                                       F-6
<PAGE>   101
                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

     NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (UNAUDITED) -- (CONTINUED)

NOTE D -- CORPORATE REORGANIZATION

     At the 1998 Annual Meeting of Shareholders of Park-Ohio Industries, Inc.
("Park-Ohio") held on May 28, 1998, the shareholders of Park-Ohio approved an
agreement of Merger ("Merger Agreement") dated February 20, 1998 by and among
Park-Ohio, PKOH Holding Corp. ("Holdings") and PKOH Merger Corp. ("Merger
Corp.") providing for a reorganization of Park-Ohio into a holding company form
of ownership with Holdings as its sole parent. On June 10, 1998, Holdings
amended and restated its articles of incorporation to increase its authorized
shares from 100 shares of common stock, $1.00 par value per share, to 40,000,000
shares of common stock and 632,470 shares of preferred stock, all $1.00 par
value per share, and changed its name from PKOH Holding Corp. to Park-Ohio
Holdings Corp. Effective as of the close of business on June 15, 1998, Merger
Corp. was merged with and into Park-Ohio upon the terms and conditions of the
Merger Agreement. At the effective time of the Merger, (i) all of the shares of
Park-Ohio's common stock issued and outstanding immediately prior to the Merger
were converted into an equal number of shares of Holdings' common stock (on a
share-for-share basis), (ii) all of the shares of Merger Corp.'s common stock
issued and outstanding immediately prior to the Merger were converted into 100
shares of Park-Ohio's common stock and (iii) all of the shares of Holdings'
common stock issued and outstanding immediately prior to the Merger were
canceled.

     Prior to the Merger, there was no public market for Holdings' common stock,
and Park-Ohio's common stock was listed for trading on the NASDAQ National
Market under the symbol "PKOH". Upon the opening of the market after the
effective time of the Merger: (i) Holdings' common stock was registered under
Section 12 (g) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange
Act"), and was listed for trading on the NASDAQ National Market under the symbol
"PKOH"; (ii) Park-Ohio common stock was simultaneously delisted from the NASDAQ
National Market and ceased to be registered under Section 12 (g) of the Exchange
Act; and (iii) Holdings assumed Park-Ohio's reporting obligations under the
Exchange Act.

NOTE E -- ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS

     In March 1998, the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants
("AICPA") issued Statement of Position ("SOP") 98-1, "Accounting for the Cost of
Computer Software Developed or Obtained for Internal Use". The SOP requires
companies to capitalize qualifying computer software costs incurred during the
application development stage. This statement is applied prospectively and is
effective for financial statements for fiscal years beginning after December 15,
1998. The Company adopted the SOP in the first quarter of 1999. The impact of
this new standard did not have a significant effect on the Company's financial
position or results of operations.

     In April 1998, the AICPA issued SOP 98-5, "Accounting for the Costs of
Start-up Activities". The SOP requires that costs of start-up activities be
expensed as incurred. The SOP is effective for fiscal years beginning after
December 15, 1998. The Company adopted the SOP in the first quarter of 1999. The
impact of adoption of the SOP on the Company's financial position, results of
operations or cash flows was immaterial.

     The Financial Accounting Standards Board's Statement of Financial
Accounting Standards No. 133, "Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging
Activities" was issued in June 1998. Statement 133 requires derivatives to be
recorded on the balance sheet at fair value and establishes accounting for three
different types of hedges: hedges of changes in fair value of assets,
liabilities, or firm commitments; hedges of the variable cash flows of
forecasted transactions; and hedges of foreign currency exposures of net
investments in foreign operations. Statement 133 is effective for years
beginning after June 15, 1999 and is not expected to have a significant impact
on the Company's financial position or results of operations.

NOTE F -- SEGMENTS

     During the first quarter of 1999 the Company, upon completion of the
acquisition of Metalloy, a full service aluminum casting and machining company,
redefined its operating segments. The Company retained its

                                       F-7
<PAGE>   102
                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

     NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (UNAUDITED) -- (CONTINUED)

Integrated Logistics ("ILS") segment and further segregated its former
Manufactured Products segment into an Aluminum Products segment and a
Manufactured Products segment. ILS is a leading national supplier of fasteners
(e.g. nuts, bolts and screws) and other industrial products to original
equipment manufacturers, other manufacturers and distributors. In connection
with the supply of such industrial products, ILS provides a variety of
value-added, cost-effective procurement solutions. Aluminum Products
manufactures cast aluminum critical components primarily for automotive original
equipment manufacturers. In addition, Aluminum Products also provides
value-added services such as design and engineering, machining and assembly.
Manufactured Products is a diverse group of manufacturing businesses that design
and manufacture a broad range of high quality products for specific customer
applications.

     Results by Business Segment were as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                                                   MARCH 31,
                                                              --------------------
                                                                1998        1999
                                                              --------    --------
<S>                                                           <C>         <C>
Net sales, including intersegment sales:
  ILS.......................................................  $ 91,794    $106,412
  Aluminum products.........................................     9,904      31,619
  Manufactured products.....................................    34,805      33,372
                                                              --------    --------
                                                              $136,503    $171,403
                                                              ========    ========
Income before income taxes:
  ILS.......................................................  $  7,920    $ 10,965
  Aluminum products.........................................       633       2,971
  Manufactured products.....................................     2,087         972
                                                              --------    --------
                                                                10,640      14,908
Amortization of excess purchase price over net assets
acquired....................................................      (381)       (814)
  Corporate costs...........................................    (1,064)     (1,079)
  Interest expense..........................................    (4,152)     (5,378)
                                                              --------    --------
                                                              $  5,043    $  7,637
                                                              ========    ========
</TABLE>

     Identifiable assets were as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              DECEMBER 31,    MARCH 31,
                                                                  1998          1999
                                                              ------------    ---------
<S>                                                           <C>             <C>
  ILS.......................................................    $288,713      $307,369
  Aluminum products.........................................      40,063        96,118
  Manufactured products.....................................     147,009       155,496
  General corporate.........................................      13,769         6,298
                                                                --------      --------
                                                                $489,554      $565,281
                                                                ========      ========
</TABLE>

                                       F-8
<PAGE>   103

               REPORT OF ERNST & YOUNG LLP, INDEPENDENT AUDITORS

Board of Directors and Shareholder
Park-Ohio Industries, Inc.

     We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Park-Ohio
Industries, Inc. and subsidiaries (a wholly-owned subsidiary of Park-Ohio
Holdings Corp.) as of December 31, 1997 and 1998, and the related consolidated
statements of income, shareholder's equity and cash flows for each of the three
years in the period ended December 31, 1998. These financial statements are the
responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an
opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

     We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

     In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly,
in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of Park-Ohio
Industries, Inc. and subsidiaries at December 31, 1997 and 1998 and the
consolidated results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the
three years in the period ended December 31, 1998 in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles.

                                          /s/ ERNST & YOUNG LLP

Cleveland, Ohio
February 15, 1999

                                       F-9
<PAGE>   104

                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

                          CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   DECEMBER 31,
                                                              ----------------------
                                                                1997         1998
                                                              ---------    ---------
                                                              (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                                           <C>          <C>
                                       ASSETS
Current Assets
  Cash and cash equivalents.................................  $  1,814     $  4,320
  Accounts receivable, less allowances for doubtful accounts
     of $2,060 in 1997 and $2,803 in 1998...................    86,787       95,718
  Inventories...............................................   129,512      150,052
  Deferred tax assets.......................................     3,240        2,232
  Other current assets......................................     5,075        5,468
                                                              --------     --------
          Total Current Assets..............................   226,428      257,790
Property, Plant and Equipment
  Land and land improvements................................     4,126        4,460
  Buildings.................................................    24,782       25,912
  Machinery and equipment...................................   103,956      130,253
                                                              --------     --------
                                                               132,864      160,625
  Less accumulated depreciation.............................    59,795       70,468
                                                              --------     --------
                                                                73,069       90,157
Other Assets
  Excess purchase price over net assets acquired, net of
     accumulated amortization of $5,749 in 1997 and $8,105
     in 1998................................................    68,996       99,351
  Deferred taxes............................................    12,960        8,900
  Other.....................................................    31,656       33,356
                                                              --------     --------
                                                              $413,109     $489,554
                                                              ========     ========
                        LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY
Current Liabilities
  Trade accounts payable....................................  $ 49,470     $ 46,755
  Accrued expenses..........................................    28,291       32,076
  Current portion of long-term liabilities..................     2,223        2,372
                                                              --------     --------
          Total Current Liabilities.........................    79,984       81,203
  Long-Term Liabilities, less current portion
  Long-term debt............................................   172,283      237,483
  Other postretirement benefits.............................    27,537       26,286
  Other.....................................................     4,295        3,740
                                                              --------     --------
                                                               204,115      267,509
Shareholder's Equity
  Common stock; par value $1 a share........................    10,960          -0-
  Additional paid-in capital................................    53,476       64,844
  Retained earnings.........................................    67,486       77,580
  Treasury stock, at cost...................................    (2,087)         -0-
  Accumulated other comprehensive earnings (loss)...........      (825)      (1,582)
                                                              --------     --------
                                                               129,010      140,842
                                                              --------     --------
                                                              $413,109     $489,554
                                                              ========     ========
</TABLE>

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                      F-10
<PAGE>   105

                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

                       CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                             --------------------------------
                                                               1996        1997        1998
                                                             --------    --------    --------
                                                                  (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                                          <C>         <C>         <C>
Net sales..................................................  $347,679    $441,110    $551,793
Cost of products sold......................................   289,400     368,734     455,167
                                                             --------    --------    --------
  Gross profit.............................................    58,279      72,376      96,626
Selling, general and administrative expenses...............    38,131      44,396      56,318
Restructuring charge.......................................     2,652         -0-         -0-
                                                             --------    --------    --------
  Operating income.........................................    17,496      27,980      40,308
Other income...............................................    (4,204)       (320)        -0-
Interest expense...........................................     6,947       9,101      17,488
                                                             --------    --------    --------
  Income from continuing operations before income taxes....    14,753      19,199      22,820
Income taxes...............................................     5,060       7,903       9,726
                                                             --------    --------    --------
  Income from continuing operations before extraordinary
     charge................................................     9,693      11,296      13,094
Extraordinary charge for early retirement of debt, net of
  tax benefit of $928......................................       -0-      (1,513)        -0-
Income from discontinued operations, net of tax............    11,642         -0-         -0-
                                                             --------    --------    --------
Net income.................................................  $ 21,335    $  9,783    $ 13,094
                                                             ========    ========    ========
</TABLE>

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                      F-11
<PAGE>   106

                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

                CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                           ACCUMULATED
                                                                                              OTHER
                                                    ADDITIONAL                            COMPREHENSIVE
                                         COMMON      PAID-IN      RETAINED    TREASURY      EARNINGS
                                          STOCK      CAPITAL      EARNINGS     STOCK         (LOSS)         TOTAL
                                         -------    ----------    --------    --------    -------------    --------
                                                                   (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                      <C>        <C>           <C>         <C>         <C>              <C>
Balance at January 1, 1996.............  $10,402     $49,184      $36,368     $  --0-        $  (412)      $ 95,542
Comprehensive income:
  Net income...........................                            21,335                                    21,335
Foreign currency translation
  adjustment...........................                                                         (217)          (217)
  Comprehensive income.................                                                                      21,118
Exercise of stock options..............       31         153                                                    184
Purchase of treasury stock.............                                        (1,775)                       (1,775)
                                         -------     -------      -------     -------        -------       --------
Balance at December 31, 1996...........   10,433      49,337       57,703      (1,775)          (629)       115,069
Comprehensive income:
  Net income...........................                             9,783                                     9,783
  Foreign currency translation
    adjustment.........................                                                         (196)          (196)
                                                                                                           --------
Comprehensive income...................                                                                       9,587
Issuance of General Aluminum Mfg.
  Company earn-out shares..............      375       3,600                                                  3,975
Exercise of stock options..............      152         539                    2,673                         3,364
Purchase of treasury stock.............                                        (2,985)                       (2,985)
                                         -------     -------      -------     -------        -------       --------
Balance at December 31, 1997...........   10,960      53,476       67,486      (2,087)          (825)       129,010
Comprehensive income:
Net income.............................                            13,094                                    13,094
Foreign currency translation
  adjustment...........................                                                         (757)          (757)
Comprehensive income...................                                                                      12,337
Issuance of General Aluminum Mfg.
  Company earn-out shares..............      188       2,306                                                  2,494
Exercise of stock options..............                  (18)                     257                           239
Purchase of treasury stock.............                                          (238)                         (238)
Corporate reorganization...............  (11,148)      9,080                    2,068                           -0-
Dividends paid.........................                            (3,000)                                   (3,000)
                                         -------     -------      -------     -------        -------       --------
Balance at December 31, 1998...........  $   -0-     $64,844      $77,580     $   -0-        $(1,582)      $140,842
                                         =======     =======      =======     =======        =======       ========
</TABLE>

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                      F-12
<PAGE>   107

                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                              -------------------------------
                                                               1996        1997        1998
                                                              -------    ---------    -------
                                                                  (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                                           <C>        <C>          <C>
OPERATING ACTIVITIES
  Net Income................................................  $21,335    $   9,783    $13,094
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided
     (used) by continuing operations:
       Extraordinary charge.................................      -0-        1,513        -0-
       Discontinued operations..............................  (11,642)         -0-        -0-
       Gain on sale of investments..........................   (1,552)        (320)       -0-
       Depreciation and amortization........................    7,998       10,365     12,753
       Deferred income taxes................................    4,310        5,686      6,659
                                                              -------    ---------    -------
                                                               20,449       27,027     32,506
  Changes in operating assets and liabilities excluding
     acquisitions of businesses:
       Accounts receivable..................................   (3,643)     (14,008)    (2,312)
       Inventories..........................................   (3,056)     (21,021)   (10,404)
       Accounts payable and accrued expenses................   (1,214)       5,623     (7,465)
       Other................................................   (6,850)      (7,660)    (8,193)
                                                              -------    ---------    -------
       Net Cash Provided (Used) by
          Continuing Operations.............................    5,686      (10,039)     4,132
       Net Cash Provided by Discontinued Operations.........    2,040          -0-        -0-
                                                              -------    ---------    -------
       Net Cash Provided (Used) by
          Operating Activities..............................    7,726      (10,039)     4,132
INVESTING ACTIVITIES
  Purchases of property, plant and equipment, net...........  (15,590)     (15,947)   (22,681)
  Costs of acquisitions, net of cash acquired...............      -0-      (60,389)   (40,175)
  Purchase of investments...................................   (5,427)      (1,432)      (101)
  Proceeds from sales of investments........................    6,315          551        -0-
  Proceeds from sale of discontinued operations, net of
     $4,500 of income taxes.................................   46,313          -0-        -0-
                                                              -------    ---------    -------
     Net Cash Provided (Used) by
       Investing Activities.................................   31,611      (77,217)   (62,957)
FINANCING ACTIVITIES
  Proceeds from bank arrangements...........................    9,500      106,500     66,000
  Payments on long-term debt................................  (45,249)    (166,657)    (1,670)
  Issuance of 9.25% senior notes, net of deferred financing
     costs..................................................      -0-      145,604        -0-
  Cash paid to retire subordinated debentures...............      -0-       (1,245)       -0-
  Dividends paid............................................      -0-          -0-     (3,000)
  Issuance of common stock under stock option plan..........      184        3,194        239
  Purchase of treasury stock................................   (1,775)      (2,985)      (238)
                                                              -------    ---------    -------
       Net Cash Provided (Used) by
          Financing Activities..............................  (37,340)      84,411     61,331
       Increase (decrease) in Cash and Cash Equivalents.....    1,997       (2,845)     2,506
       Cash and Cash Equivalents at Beginning of Year.......    2,662        4,659      1,814
                                                              -------    ---------    -------
       Cash and Cash Equivalents at End of Year.............  $ 4,659    $   1,814    $ 4,320
                                                              =======    =========    =======
  Taxes paid................................................  $ 6,925    $   1,215    $ 2,326
  Interest paid.............................................    8,321        7,713     16,272
</TABLE>

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                      F-13
<PAGE>   108

                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

                        DECEMBER 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)

NOTE A -- SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

     Consolidation: Park-Ohio Industries, Inc. is a wholly-owned subsidiary of
Park-Ohio Holdings Corp. The consolidated financial statements include the
accounts of the Company and all of its subsidiaries. All significant
intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated upon consolidation.

     Accounting Estimates: The preparation of financial statements in conformity
with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make
estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of
the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses
during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

     Cash Equivalents: The Company considers all highly liquid investments with
a maturity of three months or less when purchased to be cash equivalents.

     Inventories: Inventories are stated at the lower of cost (principally the
first-in, first-out method) or market value. If the first-in, first-out method
of inventory accounting had been used exclusively by the Company, inventories
would have been approximately $4,895 and $4,869 higher than reported at December
31, 1997 and 1998, respectively.

MAJOR CLASSES OF INVENTORIES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  DECEMBER 31,
                                                              --------------------
                                                                1997        1998
                                                                ----        ----
<S>                                                           <C>         <C>
In-process and finished goods...............................  $100,283    $124,783
Raw materials and supplies..................................    29,229      25,269
                                                              --------    --------
                                                              $129,512    $150,052
                                                              ========    ========
</TABLE>

     Property, Plant and Equipment: Property, plant and equipment are carried at
cost. Major additions and associated interest costs are capitalized and
betterments are charged to accumulated depreciation; expenditures for repairs
and maintenance are charged to operations. Depreciation of fixed assets is
computed principally by the straight-line method based on the estimated useful
lives of the assets. Interest capitalized in 1996 and 1997 was immaterial. The
Company capitalized interest of $1.0 million in 1998.

     Excess Purchase Price Over Net Assets Acquired: The Company records
amortization of excess purchase price over the fair value of net assets acquired
(see Note C) over periods from twenty-five to forty years using the
straight-line method. Management periodically evaluates for possible impairment
the current value of these intangibles through cash flow and income analyses of
the acquired businesses as required by Financial Accounting Standards Board's
Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 121, "Accounting for the
Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to be Disposed of"
which established accounting standards for determining the impairment of
long-lived assets to be held and used, certain identifiable intangibles, and
goodwill related to those assets and for long-lived assets and certain
identifiable intangibles to be disposed of.

     Pensions and Other Postretirement Benefits: The Company and its
subsidiaries have pension plans, principally noncontributory defined benefit or
noncontributory defined contribution plans, covering substantially all
employees. The Company has two non-pension and postretirement benefit plans. For
the defined benefit plans, benefits are based on the employee's years of service
and the Company's policy is to fund that amount recommended by its independent
actuaries. For the defined contribution plans, the costs charged to operations
and the amount funded are based upon a percentage of the covered employees'
compensation.

                                      F-14
<PAGE>   109
                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- CONTINUED

                        DECEMBER 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)

     Stock-Based Compensation: The Company has elected to account for
stock-based compensation using the intrinsic value method prescribed in
Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25 "Accounting for Stock Issued to
Employees" ("APB 25"), and related interpretations. Under APB 25, because the
exercise price of the Company's employee stock options equals the market price
of the underlying stock on the date of grant, no compensation expense is
recognized.

     Income Taxes: The Company accounts for income taxes under the liability
method whereby deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on
temporary differences between the financial reporting and the tax bases of
assets and liabilities and are measured using the current enacted tax rates.

     Revenue Recognition: For the majority of its operations, the Company
recognizes revenues upon shipment of its product. Revenues on long-term
contracts are recognized using the percentage of completion method of
accounting, under which the sales value of performance is recognized on the
basis of the percentage each contract's cost to date bears to the total
estimated cost. The recognition of profit, based upon anticipated final costs,
is made only after evaluation of the contract status at critical milestones. The
Company's contracts generally provide for billing to customers at various points
prior to contract completion. Revenues earned on contracts in process in excess
of billings are classified in other current assets in the accompanying balance
sheet.

     Environmental: The Company accrues environmental costs related to existing
conditions resulting from past or current operations and from which no current
or future benefit is discernible. Costs which extend the life of the related
property or mitigate or prevent future environmental contamination are
capitalized. The Company records a liability when environmental assessments
and/or remedial efforts are probable and can be reasonably estimated. The
estimated liability of the Company is not discounted or reduced for possible
recoveries from insurance carriers.

     Concentration of Credit Risk: The Company sells its products to customers
in diversified industries. The Company performs ongoing credit evaluations of
its customers' financial condition but does not require collateral to support
customer receivables. The Company establishes an allowance for doubtful accounts
based upon factors surrounding the credit risk of specific customers, historical
trends and other information. As of December 31, 1998 the Company had
uncollateralized receivables with six customers in the automotive and truck
industry each with several locations approximating $25,995 which represents 27%
of the Company's trade accounts receivable. During 1998, sales to these
customers amounted to approximately $135,241 which represents 25% of the
Company's net sales.

     Impact of Recently Issued Accounting Standards: The Company adopted FASB
Statement No. 130 "Reporting Comprehensive Income", at the beginning of 1998.
Statement 130 establishes standards for the reporting and display of
comprehensive earnings and its components in financial statements; however, the
adoption of this statement had no impact on the Company's net earnings.
Statement 130 requires foreign currency translation adjustments, which prior to
adoption were immaterial and included in accrued expenses, to be included in
other comprehensive earnings. Prior year financial statements have been
reclassified to conform to the requirements of Statement 130.

     The FASB has issued two accounting pronouncements which the Company adopted
in the fourth quarter of 1998. FASB Statement No. 131 "Disclosures about
Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information" and FASB Statement No. 132
"Employers' Disclosures about Pensions and Other Post Retirement Benefits -- an
amendment of FASB Statements No. 87, 88 and 106" both expand or modify
disclosures and accordingly, have no impact on the Company's financial position,
results of operations or cash flows.

     In March 1998, the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants
("AICPA") issued Statement of Position ("SOP") 98-1, "Accounting for the Costs
of Computer Software Developed or Obtained for Internal

                                      F-15
<PAGE>   110
                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- CONTINUED

                        DECEMBER 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)

Use". The SOP requires companies to capitalize qualifying computer software
costs incurred during the application development stage. The statement will be
applied prospectively and is effective for financial statements for fiscal years
beginning after December 15, 1998. This new standard is not expected to have a
significant effect on the Company's financial position or results of operations.

     In April 1998, the AICPA issued SOP 98-5, "Accounting for the Costs of
Start-up Activities". The SOP requires that costs of start-up activities be
expensed as incurred. The SOP is effective for fiscal years beginning after
December 15, 1998. The Company expects to adopt the SOP in the first quarter of
1999. The impact of adoption of the SOP on the Company's financial position,
results of operations or cash flows is expected to be immaterial.

     FASB Statement No. 133, "Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging
Activities" was issued in June 1998. Statement 133 requires derivatives to be
recorded on the balance sheet at fair value and establishes accounting for three
different types of hedges: hedges of changes in fair value of assets,
liabilities, or firm commitments; hedges of the variable cash flows of
forecasted transactions; and hedges of foreign currency exposures of net
investments in foreign operations. Statement 133 is effective for years
beginning after June 15, 1999 and is not expected to have a significant impact
on the Company's financial position or results of operations.

     Reclassification: Certain amounts in the prior period's financial
statements have been reclassified to be consistent with the current
presentation.

NOTE B -- CORPORATE REORGANIZATION

     At the 1998 Annual Meeting of Shareholders of Park-Ohio Industries, Inc.
("Park-Ohio") held on May 28, 1998, the shareholders of Park-Ohio approved an
agreement of Merger ("Merger Agreement") dated February 20, 1998 by and among
Park-Ohio, PKOH Holdings Corp. ("Holdings") and PKOH Merger Corp. ("Merger
Corp.") providing for a reorganization of Park-Ohio into a holding company form
of ownership with Holdings as its sole parent. On June 10, 1998, Holdings
amended and restated its articles of incorporation to increase its authorized
shares from 100 shares of common stock, $1.00 par value per share, to 40,000,000
shares of common stock and 632,470 shares of preferred stock, all $1.00 par
value per share, and changed its name from PKOH Holding Corp. to Park-Ohio
Holdings Corp. Effective as of the close of business on June 15, 1998, Merger
Corp. was merged with and into Park-Ohio upon the terms and conditions of the
Merger Agreement. At the effective time of the Merger, (i) all of the shares of
Park-Ohio's common stock issued and outstanding immediately prior to the Merger
were converted into an equal number of shares of Holding's common stock (on a
share-for-share basis), (ii) all of the shares of Merger Corp.'s common stock
issued and outstanding immediately prior to the Merger were converted into 100
shares of Park-Ohio's common stock and (iii) all of the shares of Holdings'
common stock issued and outstanding immediately prior to the Merger were
canceled.

     Prior to the Merger, there was no public market for Holdings' common stock,
and Park-Ohio's common stock was listed for trading on the NASDAQ National
Market under the symbol "PKOH". Upon the opening of the market after the
effective time of the Merger: (i) Holdings' common stock was registered under
Section 12(g) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange
Act"), and was listed for trading on the NASDAQ National Market under the symbol
"PKOH"; (ii) Park-Ohio common stock was simultaneously delisted from the NASDAQ
National Market and ceased to be registered under Section 12(g) of the Exchange
Act; and (iii) Holdings assumed Park-Ohio's reporting obligations under the
Exchange Act.

NOTE C -- ACQUISITIONS

     The Company completed two acquisitions for cash of approximately $40.2
million in 1998. In April 1998, the Company acquired all of the shares of Direct
Fasteners Limited ("Direct") a distributor of fasteners located in

                                      F-16
<PAGE>   111
                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- CONTINUED

                        DECEMBER 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)

Ontario, Canada. In October 1998, the Company acquired all of the shares of GIS
Industries, Inc. ("Gateway"), a distributor of fasteners and other industrial
products and a manufacturer of metal products and fasteners. Both Direct and
Gateway are included in the Company's Integrated Logistics ("ILS") segment. Each
of the transactions were accounted for as a purchase. The aggregate purchase
price and the results of operations of both Direct and Gateway prior to the date
of acquisition were not material to the Company.

     In January 1999, the Company acquired all of the shares of The Metalloy
Corporation ("Metalloy") for cash. Metalloy is a full service aluminum casting
and machining company and will be included in the Company's Manufactured
Products segment. The transaction will be accounted for as a purchase. The
purchase price and the results of operations of Metalloy prior to the date of
acquisition were not material to the Company.

     On August 1, 1997, the Company acquired substantially all of the shares of
Arden Industrial Products, Inc. ("Arden") for cash of approximately $44 million.
The transaction has been accounted for as a purchase. Arden is a national
distributor of specialty and standard fasteners to the industrial market. Arden
is included in the Company's ILS segment.

     The following is the estimated value of the net assets of Arden as of
August 1, 1997:

<TABLE>
<S>                                                             <C>
Cash........................................................    $ 2,711
Accounts receivable.........................................     11,503
Inventories.................................................     17,764
Property, plant and equipment...............................      4,468
Excess purchase price over net assets acquired..............     19,599
Other assets................................................      6,680
Trade accounts payable......................................     (6,437)
Accrued expenses............................................     (5,930)
Long-term liabilities.......................................     (6,358)
                                                                -------
Total estimated cost of acquisition.........................    $44,000
                                                                =======
</TABLE>

     During the year ended December 31, 1997, the Company acquired four other
businesses for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $18.6 million. Each
of these transactions was accounted for as a purchase, resulting in excess
purchase price over net assets acquired of $8.6 million. The following unaudited
pro forma results of operations assume the acquisitions of Arden and the other
businesses discussed above occurred on January 1, 1996. These pro forma results
have been prepared for comparative purposes only and do not purport to be
indicative of the results of operations which actually would have resulted had
the acquisition occurred on the date indicated, or which may result in the
future.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   YEAR ENDED
                                                              --------------------
                                                                1996        1997
                                                                ----        ----
<S>                                                           <C>         <C>
Net sales...................................................  $476,693    $508,724
Gross profit................................................    98,190      93,547
Income from continuing operations...........................     8,777      12,454
</TABLE>

     On October 15, 1993, the Company acquired General Aluminum Mfg. Company
(GAMCO), by issuing 250,000 shares of its common stock valued at $3,127 in
exchange for the outstanding shares of GAMCO. An additional 187,500 shares of
common stock valued at $1,931, were issued in March, 1995; an additional 375,000
shares of common stock valued at $3,975 were issued in January, 1997; an
additional 187,500 shares of common

                                      F-17
<PAGE>   112
                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- CONTINUED

                        DECEMBER 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)

stock valued at $2,494, representing the final earn-out shares to be issued
under the GAMCO purchase agreement, were issued in 1998. The additional $8,400
represents purchase price in excess of net assets acquired.

NOTE D -- DISPOSITIONS

     On July 31, 1996, the Company completed the sale of substantially all of
the assets of Bennett Industries, Inc. ("Bennett"), a wholly-owned subsidiary
which manufactures plastic containers, to North America Packaging Corporation, a
wholly-owned subsidiary of Southcorp Holdings Limited, an Australian company,
for $50.8 million in cash, resulting in a pre-tax gain of $13.8 million. The
results of operations and changes in cash flows for Bennett have been classified
as discontinued operations for all periods presented in the related consolidated
statements of income and consolidated statements of cash flows, respectively.
Interest expense has been allocated to discontinued operations based on the
ratio of net assets discontinued to the total net assets of the consolidated
entity plus consolidated debt.

     Summary operating results of the discontinued operations, excluding the
above gain on sale, for the year ended December 31, 1996 were as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   YEAR ENDED
                                                                DECEMBER 31, 1996
                                                                -----------------
<S>                                                             <C>
Sales.......................................................         $49,448
Costs and expenses..........................................          44,502
Income from discontinued operations before income taxes.....           4,946
Income taxes................................................           1,820
                                                                     -------
Net income from discontinued operations.....................         $ 3,126
                                                                     =======
</TABLE>

     During September, 1998 the Company completed the sale of the assets of
Friendly and Safe Packaging Systems, Inc. to Kerr Group. The transaction had an
immaterial effect on the consolidated results of operations and financial
position of the Company.

NOTE E -- ACCRUED EXPENSES

     Accrued expenses include the following:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 DECEMBER 31,
                                                              ------------------
                                                               1997       1998
                                                               ----       ----
<S>                                                           <C>        <C>
Self-insured liabilities....................................  $ 2,827    $ 2,911
Warranty and installation accruals..........................    3,401      3,156
Accrued payroll and payroll-related items...................    4,820      2,586
State and local taxes.......................................    2,324      2,101
Advance billings............................................    2,215      2,229
Acquisition liabilities.....................................    1,906      5,930
Interest payable............................................    1,498      1,695
Sundry......................................................    9,300     11,468
                                                              -------    -------
     Totals.................................................  $28,291    $32,076
                                                              =======    =======
</TABLE>

                                      F-18
<PAGE>   113
                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- CONTINUED

                        DECEMBER 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)

NOTE F -- FINANCING ARRANGEMENTS

     Long-term debt consists of the following:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  DECEMBER 31,
                                                              --------------------
                                                                1997        1998
                                                                ----        ----
<S>                                                           <C>         <C>
9.25% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007....................  $150,000    $150,000
Revolving credit maturing on April 30, 2001.................    20,000      86,000
Other.......................................................     2,755       2,105
                                                              --------    --------
                                                               172,755     238,105
Less current maturities.....................................       472         622
                                                              --------    --------
     Total..................................................  $172,283    $237,483
                                                              ========    ========
</TABLE>

     During 1998 Park-Ohio entered a new credit agreement with a group of banks
under which it may borrow up to $150 million on an unsecured basis. Interest is
payable quarterly at the prime lending rate less 1% to .3% (6.75% at December
31, 1998) or at Park-Ohio's election at LIBOR plus .9% to 1.7% (which aggregated
6.5% at December 31, 1998). The interest rate is dependent on the aggregate
amounts borrowed under the agreement. The weighted average rate on borrowings
was 8.2% at December 31, 1998. The credit agreement expires on April 30, 2001.

     Provisions of the Senior Subordinated Notes and the revolving credit
agreement contain restrictions on the Company's ability to incur additional
indebtedness, to create liens or other encumbrances, to make certain payments,
investments, loans and guarantees and to sell or otherwise dispose of a
substantial portion of assets to or merge or consolidate with, an unaffiliated
entity. The revolving credit agreement also requires maintenance of specific
financial ratios.

     On November 25, 1997, the Company sold $150 million of its 9.25% Senior
Subordinated Notes due 2007 at a price of 97.375% of face value. Interest on the
Senior Subordinated Notes is payable semi-annually on June 1 and December 1 of
each year beginning on June 1, 1998. The fair market value of fixed rate debt
securities at December 31, 1998 was approximately $152,625. The Company used the
net proceeds of the Senior Subordinated Notes along with borrowings under its
new credit facility to (i) redeem its 7 1/4% Convertible Senior Subordinated
Debentures due June 15, 2004 and (ii) to repay substantially all amounts of its
then existing credit facility. The early extinguishment of the 7 1/4%
Convertible Senior Subordinated Debentures and the then existing credit facility
resulted in an extraordinary charge of $1.5 million consisting of the following:

<TABLE>
<S>                                                             <C>
Discount on prepayment of 7 1/4% Convertible Senior
  Subordinated Debentures...................................    $1,245
Write-off related unamortized financing costs...............     1,196
Extraordinary charge before income tax benefit..............     2,441
Income tax benefit..........................................       928
                                                                ------
Net extraordinary charge....................................    $1,513
                                                                ======
</TABLE>

     The Company has agreements on which up to $5 million in standby letters of
credit and commercial letters of credit may be issued. In addition to the bank's
customary letter of credit fees, a 3/4% fee is assessed on standby letters of
credit on an annual basis. As of December 31, 1998, in addition to amounts
borrowed under the revolving credit agreement, there is $2.8 million outstanding
primarily for standby letters of credit. A fee of 1/4% to 3/8% is imposed by the
bank on the unused portion of available borrowings.

                                      F-19
<PAGE>   114
                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- CONTINUED

                        DECEMBER 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)

     Maturities of long-term debt during each of the five years following
December 31, 1998 are approximately $622 in 1999, $537 in 2000, $86,278 in 2001,
$427 in 2002 and $123 in 2003.

NOTE G -- INCOME TAXES

     Significant components of the Company's net deferred tax assets and
liabilities are as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 DECEMBER 31,
                                                              ------------------
                                                               1997       1998
                                                               ----       ----
<S>                                                           <C>        <C>
Deferred tax assets:
Postretirement benefit obligation...........................  $10,200    $ 9,900
Inventory...................................................    6,500      6,800
Tax net operating loss carryforwards and credits............    4,100      1,500
Other -- net................................................    4,100      4,832
                                                              -------    -------
     Total deferred tax assets..............................   24,900     23,032
Deferred tax liabilities:
Tax over book depreciation..................................    5,200      6,900
Pension.....................................................    3,500      5,000
                                                              -------    -------
     Total deferred tax liabilities.........................    8,700     11,900
                                                              -------    -------
Net deferred tax assets.....................................  $16,200    $11,132
                                                              =======    =======
</TABLE>

     Income taxes consisted of the following:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                            YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                           --------------------------
                                                            1996      1997      1998
                                                            ----      ----      ----
                                                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                                        <C>       <C>       <C>
Current:
  Federal................................................  $ (150)   $  775    $1,023
  State..................................................     500       733     1,037
  Foreign................................................     400       709     1,007
                                                           ------    ------    ------
                                                              750     2,217     3,067
Deferred:
  Federal................................................   4,010     5,175     6,195
  State..................................................     300       511       464
                                                           ------    ------    ------
                                                            4,310     5,686     6,659
                                                           ------    ------    ------
Income taxes.............................................  $5,060    $7,903    $9,726
                                                           ======    ======    ======
</TABLE>

                                      F-20
<PAGE>   115
                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- CONTINUED

                        DECEMBER 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)

     The reasons for the difference between income taxes and the amount computed
by applying the statutory Federal income tax rate to income from continuing
operations before income taxes are as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                            YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                           --------------------------
                                                            1996      1997      1998
                                                            ----      ----      ----
                                                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                                        <C>       <C>       <C>
Computed statutory amount................................  $5,000    $6,500    $7,700
Effect of state income taxes payable.....................     600       800     1,000
Other....................................................    (540)      603     1,026
                                                           ------    ------    ------
Income taxes.............................................  $5,060    $7,903    $9,726
                                                           ======    ======    ======
</TABLE>

     At December 31, 1998, subsidiaries of the Company have net operating loss
carryforwards for income tax purposes of approximately $1.1 million subject to
certain limitations, which expire in 2001 to 2007.

NOTE H -- LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

     The Company is subject to various pending and threatened lawsuits in which
claims for monetary damages are asserted in the ordinary course of business.
While any litigation involves an element of uncertainty, in the opinion of
management, liabilities, if any, arising from currently pending or threatened
litigation will not have a material adverse effect on the Company's financial
condition, liquidity and results of operations.

                                      F-21
<PAGE>   116
                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- CONTINUED

                        DECEMBER 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)

NOTE I -- PENSIONS AND OTHER POSTRETIREMENT BENEFITS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     PENSION BENEFITS        OTHER BENEFITS
                                                    ------------------    --------------------
                                                     1997       1998        1997        1998
                                                     ----       ----        ----        ----
<S>                                                 <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>
CHANGE IN BENEFIT OBLIGATION
Benefit obligation at beginning of year...........  $45,049    $45,473    $ 19,888    $ 21,673
Service cost......................................      304        403         118         133
Amendments and other..............................      158        116         -0-         -0-
Interest cost.....................................    3,251      3,136       1,541       1,496
Plan participants' contributions..................      -0-        -0-         118         118
Actuarial losses..................................      995        731       2,207         497
Benefits paid.....................................   (4,284)    (4,158)     (2,199)     (2,199)
                                                    -------    -------    --------    --------
Benefit obligation at end of year.................  $45,473    $45,701    $ 21,673    $ 21,718
                                                    =======    =======    ========    ========
CHANGE IN PLAN ASSETS
Fair Value of plan assets at beginning of year....  $63,139    $80,274    $    -0-    $    -0-
Actual return on plan assets......................   21,204      7,832         -0-         -0-
Company contributions.............................      215         12       2,081       2,081
Plan participants' contributions..................      -0-        -0-         118         118
Benefits paid.....................................   (4,284)    (4,158)     (2,199)     (2,199)
                                                    -------    -------    --------    --------
Fair value of plan assets at end of year..........  $80,274    $83,960    $    -0-    $    -0-
                                                    =======    =======    ========    ========
Funded status of the plan (underfunded)...........  $34,801    $38,259    $(21,673)   $(21,718)
Unrecognized net transition obligation............     (279)      (329)        -0-         -0-
Unrecognized net actuarial gain...................  (21,654)   (21,027)     (6,812)     (5,595)
Unrecognized prior service cost...................    1,429      1,395        (802)       (723)
                                                    -------    -------    --------    --------
Prepaid benefit cost..............................  $14,297    $18,298    $(29,287)   $(28,036)
                                                    =======    =======    ========    ========
WEIGHTED-AVERAGE ASSUMPTIONS AS OF DECEMBER 31
Discount rate.....................................     7.25%      7.00%       7.25%       7.00%
Expected return on plan assets....................     8.50%      8.50%        N/A         N/A
Rate of compensation increase (decrease)..........     2.50%      2.50%        N/A         N/A
</TABLE>

     For measurement purposes, an 8.0% percent annual rate of increase in the
per capita cost of covered health care benefits was assumed for 1999. The rate
was assumed to decrease gradually to 5.5% for 2004 and remain at that level
thereafter.

                                      F-22
<PAGE>   117
                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- CONTINUED

                        DECEMBER 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           PENSION BENEFITS                 OTHER BENEFITS
                                     -----------------------------    --------------------------
                                      1996       1997       1998       1996      1997      1998
                                      ----       ----       ----       ----      ----      ----
<S>                                  <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>       <C>       <C>
COMPONENTS OF NET PERIODIC BENEFIT
  COST
Service costs......................  $   296    $   302    $   403    $  106    $  118    $  133
Interest costs.....................    3,294      3,252      3,136     1,457     1,541     1,496
Expected return on plan assets.....   (4,879)    (5,181)    (6,642)      -0-       -0-       -0-
Transition obligation..............      -0-         77         77       -0-       -0-       -0-
Amortization of prior service
  cost.............................      156        170        181       (79)      (79)      (79)
Recognized net actuarial gain......      (26)      (332)    (1,225)     (464)     (407)     (343)
                                     -------    -------    -------    ------    ------    ------
Benefit costs......................  $(1,159)   $(1,712)   $(4,070)   $1,020    $1,173    $1,207
                                     =======    =======    =======    ======    ======    ======
</TABLE>

     The Company has two non-pension postretirement benefit plans. Health care
benefits are provided on both a contributory and noncontributory basis. The life
insurance plan is primarily noncontributory.

     The assumed health care cost trend rate has a significant effect on the
amounts reported. A one-percentage-point change in the assumed health care cost
trend rate would have the following effects:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              1-PERCENTAGE    1-PERCENTAGE
                                                                 POINT           POINT
                                                                INCREASE        DECREASE
                                                              ------------    ------------
<S>                                                           <C>             <C>
Effect on total of service and interest cost components in
  1998......................................................   $  124,000      $  124,000
Effect on post retirement benefit obligation as of December
  31, 1998..................................................   $1,373,000      $1,373,000
</TABLE>

     The total contribution charged to pension expense for the Company's defined
contribution plans was $876 in 1998, $687 in 1997 and $796 in 1996.

NOTE J -- LEASES

     Rental expense for 1996, 1997 and 1998 was $4,751, $6,696 and $7,056,
respectively. Future minimum lease commitments during each of the five years
following December 31, 1998 are as follows: $6,858 in 1999, $5,687 in 2000,
$4,824 in 2001, $3,594 in 2002 $2,322 in 2003 and $4,977 thereafter.

NOTE K -- INDUSTRY SEGMENTS

     The Company conducts its business through two segments: Integrated
Logistics ("ILS") and Manufactured Products. ILS is a leading national supplier
of fasteners (e.g., nuts, bolts and screws) and other industrial products to
OEMs, other manufacturers and distributors. In connection with the supply of
such industrial products, ILS provides a variety of value-added, cost-effective
procurement solutions. The principal customers of ILS are in the transportation,
industrial, electrical, lawn and garden equipment industries. Manufactured
Products designs and manufactures a broad range of high quality products
engineered for specific customer applications. The principal customers of
Manufactured Products are OEMs and end-users in the automotive, railroad, truck
and aerospace industries.

     The Company's sales are made through its own sales organization,
distributors and representatives. Intersegment sales from the manufactured
products segment to the ILS segment are immaterial and eliminated in
consolidation and are not included in the figures presented. Intersegment sales
are accounted for at values based on market prices. Income allocated to segments
excludes certain corporate expenses, interest expense and

                                      F-23
<PAGE>   118
                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- CONTINUED

                        DECEMBER 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)

amortization of excess purchase price over net assets acquired. Identifiable
assets by industry segment include assets directly identified with those
operations.

     Corporate assets generally consist of cash and cash equivalents, deferred
tax assets, and other assets.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                             --------------------------------
                                                               1996        1997        1998
                                                               ----        ----        ----
<S>                                                          <C>         <C>         <C>
Net sales
  ILS......................................................  $188,306    $266,292    $364,546
  Manufactured products....................................   159,373     174,818     187,247
                                                             --------    --------    --------
                                                             $347,679    $441,110    $551,793
                                                             ========    ========    ========
Income from continuing operations before income taxes
  ILS......................................................  $ 15,282    $ 23,310    $ 34,595
  Manufactured products....................................    10,257      10,763      12,004
                                                             --------    --------    --------
                                                               25,539      34,073      46,599
Amortization of excess purchase price over net assets
  acquired.................................................    (1,902)     (2,211)     (2,277)
  Corporate costs..........................................    (1,937)     (3,562)     (4,014)
  Interest expense.........................................    (6,947)     (9,101)    (17,488)
                                                             --------    --------    --------
                                                             $ 14,753    $ 19,199    $ 22,820
                                                             ========    ========    ========
Identifiable assets
  ILS......................................................  $134,107    $252,763    $288,713
  Manufactured products....................................   136,701     140,278     187,095
  General corporate........................................    12,102      20,068      13,746
                                                             --------    --------    --------
                                                             $282,910    $413,109    $489,554
                                                             ========    ========    ========
Depreciation and amortization expense
  ILS......................................................  $  2,623    $  4,352    $  6,124
  Manufactured products....................................     5,375       6,013       6,629
                                                             --------    --------    --------
                                                             $  7,998    $ 10,365    $ 12,753
                                                             ========    ========    ========
Capital expenditures
  ILS......................................................  $  5,261    $  3,938    $  4,274
  Manufactured products....................................     9,163      11,870      18,316
  General corporate........................................     1,166         139          91
                                                             --------    --------    --------
                                                             $ 15,590    $ 15,947    $ 22,681
                                                             ========    ========    ========
</TABLE>

     The Company had sales of $33,728 in 1996 to Ford Motor Company which
represented 10% of consolidated net sales.

     Approximately 89% of the Company's net sales are within the United States.
None of the net sales to any foreign country represented more than 6% of the
Company's total sales. Approximately 96% of the Company's assets are maintained
in the United States.

                                      F-24
<PAGE>   119
                  PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- CONTINUED

                        DECEMBER 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)

NOTE L -- RESTRUCTURING CHARGES AND OTHER INCOME

     During the fourth quarter of 1996, the Company reorganized certain
manufacturing operations which resulted in the realignment of two manufacturing
facilities and the discontinuance of certain products lines. As a result of
these actions, the Company recorded a charge of $2,700 primarily for the
writedown of property and equipment and inventory to estimated net realizable
value.

     In December 1996, the Company negotiated full settlement of subordinated
notes receivable, resulting from the sale of two manufacturing facilities, which
were fully reserved at the date of sale. The net proceeds received of $2,700
were recorded in income in the fourth quarter. In the third quarter of 1996, the
Company sold certain securities purchased during 1996 for $6,315 which resulted
in a gain of $1,500.

                                      F-25
<PAGE>   120

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                  $200,000,000

                                [PARKOHIO LOGO]

                           PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC.

                       OFFER TO EXCHANGE ALL OUTSTANDING
                   9 1/4% SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES DUE 2007
        THAT WERE ORIGINALLY ISSUED ON JUNE 2, 1999 OR NOVEMBER 25, 1997
               FOR NEW 9 1/4% SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES DUE 2007
           THAT HAVE BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

                              -------------------
                                   PROSPECTUS
                              -------------------

                                 JULY 27, 1999

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>   121

                                                                    EXHIBIT 99.1

                           PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC.
                             LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL
                   9 1/4% SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES DUE 2007
                         CUSIPS 700677AC1 AND 700677AF4

                      TO: NORWEST BANK MINNESOTA, NATIONAL
                        ASSOCIATION, THE EXCHANGE AGENT

THE EXCHANGE OFFER WILL EXPIRE AT 5:00 P.M., NEW YORK CITY TIME, ON AUGUST 26,
1999, UNLESS EXTENDED (THE "EXPIRATION DATE"). TENDERS OF OUTSTANDING NOTES MAY
BE WITHDRAWN AT ANY TIME PRIOR TO 5:00 P.M. ON THE EXPIRATION DATE.

<TABLE>
  <S>                                           <C>
        By Registered or Certified Mail:                   By Overnight Courier:
  Norwest Bank Minnesota, National Association  Norwest Bank Minnesota, National Association
           Corporate Trust Operations                    Corporate Trust Operations
                 P.O. Box 1517                                 Norwest Center
           Minneapolis, MN 55480-1517                       Sixth and Marquette
                                                         Minneapolis, MN 55479-0113

                    By Hand:                                   By Facsimile:
  Norwest Bank Minnesota, National Association  Norwest Bank Minnesota, National Association
           Corporate Trust Operations                    Corporate Trust Operations
           Northstar East, 12th Floor                          (612) 667-4927
                 608 2nd Avenue                            Confirm by telephone:
             Minneapolis, MN 55402                             (612) 667-9764
</TABLE>

                            ------------------------

     Delivery of this instrument to an address other than as set forth above or
transmission of instructions via a facsimile number other than the one listed
above will not constitute a valid delivery. The instructions accompanying this
Letter of Transmittal should be read carefully before this Letter of Transmittal
is completed.

     HOLDERS WHO WISH TO BE ELIGIBLE TO RECEIVE EXCHANGE NOTES FOR THEIR
OUTSTANDING NOTES PURSUANT TO THE EXCHANGE OFFER MUST VALIDLY TENDER (AND NOT
WITHDRAW) THEIR OUTSTANDING NOTES TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT PRIOR TO THE EXPIRATION
DATE.

     The undersigned acknowledges receipt of the prospectus dated July 27, 1999
of Park-Ohio Industries, Inc. (the "Company") and this Letter of Transmittal,
which together constitute the Company's offer to exchange $1,000 principal
amount of its new 9 1/4% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007, Series D (the
"Exchange Notes"), which have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933,
pursuant to a Registration Statement of which the prospectus is a part, for each
$1,000 principal amount of its outstanding 9 1/4% Senior Subordinated Notes due
2007, Series B and Series C (the "Outstanding Notes"), of which an aggregate of
$200,000,000 in principal amount is outstanding, upon the terms and conditions
set forth in the prospectus.

     For each Outstanding Note accepted for exchange, the holder of such
Outstanding Note will receive an Exchange Note having a principal amount equal
to that of the surrendered Outstanding Note. Interest on the Exchange Notes will
accrue from the last interest payment date on which interest was paid on the
Outstanding Notes surrendered in exchange therefor or, if no interest has been
paid on the Outstanding Notes, from the date of original issue of the
Outstanding Notes. Holders of Outstanding Notes accepted for exchange will be
deemed to have waived the right to receive any other payments or accrued
interest on the Outstanding Notes. The Company reserves the right, at any time
or from time to time, to extend this exchange offer at its discretion, in which
event the term "Expiration Date" shall mean the latest time and date to which
the exchange offer is extended. The Company shall notify the Exchange Agent of
any extension by oral (promptly confirmed in writing) or written notice and will
make a public announcement thereof, each prior to 9:00 A.M., New York City time,
on the next business day after the previously scheduled Expiration Date.

     This Letter of Transmittal is to be used by holders if:
<PAGE>   122

     - certificates representing Outstanding Notes are to be physically
       delivered to the Exchange Agent by holders;

     - tender of Outstanding Notes is to be made by book-entry transfer to the
       Exchange Agent's account at The Depository Trust Company ("DTC"),
       pursuant to the procedures set forth in the prospectus under "The
       Exchange Offer -- Procedures for Tendering" by any financial institution
       that is a participant in DTC and whose name appears on a security
       position listing as the owner of Outstanding Notes; or

     - tender of Outstanding Notes is to be made according to the guaranteed
       delivery procedures set forth in the prospectus under "The Exchange
       Offer -- Guaranteed Delivery Procedures."

     DELIVERY OF DOCUMENTS TO DTC DOES NOT CONSTITUTE DELIVERY TO THE EXCHANGE
AGENT.

     The term "holder" with respect to the Exchange Offer means any person:

     - in whose name Outstanding Notes are registered on the books of the
       Company or any other person who has obtained a properly completed bond
       power from the registered holder, or

     - whose Outstanding Notes are held of record by DTC who desires to deliver
       such Outstanding Notes by book-entry transfer at DTC.

     The undersigned has completed, executed and delivered this Letter of
Transmittal to indicate the action the undersigned desires to take with respect
to the exchange offer.

     The instructions included with this Letter of Transmittal must be followed.
Questions and requests for assistance or for additional copies of the
prospectus, this Letter of Transmittal and the Notice of Guaranteed Delivery may
be directed to the Exchange Agent. See Instruction 11.

     HOLDERS WHO WISH TO ACCEPT THE EXCHANGE OFFER AND TENDER THEIR OUTSTANDING
NOTES MUST COMPLETE THIS LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL IN ITS ENTIRETY.

                 PLEASE READ THIS ENTIRE LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL
                    CAREFULLY BEFORE CHECKING ANY BOX BELOW

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                   DESCRIPTION OF 9 1/4% SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES DUE 2007 (OUTSTANDING NOTES)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                AGGREGATE           PRINCIPAL
                                                                                PRINCIPAL            AMOUNT
                                                                                 AMOUNT             TENDERED
   NAME(S) AND ADDRESS(ES) OF REGISTERED HOLDER(S)         CERTIFICATE         REPRESENTED          (IF LESS
              (PLEASE FILL IN, IF BLANK)                   NUMBER(S)*       BY CERTIFICATE(S)      THAN ALL)**
- ------------------------------------------------------- ------------------ --------------------- ---------------
<S>                                                    <C>                 <C>                 <C>

- ------------------------------------------------------- ------------------ --------------------- ---------------

- ------------------------------------------------------- ------------------ --------------------- ---------------

- ------------------------------------------------------- ------------------ --------------------- ---------------

- ------------------------------------------------------- ------------------ --------------------- ---------------

- ------------------------------------------------------- ------------------ --------------------- ---------------
                                                              TOTAL
- ------------------------------------------------------- ------------------ --------------------- ---------------
</TABLE>

  * Need not be completed by holders tendering by book-entry transfer.

 ** Unless indicated in the column labeled "Principal Amount Tendered," any
    tendering holder of Outstanding Notes will be deemed to have tendered the
    entire aggregate principal amount represented by the column labeled
    "Aggregate Principal Amount Represented by Certificate(s)," If the space
    provided above is inadequate, list the certificate numbers and principal
    amounts on a separate signed schedule and affix the list to this Letter of
    Transmittal.

    The minimum permitted tender is $1,000 in principal amount of Outstanding
    Notes. All other tenders must be integral multiples of $1,000.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>   123

                          SPECIAL PAYMENT INSTRUCTIONS
                         (SEE INSTRUCTIONS 4, 5 AND 6)

     To be completed ONLY if certificates for Outstanding Notes in a principal
amount not tendered or not accepted for exchange, or Exchange Notes issued in
exchange for Outstanding Notes accepted for exchange, are to be issued in the
name of someone other than the undersigned, or if the Outstanding Notes tendered
by book-entry transfer that are not accepted for exchange are to be credited to
an account maintained by DTC.

     Issue certificate(s) to:

Name: ..........................................................................
                                    (Please Print)

Address: .......................................................................

 ................................................................................
                               (Include Zip Code)

 ................................................................................
                  (Tax Identification or Social Security No.)

                         SPECIAL DELIVERY INSTRUCTIONS
                         (SEE INSTRUCTIONS 4, 5 AND 6)

     To be completed ONLY if certificates for Outstanding Notes in a principal
amount not tendered or not accepted for exchange, or Exchange Notes issued in
exchange for Outstanding Notes accepted for exchange, are to be sent to someone
other than the undersigned, or to the undersigned at an address other than that
shown above.

     Mail to:

Name: ..........................................................................
                                    (Please Print)

Address: .......................................................................

 ................................................................................
                               (Include Zip Code)

 ................................................................................
                  (Tax Identification or Social Security No.)
<PAGE>   124

[ ] CHECK HERE IF TENDERED OUTSTANDING NOTES ARE BEING DELIVERED BY BOOK-ENTRY
    TRANSFER TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT'S ACCOUNT AT DTC AND COMPLETE THE FOLLOWING:

Name of Tendering Institution:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
DTC Book-Entry Account Number:
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
Transaction Code Number:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

[ ] CHECK HERE IF TENDERED OUTSTANDING NOTES ARE BEING DELIVERED PURSUANT TO A
    NOTICE OF GUARANTEED DELIVERY PREVIOUSLY SENT TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT AND
    COMPLETE THE FOLLOWING:

Name(s) of Registered Holder(s):
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Window Ticket Number (if any):
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Date of Execution of Notice of Guaranteed Delivery:
- -----------------------------------------------------------

IF DELIVERED BY BOOK-ENTRY TRANSFER, COMPLETE THE FOLLOWING:

Account Number:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Transaction Code Number:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

[ ] CHECK HERE IF YOU ARE A BROKER-DEALER AND WISH TO RECEIVE 10 ADDITIONAL
    COPIES OF THE PROSPECTUS AND 10 COPIES OF ANY AMENDMENTS OR SUPPLEMENTS
    THERETO.

Name:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Address:
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>   125

Ladies and Gentlemen:

     Subject to the terms and conditions of the exchange offer, the undersigned
hereby tenders to the Company the principal amount of Outstanding Notes
indicated above. Subject to and effective upon the acceptance for exchange of
the principal amount of Outstanding Notes tendered in accordance with this
Letter of Transmittal, the undersigned sells, assigns and transfers to, or upon
the order of, the Company all right, title and interest in and to the
Outstanding Notes tendered hereby. The undersigned hereby irrevocably
constitutes and appoints the Exchange Agent its agent and attorney-in-fact (with
full knowledge that the Exchange Agent also acts as the agent of the Company and
as Trustee under the Indenture for the Outstanding Notes and Exchange Notes)
with respect to the tendered Outstanding Notes with full power of substitution
to

     - deliver certificates for such Outstanding Notes to the Company, or
       transfer ownership of such Outstanding Notes on the account books
       maintained by DTC and deliver all accompanying evidence of transfer and
       authenticity to, or upon the order of, the Company, and

     - present such Outstanding Notes for transfer on the books of the Company
       and receive all benefits and otherwise exercise all rights of beneficial
       ownership of such Outstanding Notes, all in accordance with the terms and
       subject to the conditions of the exchange offer. The power of attorney
       granted in this paragraph shall be deemed irrevocable and coupled with an
       interest.

     The undersigned hereby represents and warrants that the undersigned has
full power and authority to tender, sell, assign and transfer the Outstanding
Notes tendered hereby and that the Company will acquire good and unencumbered
title thereto, free and clear of all liens, restrictions, charges and
encumbrances and not subject to any adverse claim, when the same are acquired by
the Company. The undersigned hereby further represents that any Exchange Notes
acquired in exchange for Outstanding Notes tendered hereby will have been
acquired in the ordinary course of business of the holder receiving such
Exchange Notes, whether or not such person is the holder, that neither the
holder nor any such other person has an arrangement or understanding with any
person to participate in the distribution of such Exchange Notes and that
neither the holder nor any such other person is an "affiliate," as defined in
Rule 405 under the Securities Act, of the Company or any of its subsidiaries.

     The undersigned also acknowledges that this exchange offer is being made in
reliance on an interpretation by the staff of the Securities and Exchange
Commission that the Exchange Notes issued in exchange for the Outstanding Notes
in the exchange offer may be offered for resale, resold and otherwise
transferred by holders thereof (other than any such holder that is an
"affiliate" of the Company within the meaning of Rule 405 under the Securities
Act), without compliance with the registration and prospectus delivery
provisions of the Securities Act, provided that such Exchange Notes are acquired
in the ordinary course of such holders' business and such holders have no
arrangements with any person to participate in the distribution of such Exchange
Notes. If the undersigned is not a broker-dealer, the undersigned represents
that it is not engaged in, and does not intend to engage in, a distribution of
Exchange Notes. If the undersigned is a broker-dealer that will receive Exchange
Notes for its own account in exchange for Outstanding Notes that were acquired
as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities, it
acknowledges that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale of
such Exchange Notes; however, by so acknowledging and by delivering a
prospectus, the undersigned will not be deemed to admit that it is an
"underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act.

     The undersigned hereby acknowledges and agrees that any broker-dealer and
any holder using the exchange offer to participate in a distribution of Exchange
Notes could not rely on the SEC staff's position set forth in certain no-action
letters and must comply with the registration and prospectus delivery
requirements of the Securities Act in connection with a secondary resale
transaction and that such a secondary resale transaction must be covered by an
effective registration statement containing the selling security holder
information required by Item 507 or Item 508, as applicable, of Regulation S-K
if the resales are of Exchange Notes obtained by such holder in exchange for
Outstanding Notes that were acquired by such holder directly from the Company or
an affiliate of the Company.

     The undersigned will, upon request, execute and deliver any additional
documents deemed by the Exchange Agent or the Company to be necessary or
desirable to complete the assignment, transfer and purchase of the Outstanding
Notes tendered hereby. All authority conferred or agreed to be conferred by this
Letter of
<PAGE>   126

Transmittal shall survive the death, incapacity or dissolution of the
undersigned and every obligation of the undersigned under this Letter of
Transmittal shall be binding upon the undersigned's heirs, personal
representatives, successors and assigns, trustees in bankruptcy or other legal
representatives of the undersigned. This tender may be withdrawn only in
accordance with the procedures set forth in "The Exchange Offer -- Withdrawal of
Tenders" section of the prospectus.

     For purposes of the exchange offer, the Company shall be deemed to have
accepted validly tendered Outstanding Notes when and if the Company has given
oral or written notice thereof to the Exchange Agent.

     If any tendered Outstanding Notes are not accepted for exchange pursuant to
the exchange offer for any reason, certificates for any such unaccepted
Outstanding Notes will be returned (except as noted below with respect to
tenders through DTC), without expense, to the undersigned at the address shown
below or at a different address as may be indicated under "Special Delivery
Instructions" as promptly as practicable after the Expiration Date.

     The undersigned understands that tenders of Outstanding Notes pursuant to
the procedures described under the caption "The Exchange Offer -- Procedures for
Tendering" in the prospectus and in the instructions hereto will constitute a
binding agreement between the undersigned and the Company upon the terms and
subject to the conditions of the exchange offer.

     Unless otherwise indicated under "Special Payment and Delivery
Instructions," please issue the certificates representing the Exchange Notes
issued in exchange for the Outstanding Notes accepted for exchange and return
any Outstanding Notes not tendered or not exchanged in the name(s) of the
undersigned (or in either such event in the case of the Outstanding Notes
tendered by DTC, by credit to the undersigned's account, at DTC). Similarly,
unless otherwise indicated under "Special Payment and Delivery Instructions,"
please send the certificates representing the Exchange Notes issued in exchange
for the Outstanding Notes accepted for exchange and any certificates for
Outstanding Notes not tendered or not exchanged (and accompanying documents, as
appropriate) to the undersigned at the address shown below the undersigned's
signature(s), unless, in either event, tender is being made through DTC. In the
event that both "Special Payment Instructions" and "Special Payment and Delivery
Instructions" are completed, please issue the certificates representing the
Exchange Notes issued in exchange for the Outstanding Notes accepted for
exchange and return any Outstanding Notes not tendered or not exchanged in the
name(s) of, and send said certificates to, the person(s) so indicated. The
undersigned recognizes that the Company has no obligation pursuant to the
"Special Payment Instructions" and "Special Delivery Instructions" to transfer
any Outstanding Notes from the name of the registered holder(s) thereof if the
Company does not accept for exchange any of the Outstanding Notes so tendered.

     Holders of Outstanding Notes who wish to tender their Outstanding Notes and

     - whose Outstanding Notes are not immediately available, or

     - who cannot deliver their Outstanding Notes, this Letter of Transmittal or
       any other documents required hereby to the Exchange Agent, or

     - cannot complete the procedure for book-entry transfer prior to the
       Expiration Date,

     - may tender their Outstanding Notes according to the guaranteed delivery
       procedures set forth in the prospectus under the caption "The Exchange
       Offer -- Guaranteed Delivery Procedures." See Instruction 1 regarding the
       completion of the Letter of Transmittal printed below.
<PAGE>   127

                        PLEASE SIGN HERE WHETHER OR NOT
             OUTSTANDING NOTES ARE BEING PHYSICALLY TENDERED HEREBY

<TABLE>
<S>                                                             <C>

X ..........................................................    ...............................
                                                                Date

X ..........................................................    ...............................
Signature(s) of Registered Holder(s) or Authorized Signatory    Date
</TABLE>

Area Code and Telephone Number: ................................................

The above lines must be signed by the registered holder(s) of Outstanding Notes
as their name(s) appear(s) on the Outstanding Notes or, if the Outstanding Notes
are tendered by a participant in DTC, as such participant's name appears on a
security position listing as the owner of Outstanding Notes, or by person(s)
authorized to become registered holder(s) by a properly completed bond power
from the registered holder(s), a copy of which must be transmitted with this
Letter of Transmittal. If Outstanding Notes to which this Letter of Transmittal
relates are held of record by two or more joint holders, then all such holders
must sign this Letter of Transmittal. If signature is by a trustee, executor,
administrator, guardian, attorney-in-fact, officer of a corporation or other
person acting in a fiduciary or representative capacity, such person must (i)
set forth his or her full title below and (ii) unless waived by the Company,
submit evidence satisfactory to the Company of such person's authority to act.
See Instruction 4 regarding the completion of this Letter of Transmittal printed
below.

Name(s): .......................................................................
 ................................................................................
                                 (Please Print)

Capacity: ......................................................................
Address: .......................................................................
                               (Include Zip Code)

                 SIGNATURE GUARANTEE BY AN ELIGIBLE INSTITUTION
                         (If Required by Instruction 4)

Certain signatures must be Guaranteed by an Eligible Institution.
 ................................................................................
                             (Authorized Signature)

 ................................................................................
                                    (Title)

 ................................................................................
                                 (Name of Firm)

Dated: .........................................................................
<PAGE>   128

                                  INSTRUCTIONS

         FORMING PART OF THE TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER

     1. Delivery of this Letter and Notes; Guaranteed Delivery Procedures. This
Letter is to be completed by noteholders, either if certificates are to be
forwarded herewith or if tenders are to be made pursuant to the procedures for
delivery by book-entry transfer set forth in "The Exchange Offer -- Book-Entry
Transfer" section of the prospectus. Certificates for all physically tendered
Outstanding Notes, or book-entry confirmation, as the case may be, as well as a
properly completed and duly executed Letter (or manually signed facsimile
hereof) and any other documents required by this Letter, must be received by the
Exchange Agent at the address set forth herein on or prior to the Expiration
Date, or the tendering holder must comply with the guaranteed delivery
procedures set forth below. Outstanding Notes tendered hereby must be in
denominations of principal amount of maturity of $1,000 and any integral
multiple thereof.

     Noteholders whose certificates for Outstanding Notes are not immediately
available or who cannot deliver their certificates and all other required
documents to the Exchange Agent on or prior to the Expiration Date, or who
cannot complete the procedure for book-entry transfer on a timely basis, may
tender their Outstanding Notes pursuant to the guaranteed delivery procedures
set forth in "The Exchange Offer -- Guaranteed Delivery Procedures" section of
the prospectus. Pursuant to such procedures,

     - such tender must be made through an Eligible Institution (as defined in
       Instruction 4 below),

     - prior to the Expiration Date, the Exchange Agent must receive from such
       Eligible Institution a properly completed and duly executed Letter (or
       facsimile thereof) and Notice of Guaranteed Delivery, substantially in
       the form provided by the Company (by facsimile transmission, mail or hand
       delivery), setting forth the name and address of the holder of
       Outstanding Notes and the amount of Outstanding Notes tendered, stating
       that the tender is being made thereby and guaranteeing that within five
       Nasdaq National Market trading days after the date of execution of the
       Notice of Guaranteed Delivery, the certificates for all physically
       tendered Outstanding Notes, or a book-entry confirmation, and any other
       documents required by this Letter will be deposited by the Eligible
       Institution with the Exchange Agent, and

     - the certificates for all physically tendered Outstanding Notes, in proper
       form for transfer, or book-entry confirmation, as the case may be, and
       all other documents required by this Letter, are received by the Exchange
       Agent within five Nasdaq National Market trading days after the date of
       execution of the Notice of Guaranteed Delivery.

     The method of delivery of this Letter, the Outstanding Notes and all other
required documents is at the election and risk of the tendering holders, but the
delivery will be deemed made only when actually received or confirmed by the
Exchange Agent. If Outstanding Notes are sent by mail, it is suggested that the
mailing be made sufficiently in advance of the Expiration Date to permit the
delivery to the Exchange Agent prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the
Expiration Date.

     See "The Exchange Offer" section in the prospectus.

     2. Tender by Holder. Only a holder of Outstanding Notes may tender their
Outstanding Notes in the Exchange Offer. Any beneficial holder of Outstanding
Notes who is not the registered holder and who wishes to tender should arrange
with the registered holder to execute and deliver this Letter on his or her
behalf or must, prior to completing and executing this Letter and delivering his
or her Outstanding Notes, either make appropriate arrangements to register
ownership of the Outstanding Notes in such holder's name or obtain a properly
completed bond power from the registered holder.

     3. Partial Tenders. Tenders of Outstanding Notes will be accepted only in
integral multiples of $1,000. If less than the entire principal amount of any
Outstanding Notes is tendered, the tendering holder should fill in the principal
amount tendered in the fourth column of the box entitled "Description of 9 1/4%
Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007 (Outstanding Notes)" above. The entire
principal amount of Outstanding Notes delivered to the Exchange Agent will be
deemed to have been tendered unless otherwise indicated. If the entire principal
amount of all Outstanding Notes is not tendered, then Outstanding Notes for the
principal amount of Outstanding Notes not tendered and a certificate or
certificates representing Exchange Notes issued in exchange for any Outstanding
<PAGE>   129

Notes accepted will be sent to the holder at his or her registered address,
unless a different address is provided in the appropriate box on this Letter of
Transmittal, promptly after the Outstanding Notes are accepted for exchange.

     4. Signatures on this Letter; Powers of Attorney and Endorsements;
Guarantee of Signatures. If this Letter is signed by the registered holder of
the Outstanding Notes tendered hereby, the signature must correspond exactly
with the name as written on the face of the certificates without any change
whatsoever.

     If any tendered Outstanding Notes are owned of record by two or more joint
owners, all such owners must sign this Letter.

     If any tendered Outstanding Notes are registered in different names on
several certificates, it will be necessary to complete, sign and submit as many
separate copies of this Letter as there are different registrations of
certificates.

     When this Letter is signed by the registered holder or holders of the
Outstanding Notes specified herein and tendered hereby, no endorsements of
certificates or separate powers of attorney are required. If, however, the
Exchange Notes are to be issued, or any untendered Outstanding Notes are to be
reissued, to a person other than the registered holder, then endorsements of any
certificates transmitted hereby or separate powers of attorney are required.
Signatures on such certificate(s) must be guaranteed by an Eligible Institution.

     If this Letter is signed by a person other than the registered holder or
holders of any certificate(s) specified herein, such certificate(s) must be
endorsed or accompanied by appropriate powers of attorney, in either case signed
exactly as the name or names on the registered holder or holders appear(s) on
the certificate(s) and signatures on such certificate(s) must be guaranteed by
an Eligible Institution.

     If this Letter or any certificates or powers of attorney are signed by
trustees, executors, administrators, guardians, attorneys-in-fact, officers of
corporations or others acting in a fiduciary or representative capacity, such
persons should so indicate when signing, and unless waived by the Company,
proper evidence satisfactory to the Company of their authority to so act must be
submitted.

     Endorsements on certificates for Outstanding Notes or signatures on powers
of attorney required by this Instruction 4 must be guaranteed by a firm which is
a participant in a recognized signature guarantee medallion program ("Eligible
Institutions").

     Signatures on this Letter must be guaranteed by an Eligible Institution
unless the Outstanding Notes are tendered:

     - by a registered holder of Outstanding Notes (which term, for purposes of
       the Exchange Offer, includes any participant in the Book-Entry Transfer
       Facility system whose name appears on a security position listing as the
       holder of such Outstanding Notes) who has not completed the box entitled
       "Special Issuance Instructions" or "Special Delivery Instructions" on
       this Letter, or

     - for the account of an Eligible Institution.

     5. Special Payment and Delivery Instructions. Tendering holders should
indicate, in the applicable box or boxes, the name and address to which Exchange
Notes or substitute Outstanding Notes for principal amounts not tendered or not
accepted for exchange are to be issued or sent, if different from the name and
address of the person signing this Letter of Transmittal (or in the case of a
tender of Outstanding Notes through DTC, if different from DTC). In the case of
issuance in a different name, the taxpayer identification or social security
number of the person named must also be indicated. Noteholders tendering
Outstanding Notes by book-entry transfer may request that Outstanding Notes not
exchanged be credited to such account maintained at the Book-Entry Transfer
Facility as such noteholder may designate hereon. If no such instructions are
given, any Outstanding Notes that are not exchanged will be returned to the name
and address of the person signing this Letter.

     6. Tax Identification Number. Federal income tax law requires that a holder
whose offered Outstanding Notes are accepted for exchange must provide the
Company (as payer) with his, her or its correct taxpayer identification number
("TIN"), which, in the case of an exchanging holder who is an individual, is his
or her social security number. If the Company is not provided with the correct
TIN or an adequate basis for exemption,
<PAGE>   130

such holder may be subject to a $50 penalty imposed by the Internal Revenue
Service and payments made with respect to Outstanding Notes purchased pursuant
to this exchange offer may be subject to backup withholding at a 31% rate. If
withholding results in an overpayment of taxes, a refund may be obtained. Exempt
holders (including, among others, all corporations and certain foreign
individuals) are not subject to these backup withholding and reporting
requirements. See the enclosed "Guidelines for Certification of Taxpayer
Identification Number on Substitute Form W-9."

     To prevent backup withholding, each exchanging holder must provide his, her
or its correct TIN by completing the Substitute Form W-9 enclosed herewith,
certifying that the TIN provided is correct (or that such Holder is awaiting a
TIN) and that

     - the holder is exempt from backup withholding,

     - the holder has been notified by the IRS that he, she or it is subject to
       backup withholding as a result of a failure to report all interest or
       dividends, or

     - the IRS has notified the holder that he, she or it is no longer subject
       to backup withholding.

     In order to satisfy the Exchange Agent that a foreign individual qualifies
as an exempt recipient, such holder must submit a statement signed under penalty
of perjury attesting to such exempt status. Such statements may be obtained from
the Exchange Agent. If the Outstanding Notes are in more than one name or are
not in the name of the actual owner, consult the Substitute Form W-9 for
information on which TIN to report. If you do not provide your TIN to the
Company within 60 days, backup withholding will begin and continue until you
furnish your TIN to the Company.

     7. Transfer Taxes. The Company will pay all transfer taxes, if any,
applicable to the exchange of Outstanding Notes pursuant to the exchange offer.
If, however, certificates representing Exchange Notes or Outstanding Notes for
principal amounts not tendered or accepted for exchange are to be delivered to,
or are to be registered or issued in the name of, any person other than the
registered holder of the Outstanding Notes tendered hereby, or if tendered
Outstanding Notes are registered in the name of any person other than the person
signing this Letter of Transmittal, or if a transfer tax is imposed for any
reason other than the exchange of Outstanding Notes pursuant to the exchange
offer, then the amount of any such transfer taxes (whether imposed on the
registered holder or on any other persons) will be payable by the tendering
holder. If satisfactory evidence of payment of such taxes or exemption therefrom
is not submitted herewith, the amount of such transfer taxes will be billed
directly to such tendering holder.

     Except as provided in this Instruction 7, it will not be necessary for
transfer tax stamps to be affixed to the Outstanding Notes listed in this Letter
of Transmittal.

     8. Waiver of Conditions. The Company reserves the absolute right to amend,
waive or modify specified conditions in the exchange offer in the case of any
Outstanding Notes tendered.

     9. No Conditional Transfers. No alternative, conditional, irregular or
contingent tenders will be accepted. All tendering holders of Outstanding Notes,
by execution of this Letter, shall waive any right to receive notice of the
acceptance of their Outstanding Notes for exchange.

     Neither the Company, the Exchange Agent nor any other person is obligated
to give notice of any defect or irregularity with respect to any tender of
Outstanding Notes nor shall any of them incur any liability for failure to give
any such notice.

     10. Mutilated, Lost, Stolen or Destroyed Outstanding Notes. Any tendering
holder whose Outstanding Notes have been mutilated, lost, stolen or destroyed
should contact the Exchange Agent at the address indicated herein for further
instructions.

     11. Requests for Assistance or Additional Copies. Questions and requests
for assistance for additional copies of the prospectus, this Letter of
Transmittal and the Notice of Guaranteed Delivery may be directed to the
Exchange Agent at the address specified in the prospectus.
<PAGE>   131

                       (DO NOT WRITE IN THE SPACE BELOW)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
      CERTIFICATE                 OUTSTANDING NOTES              OUTSTANDING NOTES
      SURRENDERED                     TENDERED                       ACCEPTED
      -----------                 -----------------              -----------------
  <S>                            <C>                            <C>

  ------------------             ------------------             ------------------

  ------------------             ------------------             ------------------

  ------------------             ------------------             ------------------
  ------------------             ------------------             ------------------
</TABLE>

     Delivery Prepared by _____________ Checked By _____________ Date __________
<PAGE>   132

                    PAYER'S NAME: PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<TABLE>
<S>                                        <C>                                        <C>
 Name (if joint names, list first and circle the name of the person or entity whose number you enter in Part I below. See
 instructions if your name has changed.)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 Address
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 City, state and ZIP Code
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 List account number(s) here (optional)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SUBSTITUTE                                  PART I -- Please provide your Tax-
FORM W-9                                    payer Identification Number               ---------------------------------------
                                            ("TIN") in the box at right and           Social Security Number
DEPARTMENT OF THE TREASURY                  certify by signing and dating below.
INTERNAL REVENUE SERVICE                                                              OR ----------------------------------
                                                                                      TIN
                                           ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                            PART II -- Check the box if you are NOT subject to backup withholding under the
                                            provisions of section 3408(a)(1)(C) of the Internal Revenue Code because (1) you
                                            have not been notified that you are subject to backup withholding as a result of
                                            failure to report all interest or dividends or (2) the Internal Revenue Service has
                                            notified you that you are no longer subject to backup withholding.  [ ]
                                           ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                            PART III -- AWAITING TIN
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 PAYER'S REQUEST FOR TAXPAYER IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 CERTIFICATION -- Under the penalties of perjury, I certify that the information provided on this form is true, correct and
 complete.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 SIGNATURE                                                                                        DATE
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

NOTE: FAILURE TO COMPLETE AND RETURN THIS FORM MAY RESULT IN BACKUP WITHHOLDING
      OF 31% OF ANY PAYMENTS MADE TO YOU PURSUANT TO THE EXCHANGE OFFER. PLEASE
      REVIEW THE ENCLOSED GUIDELINES FOR CERTIFICATION OF TAXPAYER
      IDENTIFICATION NUMBER ON SUBSTITUTE FORM W-9 FOR ADDITIONAL DETAILS.
<PAGE>   133

                       GUIDELINES FOR CERTIFICATION OF TAXPAYER
                     IDENTIFICATION NUMBER ON SUBSTITUTE FORM W-9

     GUIDELINES FOR DETERMINING THE PROPER IDENTIFICATION NUMBER TO GIVE THE
PAYER. -- Social Security numbers have nine digits separated by two hyphens:
i.e. 000-00-0000. Employer identification numbers have nine digits separated by
only one hyphen: i.e. 00-0000000. The table below will help determine the number
to give the payer.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ---------------------------------------------------------
                                        GIVE THE
        FOR THIS TYPE                SOCIAL SECURITY
         OF ACCOUNT:                  NUMBER OF --
- ---------------------------------------------------------
<C>  <S>                        <C>
 1.  An individual's account    The individual
 2.  Two or more individuals    The actual owner of the
                                account or, if combined
                                funds, any one of the
                                individuals(1)
 3.  Husband and wife (joint    The actual owner of the
     account)                   account or, if joint
                                funds, either person(1)
 4.  Custodian account of a     The minor(2)
     minor (Uniform Gift to
     Minors Act)
 5.  Adult and minor (joint     The adult or, if the
     account)                   minor is the only
                                contributor, the minor(1)
 6.  Account in the name of     The ward, minor, or
     guardian or committee for  incompetent person(3)
     a designated ward, minor
     or incompetent person
 7.  a. The usual revocable     The grantor trustee(1)
        savings trust account
        (grantor is also
        trustee)
     b. So-called trust         The actual owner(1)
     account that is not a
        legal and valid trust
        under State law
 8.  Sole proprietorship        The owner(4)
     account
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ---------------------------------------------------------
                                        GIVE THE
        FOR THIS TYPE                SOCIAL SECURITY
         OF ACCOUNT:                  NUMBER OF --
- ---------------------------------------------------------
<C>  <S>                        <C>
 9.  A valid trust, estate or   The legal entity (do not
     pension trust              furnish the identifying
                                number of the personal
                                representative or trustee
                                unless the legal entity
                                itself is not designated
                                in the account title.)(5)
10.  Corporate account          The corporation
11.  Religious, charitable, or  The organization
     educational organization
     account
12.  Partnership account held   The partnership
     in the name of the
     business
13.  Association, club, or      The organization
     other tax-exempt
     organization
14.  A broker or registered     The broker or nominee
     nominee
15.  Account with the           The public entity
     Department of Agriculture
     in the name of a public
     entity (such as a State
     or local government,
     school district, or
     prison) that receives
     agricultural program
     payments
</TABLE>

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

(1) List first and circle the name of the person whose number you furnish.
(2) Circle the minor's name and furnish the minor's social security number.
(3) Circle the ward's, minor's or incompetent person's name and furnish such
    person's social security number.
(4) Show the name of the owner.
(5) List first and circle the name of the legal trust, estate, or pension trust.

NOTE: IF NO NAME IS CIRCLED WHEN THERE IS MORE THAN ONE NAME, THE NUMBER WILL BE
      CONSIDERED TO BE THAT OF THE FIRST NAME LISTED.
<PAGE>   134

OBTAINING A NUMBER

    If you don't have a taxpayer identification number or you don't know your
number, obtain Form SS-5, Application for a Social Security Number Card, or Form
SS-4, Application for Employer Identification Number, at the local office of the
Social Security Administration or the Internal Revenue Service and apply for a
number.

PAYEES EXEMPT FROM BACKUP WITHHOLDING

    Payees specifically exempted from backup withholding on ALL payments include
the following:

    - A corporation.

    - A financial institution.

    - An organization exempt from tax under section 501(a), or an individual
      retirement plan.

    - The United States or any agency or instrumentality thereof.

    - A State, the District of Columbia, a possession of the United States, or
      any subdivision or instrumentality thereof.

    - A foreign government, a political subdivision of a foreign government, or
      any agency or instrumentality thereof.

    - An international organization or any agency, or instrumentality thereof.

    - A registered dealer in securities or commodities registered in the U.S. or
      a possession of the U.S.

    - A real estate investment trust.

    - A common trust fund operated by a bank under section 584(a).

    - An exempt charitable remainder trust, or a non-exempt trust described in
      section 4947(a)(l).

    - An entity registered at all times under the Investment Company Act of
      1940.

    - A foreign central bank of issue.

    Payments of dividends and patronage dividends not generally subject to
backup withholding include the following:

    - Payments to nonresident aliens subject to withholding under section 1441.

    - Payments to partnerships not engaged in a trade or business in the U.S.
      and which have at least one nonresident partner.

    - Payments of patronage dividends where the amount received is not paid in
      money.

    - Payments made by certain foreign organizations.

    - Payments made to a nominee.

    Payments of interest not generally subject to backup withholding include the
following

    - Payments of interest on obligations issued by individuals. Note: You may
      be subject to backup withholding if this interest is $600 or more and is
      paid in the course of the payer's trade or business and you have not
      provided your correct taxpayer identification number to the payer.

    - Payments of tax-exempt interest (including exempt-interest dividends under
      section 852).

    - Payments described in section 6049(b)(5) to non-resident aliens.

    - Payments on tax-free covenant bonds under section 1451.

    - Payments made by certain foreign organizations.

    - Payments made to a nominee.

    Exempt payees described above should file Form W-9 to avoid possible
erroneous backup withholding. FILE THIS FORM WITH THE PAYER, FURNISH YOUR
TAXPAYER IDENTIFICATION NUMBER, WRITE "EXEMPT" ON THE FACE OF THE FORM, AND
RETURN IT TO THE PAYER. IF THE PAYMENTS ARE INTEREST, DIVIDENDS, OR PATRONAGE
DIVIDENDS, ALSO SIGN AND DATE THE FORM.

    Certain payments other than interest, dividends and patronage dividends,
that are not subject to information reporting are also not subject to backup
withholding. For details, see the regulations under sections 6041, 6041A(a),
6045, and 6050A.

    PRIVACY ACT NOTICE -- Section 6109 requires most recipients of dividend,
interest, or other payments to give tax-payer identification numbers to payers
who must report for payments to IRS. IRS uses the numbers for identification
purposes. Payers must be given the numbers whether or not recipients are
required to file tax returns. Beginning January 1, 1994, payers must generally
withhold 31% of taxable interest, dividend, and certain other payments to a
payee who does not furnish a taxpayer identification number to a payer. Certain
penalties may also apply.

PENALTIES

    (1) PENALTY FOR FAILURE TO FURNISH TAXPAYER IDENTIFICATION NUMBER. -- If you
fail to furnish your taxpayer identification number to a payer, you are subject
to a penalty of $50 for each such failure unless your failure is due to
reasonable cause and not to willful neglect.

    (2) FAILURE TO REPORT CERTAIN DIVIDEND AND INTEREST PAYMENTS. -- If you fail
to include any portion of an includible payment for interest, dividends, or
patronage dividends in gross income, such failure will be treated as being due
to negligence and will be subject to a penalty of 5% on any portion of an
underpayment attributable to that failure unless there is clear and convincing
evidence to the contrary.

    (3) CIVIL PENALTY FOR FALSE INFORMATION WITH RESPECT TO WITHHOLDING. -- If
you make a false statement with no reasonable basis which results in no
imposition of backup withholding, you are subject to a penalty of $500.

    (4) CRIMINAL PENALTY FOR FALSIFYING INFORMATION. -- Falsifying
certifications or affirmations may subject you to criminal penalties including
fines and/or imprisonment.

    FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION CONTACT YOUR TAX CONSULTANT OR THE INTERNAL
REVENUE SERVICE.
<PAGE>   135

                                                                    EXHIBIT 99.2

                         NOTICE OF GUARANTEED DELIVERY
                                      FOR
                   9 1/4% SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES DUE 2007
                                       OF

                           PARK-OHIO INDUSTRIES, INC.

                         CUSIPS 700677AC1 AND 700677AF4

     As set forth in the prospectus dated July 27, 1999, of Park-Ohio
Industries, Inc. (the "Company") and in the accompanying Letter of Transmittal
and instructions thereto, this form or one substantially equivalent must be used
to accept the Company's offer to exchange all of its outstanding 9 1/4% Senior
Subordinated Notes due 2007 Series B and Series C (the "Outstanding Notes") for
its 9 1/4% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007, Series D which have been
registered under the Securities Act of 1933, if certificates for the Outstanding
Notes are not immediately available or if the Outstanding Notes, the Letter of
Transmittal or any other documents required thereby cannot be delivered to the
Exchange Agent, or the procedure for book-entry transfer cannot be completed,
prior to 5:00 P.M., New York City time, on August 26, 1999 (the "Expiration
Date"). This form may be delivered by an Eligible Institution by hand or
transmitted by facsimile transmission, overnight courier or mail to the Exchange
Agent as set forth below.

THE EXCHANGE OFFER WILL EXPIRE AT 5:00 P.M., NEW YORK CITY TIME, ON AUGUST 26,
1999, UNLESS THE OFFER IS EXTENDED. TENDERS OF OUTSTANDING NOTES MAY BE
WITHDRAWN AT ANY TIME PRIOR TO 5:00 P.M. ON THE EXPIRATION DATE.

      To: Norwest Bank Minnesota, National Association, The Exchange Agent

<TABLE>
<S>                                            <C>
      By Registered or Certified Mail:                     By Overnight Courier:
Norwest Bank Minnesota, National Association   Norwest Bank Minnesota, National Association
         Corporate Trust Operations                     Corporate Trust Operations
                P.O. Box 1517                                 Norwest Center
         Minneapolis, MN 55480-1517                         Sixth and Marquette
                                                        Minneapolis, MN 55479-0113
                  By Hand:                                     By Facsimile:
Norwest Bank Minnesota, National Association   Norwest Bank Minnesota, National Association
         Corporate Trust Operations                     Corporate Trust Operations
         Northstar East, 12th Floor                           (612) 667-4927
               608 2nd Avenue                              Confirm by telephone:
            Minneapolis, MN 55402                             (612) 667-9764
</TABLE>

                            ------------------------

DELIVERY OF THIS INSTRUMENT TO AN ADDRESS, OR TRANSMISSION OF INSTRUCTIONS VIA A
FACSIMILE, OTHER THAN AS SET FORTH ABOVE, DOES NOT CONSTITUTE A VALID DELIVERY.

     This form is not to be used to guarantee signatures. If a signature on the
Letter of Transmittal to be used to tender Outstanding Notes is required to be
guaranteed by an "Eligible Institution" under the instructions thereto, such
signature guarantee must appear in the applicable space provided in the Letter
of Transmittal.
<PAGE>   136

Ladies and Gentlemen:

     The undersigned hereby tenders to Park-Ohio Industries, Inc. (the
"Company"), upon the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in the
prospectus and the Letter of Transmittal (which together constitute the
"Exchange Offer"), receipt of which is hereby acknowledged, Outstanding Notes
pursuant to the guaranteed delivery procedures set forth in Instruction I of the
Letter of Transmittal.

     The undersigned understands that tenders of Outstanding Notes will be
accepted only in principal amounts equal to $1,000 or integral multiples
thereof. The undersigned understands that tenders of Outstanding Notes pursuant
to the Exchange Offer may be withdrawn only in accordance with the procedures
set forth in "The Exchange Offer -- Withdrawal of Tenders" section of the
prospectus.

     All authority herein conferred or agreed to be conferred by this Notice of
Guaranteed Delivery shall survive the death, incapacity or dissolution of the
undersigned and every obligation of the undersigned under this Notice of
Guaranteed Delivery shall be binding upon the heirs, personal representatives,
executors, administrators, successors, assigns, trustees in bankruptcy and other
legal representatives of the undersigned.

            NOTE: SIGNATURES MUST BE PROVIDED WHERE INDICATED BELOW.

<TABLE>
<S>                                              <C>
Certificate No(s). for Outstanding Notes (if
available)                                       Address

- ---------------------------------------------    ---------------------------------------------

- ---------------------------------------------    ---------------------------------------------
Principal Amount of Outstanding Notes            Area Code and Tel. No.

- ---------------------------------------------    ---------------------------------------------

- ---------------------------------------------    ---------------------------------------------
Name(s) of Record Holder(s)                      Signature(s)

- ---------------------------------------------    ---------------------------------------------

- ---------------------------------------------    ---------------------------------------------
                                                 Dated:

                                                 ---------------------------------------------
                                                 If Outstanding Notes will be delivered by
                                                 book-entry transfer at the Depository Trust
                                                 Company,
                                                 Depository Account No:

                                                 ---------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

     This Notice of Guaranteed Delivery must be signed by the registered
holder(s) of Outstanding Notes exactly as its (their) name(s) appear on
certificates for Outstanding Notes or on a security position listing as the
owner of Outstanding Notes, or by person(s) authorized to become registered
holder(s) by endorsements and documents transmitted with this Notice of
Guaranteed Delivery. If signature is by a trustee, executor, administrator,
guardian, attorney-in-fact, officer or other person acting in a fiduciary or
representative capacity, such person must provide the following information:
<PAGE>   137

                      PLEASE PRINT NAME(S) AND ADDRESS(ES)

NAME(S):
 ................................................................................
 ................................................................................
 ................................................................................

CAPACITY:
 ................................................................................

ADDRESS(ES):
 ................................................................................
 ................................................................................
<PAGE>   138

                                   GUARANTEE

                    (Not To Be Used for Signature Guarantee)

     The undersigned, a member firm of a registered national securities exchange
or of the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc., or a commercial bank
or trust company having an office or correspondent in the United States or an
"eligible guarantor institution" within the meaning of Rule 17Ad-15 under the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, hereby

     (a) represents that the above named person(s) "own(s)" the Outstanding
Notes tendered hereby within the meaning of Rule 14e-4 under the Exchange Act,

     (b) represents that such tender of Outstanding Notes complies with Rule
14e-4 under the Exchange Act and

     (c) guarantees that delivery to the Exchange Agent of certificates for the
Outstanding Notes tendered hereby, in proper form for transfer (or confirmation
of the book-entry transfer of such Outstanding Notes into the Exchange Agent's
account at the Depository Trust Company, pursuant to the procedures for book-
entry transfer set forth in the prospectus), with delivery of a properly
completed and duly executed Letter of Transmittal (or manually signed facsimile
thereof) with any required signatures and any other required documents, will be
received by the Exchange Agent at one of its addresses set forth above within
five Nasdaq National Market trading days after the Expiration Date.

     THE UNDERSIGNED ACKNOWLEDGES THAT IT MUST DELIVER THE LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL
AND OUTSTANDING NOTES TENDERED HEREBY TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT WITHIN THE TIME
PERIOD SET FORTH AND THAT FAILURE TO DO SO COULD RESULT IN FINANCIAL LOSS TO THE
UNDERSIGNED.

Name of Firm:
             ------------------------------------------------------------------
Address:
         ----------------------------------------------------------------------
                                       (Zip Code)

Area Code and Tel. No.:
                       --------------------------------------------------------
Authorized Signature:
                     ----------------------------------------------------------
Name:
      -------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                (Please Type or Print)

Title:
      -------------------------------------------------------------------------
Date:
      ---------------------------------------

NOTE: DO NOT SEND OUTSTANDING NOTES WITH THIS FORM; OUTSTANDING NOTES SHOULD BE
      SENT WITH YOUR LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL SO THAT THEY ARE RECEIVED BY THE
      EXCHANGE AGENT WITHIN FIVE NASDAQ NATIONAL MARKET TRADING DAYS AFTER THE
      EXPIRATION DATE.


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission